Docs: more on ${authresults }
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.90"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2018
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440 .endtable
441
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
449 .cindex "web site"
450 .cindex "FTP site"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
452 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
453 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
454 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
455 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
456 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
457
458 .cindex "wiki"
459 .cindex "FAQ"
460 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
461 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
462 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
463 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
464 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
465
466 .cindex Bugzilla
467 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
468 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
469 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
470
471
472
473 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
474 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
475 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
476
477 .table2 140pt
478 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
479 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
480 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
481 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
482 .endtable
483
484 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
485 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
486 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
487 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
488 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
489 via this web page:
490 .display
491 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 .endd
493 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
494 lists.
495
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503
504
505
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
507 .cindex "FTP site"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
510 .display
511 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
512 .endd
513 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
514 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
515 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
516
517 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
518 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
519 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
520 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
521 .display
522 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
523 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
524 .endd
525 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
526 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
527 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
528
529 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
530 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
531 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
532 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
533 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
534 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
535 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
536 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
537 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
538 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
539 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
540
541 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
542 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
543 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
544 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
545
546 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
547 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
548 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
549
550 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
551 .display
552 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
554 .endd
555 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
556 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
557 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
558
559 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
560 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
561 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
562 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
563 .display
564 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
565 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
566 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
568 .endd
569 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
570 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
571
572
573 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
574 .ilist
575 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
576 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
577 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
578 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
579 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
580 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
581 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
582 .next
583 .cindex "domainless addresses"
584 .cindex "address" "without domain"
585 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
586 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
587 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
588 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
589 arrival.
590 .next
591 .cindex "transport" "external"
592 .cindex "external transports"
593 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
594 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
595 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
596 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
597 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
598 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
599 .next
600 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
601 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
602 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
603 other means.
604 .next
605 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
606 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
607 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
608 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
609 a number of common scanners are provided.
610 .endlist
611
612
613 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
614 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
615 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
616 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
617 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
618 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
619
620
621 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
622 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
623 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
624 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
625 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
626 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
627 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
628 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
629 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
630 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
631 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
632 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
633
634 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
635 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
636 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
637 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
638
639
640
641 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
642 .cindex "terminology definitions"
643 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
644 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
645 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
646 below) by a blank line.
647
648 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
649 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
650 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
651 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
652 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
653 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
654 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
655 rise to further bounce messages.
656
657 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
658 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
659 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
660 otherwise.
661
662 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
663 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
664 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
665 until a later time.
666
667 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
668 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
669 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
670
671 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
672 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
673 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
674 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
675 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
676 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
677 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
678 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
679
680 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
681 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
682 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
683 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
684 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
685 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
686 line.
687
688 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
689 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
690 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
691 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
692 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
693
694 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
695 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
696 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
697 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
698 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
699 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
700
701 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
702 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
703 message's envelope.
704
705 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
706 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
707 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
708 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
709 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
710
711 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
712 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
713 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
714 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
715 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
716
717 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
718 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
719 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
720 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
721 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
722 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
723
724
725
726
727
728
729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
731
732 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
733 .cindex "incorporated code"
734 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
735 .cindex "PCRE"
736 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
737 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
738
739 .ilist
740 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
741 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
742 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
743 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
744 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
745 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
746 .next
747 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
748 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
749 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
750 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
751 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
752 following statements:
753
754 .blockquote
755 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
756
757 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
758 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
759 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
760 version.
761 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
762 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
763 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
764 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
765 restrictions applied to it).
766 .endblockquote
767 .next
768 .cindex "SPA authentication"
769 .cindex "Samba project"
770 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
771 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
772 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
773 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
774 under the Gnu GPL.
775 .next
776 .cindex "Cyrus"
777 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
778 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
779 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
780 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
781 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
782 conditions expressed therein.
783
784 .blockquote
785 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
786
787 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
788 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
789 are met:
790
791 .olist
792 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
793 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
794 .next
795 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
796 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
797 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
798 distribution.
799 .next
800 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
801 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
802 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
803 details, please contact
804 .display
805 Office of Technology Transfer
806 Carnegie Mellon University
807 5000 Forbes Avenue
808 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
809 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
810 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
811 .endd
812 .next
813 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
814 acknowledgment:
815
816 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
817 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
818
819 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
820 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
821 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
822 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
823 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
824 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
825 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
826 .endlist
827 .endblockquote
828
829 .next
830 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
831 .cindex "X-windows"
832 .cindex "Athena"
833 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
834 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
835 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
836 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
837
838 .blockquote
839 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
840 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
841
842 All Rights Reserved
843
844 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
845 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
846 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
847 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
848 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
849 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
850 software without specific, written prior permission.
851
852 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
853 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
854 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
855 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
856 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
857 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
858 SOFTWARE.
859 .endblockquote
860
861 .next
862 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
863 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
864 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
865 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
866 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
867 source code.
868
869 .next
870 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
871 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
872 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
873 .endlist
874
875
876
877
878
879 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
880 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
881
882 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
883 "Receiving and delivering mail"
884
885
886 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
887 .cindex "design philosophy"
888 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
889 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
890 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
891 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
892 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
893 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
894
895
896 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
897 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
898 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
899 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
900 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
901 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
902 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
903
904 .ilist
905 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
906 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
907 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
908 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
909 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
910 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
911 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
912 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
913 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
914 error code.
915 .next
916 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
917 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
918 .next
919 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
920 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
921 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
922 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
923 .next
924 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
925 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
926 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
927 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
928 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
929 .next
930 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
931 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
932 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
933 .next
934 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
935 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
936 runs at the start of every delivery process.
937 .endlist
938
939
940
941 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
942 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
943 .cindex "Sieve filter"
944 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
945 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
946 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
947 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
948 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
949 of filtering are available:
950
951 .ilist
952 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
953 by RFC 3028.
954 .next
955 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
956 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
957 .endlist
958
959 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
960
961
962
963 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
964 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
965 .cindex "format" "of message id"
966 .cindex "id of message"
967 .cindex "base62"
968 .cindex "base36"
969 .cindex "Darwin"
970 .cindex "Cygwin"
971 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
972 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
973 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
974 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
975 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
976 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
977 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
978 not always case-sensitive.
979
980 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
981 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
982 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
983 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
984 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
985 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
986 somewhat eccentric:
987
988 .ilist
989 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
990 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
991 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
992 way of representing the date and time of day).
993 .next
994 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
995 received the message.
996 .next
997 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
998 .olist
999 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1000 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1001 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1002 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1003 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1004 .next
1005 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1006 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1007 (1/100) of a second.
1008 .endlist
1009 .endlist
1010
1011 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1012 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1013 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1014 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1015 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1016
1017
1018 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1019 .cindex "receiving mail"
1020 .cindex "message" "reception"
1021 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1022 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1023 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1024 there are several possibilities:
1025
1026 .ilist
1027 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1028 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1029 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1030 .next
1031 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1032 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1033 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1034 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1035 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1036 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1037 .next
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1039 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1040 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1041 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1042 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1043 .next
1044 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1045 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1046 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1047 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1048 .endlist
1049
1050
1051 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1052 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1053 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1054 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1055 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1056 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1057 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1058 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1059 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1060 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1061 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1062 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1063 users to change sender addresses.
1064
1065 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1066 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1067 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1068 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1069 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1070 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1071 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1072
1073 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1074 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1075 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1076 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1077 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1078 message is received.
1079
1080
1081
1082
1083
1084 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1085 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1086 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1087 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1088 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1089 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1090 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1091 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1092
1093 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1094 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1095 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1096 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1097 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1098 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1099 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1100 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1101 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1102 affect file system performance.
1103
1104 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1105 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1106 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1107 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1108 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1109
1110 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1111 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1112 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1113 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1114 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1115 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1116 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1117 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1118 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1119 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1120 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1121 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1122
1123
1124
1125 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1126 .cindex "message" "life of"
1127 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1128 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1129 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1130 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1131 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1132 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1133 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1134
1135 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1136 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1137 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1138 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1139 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1140 to be sent.
1141
1142 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1143 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1144 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1145 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1146 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1147
1148 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1149 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1150 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1151 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1152 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1153 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1154 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1155 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1156 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1157 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1158 systems.
1159
1160 .cindex "journal file"
1161 .cindex "file" "journal"
1162 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1163 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1164 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1165 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1166 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1167 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1168 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1169 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1170
1171 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1172 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1173 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1174 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1175 deliveries caused by crashes.
1176
1177
1178
1179 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1180 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1181 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1182 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1183 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1184 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1185 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1186 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1187 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1188
1189 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1190 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1191 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1192 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1193 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1194 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1195 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1196 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1197 the driver's features in general.
1198
1199 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1200 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1201 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1202 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1203 to be bounced.
1204
1205 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1206 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1207 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1208 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1209 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1210 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1211
1212 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1213 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1214 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1215 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1216 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1217 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1218
1219 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1220 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1221 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1222 configuration.
1223
1224 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1225 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1226 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1227 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1228 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1229 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1230 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1231 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1232 configured to fail the address.
1233
1234 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1235 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1236 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1237 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1238 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1239 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1240
1241 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1242 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1243 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1244 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1245 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1246 the address is bounced.
1247
1248
1249
1250 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1251 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1252 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1253 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1254 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1255 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1256 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1257 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1258
1259 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1260 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1261 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1262 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1263 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1264 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1265 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1266 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1267
1268
1269
1270
1271 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1272 .cindex "router" "running details"
1273 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1274 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1275 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1276 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1277 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1278 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1279 the following:
1280
1281 .ilist
1282 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1283 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1284 original address ceases,
1285 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1286 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1287 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1288 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1289 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1290 end of routing.
1291
1292 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1293 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1294 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1295 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1296 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1297 .next
1298 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1299 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1300 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1301 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1302 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1303 .next
1304 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1305 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1306 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1307 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1308 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1309 .next
1310 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1311 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1312 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1313 .next
1314 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1315 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1316 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1317 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1318 .next
1319 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1320 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1321 .endlist
1322
1323 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1324 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1325 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1326 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1327 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1328
1329 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1330 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1331 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1332 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1333 facility for this purpose.
1334
1335
1336 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1337 .cindex "case of local parts"
1338 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1339 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1340 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1341 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1342 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1343 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1344 routed addresses are shown.
1345
1346
1347
1348 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1349 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1350 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1351 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1352 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1353 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1354
1355 .ilist
1356 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1357 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1358 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1359 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1360 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1361 of any other conditions.
1362 .next
1363 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1364 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1365 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1366 address.
1367 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1368 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1369 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1370 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1371 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1372 .next
1373 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1374 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1375 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1376 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1377 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1378 .next
1379 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1380 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1381 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1382 .next
1383 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1384 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1385 .next
1386 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1387 of domains that it defines.
1388 .next
1389 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1390 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1391 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1392 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1393 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1394 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1395 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1396 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1397 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1398 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1399 .next
1400 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1402 .vindex "&$home$&"
1403 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1404 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1405 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1406 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1407 remaining preconditions.
1408 .next
1409 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1410 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1411 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1412 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1413 could lead to confusion.
1414 .next
1415 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1416 set of addresses that it defines.
1417 .next
1418 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1419 specified files is tested.
1420 .next
1421 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1422 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1423 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1424 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1425 .endlist
1426
1427
1428 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1429 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1430 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1431 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1432 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1433 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1434 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1435
1436
1437
1438 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1439 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1440 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1441
1442 .ilist
1443 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1444 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1445 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1446 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1447 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1448 filtering'&.
1449 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1450 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1451
1452 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1453 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1454 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1455 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1456 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1457 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1458 filter.
1459 .next
1460 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1461 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1462 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1463 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1464 processed entirely independently of each other.
1465 .next
1466 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1467 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1468 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1469 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1470 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1471 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1472 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1473 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1474 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1475 .next
1476 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1477 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1478 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1479 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1480 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1481 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1482 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1483 addresses to the same domain.
1484 .next
1485 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1486 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1487 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1488 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1489 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1490 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1491 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1492 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1493 .next
1494 .cindex "queue runner"
1495 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1496 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1497 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1498 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1499 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1500 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1501 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1502 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1503 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1504 .next
1505 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1506 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1507 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1508 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1509 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1510 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1511 .next
1512 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1513 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1514 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1515 messages to other addresses.
1516 .next
1517 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1518 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1519 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1520 &'deferred'&.
1521 .next
1522 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1523 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1524 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1525 .endlist
1526
1527
1528
1529
1530 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1531 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1532 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1533 .cindex "queue runner"
1534 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1535 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1536 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1537 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1538 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1539 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1540 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1541 passed its retry time.
1542 You can run several queue runners at once.
1543
1544 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1545 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1546 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1547 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1548 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1549 as permanent.
1550
1551
1552
1553 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1554 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1555 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1556 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1557 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1558 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1559 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1560 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1561 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1562 also apply.
1563
1564 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1565 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1566 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1567 deferred,
1568 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1569 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1570 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1571 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1572 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1573 one connection.
1574
1575
1576
1577 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1578 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1579 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1580 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1581 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1582 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1583 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1584 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1585 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1586 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1587 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1588
1589 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1590 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1591 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1592 automatically.
1593
1594 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1595 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1596 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1597 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1598 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1599 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1600 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1601 of the list.
1602
1603
1604
1605 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1606 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1607 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1608 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1609 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1610 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1611 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1612 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1613
1614
1615
1616
1617
1618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1620
1621 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1622 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1623
1624 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1625 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1626 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1627 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1628
1629 .table2 140pt
1630 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1631 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1632 documented"
1633 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1634 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1635 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1636 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1637 instructions"
1638 .endtable
1639
1640 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1641 following subdirectories are created:
1642
1643 .table2 140pt
1644 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1645 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1646 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1647 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1648 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1649 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1650 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1651 .endtable
1652
1653 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1654 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1655 that may be useful to some sites.
1656
1657
1658 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1659 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1660 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1661 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1662 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1663 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1664 system.
1665 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1666 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1667 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1668 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1669 overridden if necessary.
1670 .cindex compiler requirements
1671 .cindex compiler version
1672 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1673
1674
1675 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1676 .cindex "PCRE library"
1677 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1678 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1679 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1680 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1681 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1682 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1683 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1684 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1685 If your operating system has no
1686 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1687 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1688 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1689
1690 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1691 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1692 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1693 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1694 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1695 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1696 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1697
1698 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1699 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1700 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1701 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1702 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1703 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1704 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1705 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1706
1707 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1708 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1709 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1710 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1711 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1712 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1713 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1714 Berkeley DB library.
1715
1716 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1717 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1718 possibilities:
1719
1720 .olist
1721 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1722 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1723 .next
1724 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1725 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1726 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1727 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1728 file name is used unmodified.
1729 .next
1730 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1731 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1732 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1733 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1734 .next
1735 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1736 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1737 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1738 .next
1739 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1740 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1741 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1742 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1743 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1744 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1745 .next
1746 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1747 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1748 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1749 operates on a single file.
1750 .endlist
1751
1752 .cindex "USE_DB"
1753 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1754 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1755 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1756 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1757 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1758 .code
1759 USE_DB=yes
1760 .endd
1761 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1762 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1763
1764 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1765 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1766 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1767 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1768 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1769 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1770
1771 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1772 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1773 in one of these lines:
1774 .code
1775 DBMLIB = -ldb
1776 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1777 .endd
1778 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1779 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1780 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1781 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1782 this example:
1783 .code
1784 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1785 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1786 .endd
1787 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1788 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1789
1790
1791
1792 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1793 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1794 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1795 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1796 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1797 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1798 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1799 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1800 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1801 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1802 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1803 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1804
1805 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1806 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1807 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1808 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1809 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1810 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1811
1812 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1813 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1814 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1815 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1816 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1817 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1818 be logged.
1819
1820 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1821 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1822 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1823 facilities, you need to set
1824 .code
1825 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1826 .endd
1827 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1828 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1829
1830
1831 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1832 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1833 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1834 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1835 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1836 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1837 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1838
1839 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1840 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1841 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1842 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1843 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1844 do this.
1845
1846
1847
1848 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1849 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1850 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1851 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1852 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1853 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1854 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1855 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1856 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1857 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1858
1859 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1860 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1861 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1862 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1863 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1864 .code
1865 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1866 .endd
1867 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1868
1869
1870
1871 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1872 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1873 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1874 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1875 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1876 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1877 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1878 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1879 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1880 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1881 line option).
1882
1883 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1884 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1885 implementing SSL.
1886
1887 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1888 .code
1889 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1890 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1891 .endd
1892 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1893 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1894 .code
1895 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1896 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1897 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1898 .endd
1899 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1900 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1904 .endd
1905 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1906 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1907 .code
1908 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1909 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1910 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1911 .endd
1912 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1913 library and include files. For example:
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1919 .endd
1920 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1921 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1922 .code
1923 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1924 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1925 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1926 .endd
1927
1928 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1929 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1930 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1931
1932
1933
1934
1935 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1936
1937 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1938 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1939 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1940 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1941 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1942 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1943 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1944 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1945 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1946 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1947 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1948 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1949 you might have
1950 .code
1951 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1952 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1953 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1954 .endd
1955 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1956 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1957 .code
1958 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1959 .endd
1960 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1961 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1962 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1963 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1964 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1965 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1966 further details.
1967
1968
1969 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1970 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1971 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1972 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1973 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1974 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1975 library files.
1976
1977 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1978 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1979 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1980 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1981 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1982 Exim used to
1983 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1984 withdrawn.
1985
1986
1987
1988 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1989 .cindex "lookup modules"
1990 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1991 .cindex ".so building"
1992 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1993 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1994 on demand.
1995 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1996 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1997 dependencies.
1998 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1999
2000 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2001 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2002 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2003 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2004 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2005 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2006
2007 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2008 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2009 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2010 on demand:
2011 .code
2012 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2013 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2014 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2015 .endd
2016
2017
2018 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2019 .cindex "build directory"
2020 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2021 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2022 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2023 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2024 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2025 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2026 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2027
2028 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2029 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2030 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2031 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2032 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2033 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2034 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2035 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2036
2037 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2038 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2039 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2040
2041
2042
2043 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2044 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2045 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2046 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2047 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2048 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2049 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2050 .code
2051 FULLECHO='' make -e
2052 .endd
2053 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2054 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2055 given in addition to the short output.
2056
2057
2058
2059 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2060 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2061 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2062 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2063 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2064 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2065 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2066 order:
2067 .display
2068 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2069 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2070 &_Local/Makefile_&
2071 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2072 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2073 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2074 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2075 .endd
2076 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2077 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2078 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2079 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2080 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2081 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2082 and are often not needed.
2083
2084 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2085 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2086 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2087 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2088 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2089 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2090 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2091 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2092 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2093
2094
2095 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2096 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2097 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2098 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2099 default values are.
2100
2101
2102 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2103 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2104 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2105 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2106 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2107 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2108 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2109 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2110 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2111 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2112 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2113 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2114 containing the lines
2115 .code
2116 CC=cc
2117 CFLAGS=-std1
2118 .endd
2119 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2120 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2121
2122 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2123 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2124 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2125
2126
2127 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2128 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2129 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2130 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2131 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2132 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2133 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2134 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2135 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2136 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2137 .code
2138 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2139 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2140 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2141 .endd
2142 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2143 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2144 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2145 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2146 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2147 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2148 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2149 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2150 errors.
2151
2152 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2153 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2154 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2155 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2156 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2157 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2158 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2159 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2160 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2161 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2162 syntax. For instance:
2163 .code
2164 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2165 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2166 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2167 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2168 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2169 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2170 .endd
2171
2172 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2173 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2174 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2175 .code
2176 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2177 .endd
2178 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2179 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2180
2181 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2182 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2183 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2184 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2185 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2186 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2187 .code
2188 X11=/usr/X11R6
2189 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2190 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2191 .endd
2192 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2193 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2194 .code
2195 X11=/usr/openwin
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2198 .endd
2199 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2200 definition of all three of these variables into your
2201 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2202
2203 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2204 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2205 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2206 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2207 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2208
2209 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2210 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2211 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2212 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2213 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2214 libraries.
2215
2216 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2217 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2218 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2219 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2220 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2221
2222
2223 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2224 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2225 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2226 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2227 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2228 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2229 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2230 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2231
2232
2233
2234 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2235 .cindex "building Eximon"
2236 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2237 where the files that are involved are
2238 .display
2239 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2240 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2241 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2242 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2243 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2244 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2245 .endd
2246 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2247 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2248 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2250 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2251 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2252 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2253 .ecindex IIDbuex
2254
2255
2256 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2257 .cindex "installing Exim"
2258 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2259 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2260 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2261 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2262 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2263 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2264 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2265 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2266 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2267 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2268 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2269 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2270
2271 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2272 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2273 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2274 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2275 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2276 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2277 alternative files, no default is installed.
2278
2279 .cindex "system aliases file"
2280 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2281 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2282 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2283 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2284 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2285 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2286 and outputs a comment to the user.
2287
2288 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2289 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2290 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2291 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2292 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2293
2294 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2295 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2296 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2297 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2298 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2299 over SMTP.
2300
2301 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2302 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2303 command such as
2304 .code
2305 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2306 .endd
2307 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2308 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2309 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2310 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2311 but this usage is deprecated.
2312
2313 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2314 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2315 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2316 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2317 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2318 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2319
2320 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2321 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2322 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2323 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2324 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2325 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2326 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2327
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2329 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2330 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2331 command:
2332 .code
2333 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2334 .endd
2335 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2336 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2337 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2338 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2339 command:
2340 .code
2341 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2342 .endd
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2344 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2345
2346 .ilist
2347 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2348 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2349 .next
2350 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2351 installed binary.
2352 .endlist
2353
2354 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2355 .code
2356 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2357 .endd
2358 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2359 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2360 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2361 .code
2362 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2363 .endd
2364
2365
2366
2367 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2368 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2369 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2370 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2371 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2372 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2373
2374 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2375 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2376 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2377
2378
2379
2380 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2381 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2382 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2383 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2384 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2385 necessary.
2386
2387
2388
2389
2390 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2391 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2392 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2393 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2394 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2395 .code
2396 exim -bV
2397 .endd
2398 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2399 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2400 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2401 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2402 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2403 example,
2404 .display
2405 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2406 .endd
2407 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2408 .display
2409 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2410 .endd
2411 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2412 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2413 user agent. For example:
2414 .code
2415 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2416 From: user@your.domain.example
2417 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2418 Subject: Testing Exim
2419
2420 This is a test message.
2421 ^D
2422 .endd
2423 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2424 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2425 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2426
2427 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2428 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2429 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2430 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2431 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2432 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2433 .display
2434 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2435 .endd
2436 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2437 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2438 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2439 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2440 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2441
2442 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2443 .cindex "lock files"
2444 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2445 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2446 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2447 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2448 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2449 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2450 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2451 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2452 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2453 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2454 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2455 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2456
2457 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2458 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2459 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2460 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2461 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2462 incoming SMTP mail.
2463
2464 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2465 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2466 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2467 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2468 production version.
2469
2470
2471 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2472 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2473 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2474 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2475 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2476 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2477 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2478 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2479 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2480 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2481 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2482 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2483 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2484
2485 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2486 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2487 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2488 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2489 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2490 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2491 as follows:
2492 .code
2493 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2494 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2495 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2496 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2497 .endd
2498 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2499 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2500 favourite user agent.
2501
2502 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2503 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2504 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2505 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2506 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2507 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2508
2509
2510
2511 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2512 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2513 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2514 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2515 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2516 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2517 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2518 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2519 configuration file.
2520
2521
2522
2523
2524 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2525 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2526 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2527 .code
2528 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2529 .endd
2530 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2531 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2532 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2533 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2534 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2535 .code
2536 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2537 .endd
2538 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2539
2540 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2541 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2542 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2543
2544
2545
2546
2547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2549
2550 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2551 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2552 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2553 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2554 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2555 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2556 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2557 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2558 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2559
2560
2561 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2562 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2563 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2564 were present before any other options.
2565 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2566 standard output.
2567 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2568 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2569 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2570
2571 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2572 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2573 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2574 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2575 format.
2576
2577 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2578 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2579 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2580 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2581
2582 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2583 .cindex "queue runner"
2584 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2585 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2586 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2587
2588 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2589 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2590 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2592 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2593 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2594 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2595 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2596
2597
2598 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2599 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2600 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2601 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2602 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2603 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2604
2605 .ilist
2606 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2607 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2608 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2609 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2610 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2611 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2612
2613 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2614 .cindex "envelope sender"
2615 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2616 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2617 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2618 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2619 users to set envelope senders.
2620
2621 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2622 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2623 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2624 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2625 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2626 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2627 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2628
2629 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2630 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2631 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2632 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2633 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2634 that are available to trusted users.
2635 .next
2636 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2637 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2638 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2639 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2640 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2641
2642 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2643 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2644 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2645 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2646
2647 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2648 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2649 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2650 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2651
2652 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2653 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2654 false.
2655 .endlist
2656
2657
2658 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2659 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2660 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2661 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2662
2663
2664
2665
2666 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2667 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2668 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2669 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2670 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2671 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2672 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2673 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2674
2675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2676 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2677 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2678 . creates a man page for the options.
2679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2680
2681 .literal xml
2682 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2683 .literal off
2684
2685
2686 .vlist
2687 .vitem &%--%&
2688 .oindex "--"
2689 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2690 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2691 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2692 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2693
2694 .vitem &%--help%&
2695 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2696 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2697 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2698 no arguments.
2699
2700 .vitem &%--version%&
2701 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2702 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2703 displayed.
2704
2705 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2706 &%-Am%&
2707 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2708 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2709 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2710 ignored by Exim.
2711
2712 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2713 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2714 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2715 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2716 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2717 clean; it ignores this option.
2718
2719 .vitem &%-bd%&
2720 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2721 .cindex "daemon"
2722 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2723 .cindex "queue runner"
2724 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2725 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2726 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2727
2728 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2729 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2730 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2731 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2732
2733 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2734 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2735 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2736 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2737
2738 When a listening daemon
2739 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2740 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2741 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2742 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2743 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2744 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2745 running as root.
2746
2747 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2748 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2749 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2750
2751 The SIGHUP signal
2752 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2753 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2754 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2755 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2756 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2757 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2758 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2759 because these are reread each time they are used.
2760
2761 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2762 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2763 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2764 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2765
2766 .vitem &%-be%&
2767 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2768 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2769 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2770 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2771 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2772 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2773 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2774
2775 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2776 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2777 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2778 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2779 test data. A line history is supported.
2780
2781 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2782 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2783 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2784 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2785 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2786 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2787 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2788
2789 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2790 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2791 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2792 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2793
2794 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2795 defined and macros will be expanded.
2796 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2797 available to admin users.
2798
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2805 .code
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807 .endd
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815 &%-be%&).
2816
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2824
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835 supplied.
2836
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840 .code
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842 .endd
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847 .code
2848 # Exim filter
2849 # Sieve filter
2850 .endd
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854 redirection lists.
2855
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869 options).
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876 &$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2885
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890 prefix.
2891
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896 suffix.
2897
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2909 .code
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912 .endd
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924 &*Warning 1*&:
2925 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929 connection.
2930
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2941
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957 .vitem &%-bi%&
2958 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966 recognized.
2967
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002 .vitem &%-bm%&
3003 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024 The format
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032 .code
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035 .endd
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3053 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3054 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3055 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3056 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3057 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3058 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3059
3060 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3061 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3062 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3063 This option requires admin privileges.
3064
3065 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3066 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3067 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3068
3069 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3070 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3071 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3072 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3073 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3074 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3075 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3076 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3077 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3078
3079 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3080 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3081 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3082 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3083 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3084
3085 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3086 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3087 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3088 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3089
3090
3091 .vitem &%-bP%&
3092 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3093 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3094 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3095 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3096 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3097 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3098 arguments, for example:
3099 .code
3100 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3101 .endd
3102 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3103 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3104 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3105 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3106 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3107 users, the output is as in this example:
3108 .code
3109 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3110 .endd
3111 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3112 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3113
3114 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3115 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3116 backward compatibility.)
3117 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3118 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3119
3120 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3121 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3122 name will not be output.
3123
3124 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3125 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3126 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3127 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3128 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3129 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3130 written directly into the spool directory.
3131
3132 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3133 .code
3134 exim -bP +local_domains
3135 .endd
3136 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3137 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3138
3139 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3140 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3141 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3142 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3143 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3144 that driver are output. For example:
3145 .code
3146 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3147 .endd
3148 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3149 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3150 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3151 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3152 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3153 &%authenticators%&.
3154
3155 .cindex "environment"
3156 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3157 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3158 variables.
3159
3160 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3161 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3162 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3163 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3164 The output format is one item per line.
3165 .new
3166 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3167 the exit status will be nonzero.
3168 .wen
3169
3170 .vitem &%-bp%&
3171 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3172 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3173 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3174 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3175 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3176 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3177 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3178 to allow any user to see the queue.
3179
3180 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3181 .code
3182 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3183 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3184 <other addresses>
3185 .endd
3186 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3187 .cindex "size" "of message"
3188 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3189 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3190 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3191 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3192 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3193 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3194 before the sender address.
3195
3196 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3197 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3198 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3199
3200 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3201 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3202 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3203 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3204 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3205 complete.
3206
3207
3208 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3209 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3210 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3211 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3212 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3213 of just &"D"&.
3214
3215
3216 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3217 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3218 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3219 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3220 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3221 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3222
3223
3224 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3225 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3226 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3227 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3228 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3229 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3230
3231 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3232 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3233 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3234
3235 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3236 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3237 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3238
3239
3240 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3241 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3242 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3243 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3244 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3245 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3246
3247
3248 .vitem &%-brt%&
3249 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3250 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3251 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3252 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3253 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3254 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3255 .code
3256 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3257 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3258 .endd
3259 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3260 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3261 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3262 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3263 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3264 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3265 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3266 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3267 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3268 .code
3269 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3270 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3271 .endd
3272
3273 .vitem &%-brw%&
3274 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3275 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3276 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3277 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3278 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3279 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3280 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3281 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3282
3283 .vitem &%-bS%&
3284 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3285 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3286 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3287 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3288 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3289 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3290 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3291 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3292 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3293 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3294
3295 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3296 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3297 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3298
3299 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3300 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3301 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3302 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3303
3304 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3305 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3306 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3307
3308 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3309 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3310 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3311 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3312 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3313
3314 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3315 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3316
3317 .vitem &%-bs%&
3318 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3319 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3320 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3321 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3322 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3323 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3324 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3325 messages to the MTA.
3326
3327 In
3328 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3329 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3330 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3331 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3332 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3333 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3334 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3335
3336 .cindex "inetd"
3337 The
3338 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3339 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3340 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3341 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3342 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3343 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3344 the listening daemon.
3345
3346 .vitem &%-bt%&
3347 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3348 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3349 .cindex "address" "testing"
3350 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3351 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3352 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3353 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3354 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3355
3356 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3357 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3358
3359 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3360 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3361 security issues.
3362
3363 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3364 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3365 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3366 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3367 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3368 program.
3369
3370 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3371 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3372 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3373 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3374
3375 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3376 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3377 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3378 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3379 always shown.
3380
3381 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3382 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3383 message,
3384 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3385 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3386 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3387 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3388 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3389 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3390 doing such tests.
3391
3392 .vitem &%-bV%&
3393 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3394 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3395 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3396 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3397 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3398 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3399 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3400
3401 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3402 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3403 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3404 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3405 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3406 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3407 dynamic testing facilities.
3408
3409 .vitem &%-bv%&
3410 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3411 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3412 .cindex "address" "verification"
3413 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3414 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3415 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3416 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3417 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3418 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3419
3420 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3421 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3422 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3423
3424 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3425 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3426
3427 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3428 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3429 security issues.
3430
3431 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3432 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3433 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3434 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3435 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3436
3437 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3438 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3439 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3440 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3441 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3442 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3443 to succeed.
3444
3445 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3446 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3447 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3448
3449 The
3450 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3451 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3452 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3453 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3454
3455 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3456 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3457 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3458 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3459
3460 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3461 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3462 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3463 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3464 might happen.
3465
3466 .vitem &%-bw%&
3467 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3468 .cindex "daemon"
3469 .cindex "inetd"
3470 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3471 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3472 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3473 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3474
3475 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3476 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3477 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3478 each port only when the first connection is received.
3479
3480 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3481 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3482
3483 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3484 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3485 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3486 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3487 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3488 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3489 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3490 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3491 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3492 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3493 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3494
3495 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3496 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3497 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3498 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3499 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3500 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3501 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3502 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3503 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3504
3505 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3506 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3507 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3508 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3509 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3510 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3511 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3512
3513 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3514 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3515 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3516 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3517 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3518 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3519 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3520
3521 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3522 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3523 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3524 configuration file.
3525
3526 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3527 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3528 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3529 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3530 specified by this option.
3531
3532
3533 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3534 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3535 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3536 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3537 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3538 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3539 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3540 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3541
3542 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3543 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3544 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3545 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3546 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3547 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3548 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3549
3550 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3551 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3552 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3553 synonymous:
3554 .code
3555 exim -DABC ...
3556 exim -DABC= ...
3557 .endd
3558 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3559 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3560 example:
3561 .code
3562 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3563 .endd
3564 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3565 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3566
3567
3568 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3569 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3570 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3571 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3572 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3573 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3574 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3575 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3576 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3577 return code.
3578
3579 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3580 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3581 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3582 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3583 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3584 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3585 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3586 are:
3587 .display
3588 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3589 &`auth `& authenticators
3590 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3591 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3592 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3593 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3594 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3595 &`filter `& filter handling
3596 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3597 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3598 &`ident `& ident lookup
3599 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3600 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3601 &`load `& system load checks
3602 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3603 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3604 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3605 &`memory `& memory handling
3606 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3607 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3608 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3609 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3610 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3611 &`retry `& retry handling
3612 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3613 &`route `& address routing
3614 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3615 &`tls `& TLS logic
3616 &`transport `& transports
3617 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3618 &`verify `& address verification logic
3619 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3620 .endd
3621 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3622 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3623 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3624 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3625 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3626 turn everything off.
3627
3628 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3629 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3630 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3631 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3632 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3633 rather than stderr.
3634
3635 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3636 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3637 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3638 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3639 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3640 run in parallel.
3641
3642 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3643 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3644 in processing.
3645
3646 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3647 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3648
3649 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3650 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3651 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3652 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3653 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3654 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3655
3656 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3657 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3658 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3659 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3660 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3661
3662 .vitem &%-E%&
3663 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3664 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3665 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3666 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3667 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3668 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3669 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3670 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3671 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3672
3673 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3674 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3675 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3676 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3677 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3678 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3679
3680 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3681 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3682 .cindex "sender" "name"
3683 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3684 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3685 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3686 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3687 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3688 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3689
3690 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3691 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3692 .cindex "sender" "address"
3693 .cindex "address" "sender"
3694 .cindex "trusted users"
3695 .cindex "envelope sender"
3696 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3697 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3698 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3699 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3700 users to use it.
3701
3702 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3703 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3704 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3705 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3706 domain.
3707
3708 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3709 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3710 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3711 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3712 examples of shell commands:
3713 .code
3714 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3715 exim -f "" user@domain
3716 .endd
3717 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3718 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3719 &%-bv%& options.
3720
3721 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3722 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3723 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3724 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3725
3726 White
3727 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3728 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3729 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3730 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3731 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3732 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3733
3734 .vitem &%-G%&
3735 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3736 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3737 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3738 .code
3739 control = suppress_local_fixups
3740 .endd
3741 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3742 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3743 in future.
3744
3745 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3746 this option.
3747
3748 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3749 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3750 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3751 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3752 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3753 headers.)
3754
3755 .vitem &%-i%&
3756 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3757 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3758 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3759 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3760 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3761 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3762 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3763
3764 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3765 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3766 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3767 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3768 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3769 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3770 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3771 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3772
3773 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3774
3775 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3776 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3777 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3778 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3779 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3780 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3781 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3782 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3783 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3784
3785 Retry
3786 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3787 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3788 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3789 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3790 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3791 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3792
3793 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3794 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3795 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3796 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3797
3798 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3799 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3800 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3801 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3802 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3803 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3804 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3805 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3806 can be used only by an admin user.
3807
3808 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3809 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3810 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3811 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3812 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3813 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3814 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3815 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3816 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3817 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3818 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3819
3820 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3821 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3822 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3824 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3825
3826 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3827 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3828 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3829 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3830 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3831
3832 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3833 .oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3834 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3835 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3836 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3837
3838 .vitem &%-MCK%&
3839 .oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3840 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3841 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3842 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3843
3844 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3845 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3846 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3847 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3848 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3849
3850 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3851 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3852 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3853 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3854 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3855 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3856 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3857 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3858
3859 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3860 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3861 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3862 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3863 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3864 connection.
3865
3866 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3867 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3868 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3869 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3870 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3871
3872 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3873 .oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3874 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3875 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3876 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3877 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3878
3879 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3880 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3881 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3882 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3883 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3884 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3885 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3886 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3887 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3888 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3889 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3890 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3891 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3892 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3893 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3894
3895 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3896 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3897 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3898 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3899 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3900 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3901 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3902 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3903 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3904 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3905
3906 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3907 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3908 .cindex "freezing messages"
3909 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3910 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3911 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3912 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3913 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3914 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3915 user.
3916
3917 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3918 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3919 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3920 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3921 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3922 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3923 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3924 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3925 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3926 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3927 user.
3928
3929 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3930 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3931 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3932 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3933 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3934 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3935 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3936
3937 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3938 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3939 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3940 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3941 .cindex "removing recipients"
3942 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3943 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3944 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3945 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3946 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3947 can be used only by an admin user.
3948
3949 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3950 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3951 .cindex "removing messages"
3952 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3953 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3954 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3955 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3956 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3957 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3958 placed on the queue.
3959
3960 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3961 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3962 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3963 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3964 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3965 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3966 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3967 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3968 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3969 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3970 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3971
3972 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3973 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3974 .cindex "thawing messages"
3975 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3976 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3977 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3978 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3979 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3980 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3981 by an admin user.
3982
3983 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3984 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3985 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3986 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3987 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3988 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3989
3990 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3991 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3992 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3993 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3994 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3995 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3996 only by an admin user.
3997
3998 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3999 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4000 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4001 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4002 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4003 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4004 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4005
4006 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4007 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4008 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4009 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4010 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4011 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4012
4013 .vitem &%-m%&
4014 .oindex "&%-m%&"
4015 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4016 treats it that way too.
4017
4018 .vitem &%-N%&
4019 .oindex "&%-N%&"
4020 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4021 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4022 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4023 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4024 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4025 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4026 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4027 than &"=>"&.
4028
4029 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4030 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4031 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4032 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4033 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4034 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4035 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4036 for that message.
4037
4038 .vitem &%-n%&
4039 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4040 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4041 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4042 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4043 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4044
4045 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4046 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4047 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4048 Exim.
4049
4050 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4051 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4052 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4053 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4054 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4055 description above.
4056
4057 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4058 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4059 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4060 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4061 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4062 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4063 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4064 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4065
4066 .vitem &%-odb%&
4067 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4068 .cindex "background delivery"
4069 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4070 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4071 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4072 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4073 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4074 processes to finish.
4075
4076 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4077 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4078 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4079 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4080
4081 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4082 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4083 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4084 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4085
4086 .vitem &%-odf%&
4087 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4088 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4089 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4090 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4091 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4092 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4093 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4094
4095 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4096 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4097 during deliveries.
4098
4099 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4100 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4101
4102 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4103 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4104 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4105 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4106
4107
4108 .vitem &%-odi%&
4109 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4110 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4111 Sendmail.
4112
4113 .vitem &%-odq%&
4114 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4115 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4116 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4117 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4118 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4119 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4120 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4121 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4122 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4123 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4124 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4125 forces queueing.
4126
4127 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4128 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4129 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4130 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4131 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4132 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4133 configuration file is in effect.
4134
4135 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4136 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4137 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4138 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4139 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4140 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4141 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4142 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4143 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4144 &%-qq%& option.
4145
4146 .vitem &%-oee%&
4147 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4148 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4149 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4150 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4151 message.
4152
4153 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4154 Provided
4155 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4156 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4157 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4158 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4159
4160 .vitem &%-oem%&
4161 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4162 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4163 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4164 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4165 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4166 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4167
4168 .vitem &%-oep%&
4169 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4170 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4171 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4172 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4173 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4174 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4175
4176 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4177 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4178 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4179 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4180 effect as &%-oep%&.
4181
4182 .vitem &%-oew%&
4183 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4184 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4185 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4186 effect as &%-oem%&.
4187
4188 .vitem &%-oi%&
4189 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4190 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4191 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4192 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4193 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4194 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4195 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4196
4197 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4198 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4199 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4200
4201 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4202 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4203 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4204 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4205 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4206 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4207 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4208 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4209
4210 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4211 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4212 .code
4213 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4214 .endd
4215 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4216 followed by a colon and the port number:
4217 .code
4218 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4219 .endd
4220 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4221 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4222 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4223 whichever one is last.
4224
4225 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4226 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4227 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4228 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4229 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4230 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4231 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4232 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4233
4234 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4235 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4236 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4237 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4238 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4239 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4240 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4241 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4242
4243 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4244 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4245 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4246 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4247 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4248 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4249 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4250 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4251 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4252 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4253
4254 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4255 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4256 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4257 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4258 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4259 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4260 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4261
4262 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4263 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4264 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4265 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4266 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4267 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4268 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4269 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4270 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4271
4272 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4273 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4274 is sending the bounce.
4275
4276 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4277 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4278 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4279 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4280 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4281 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4282 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4283 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4284 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4285 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4286 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4287 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4288
4289 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4290 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4291 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4292 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4293 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4294 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4295 uses the name it is given.
4296
4297 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4298 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4299 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4300 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4301 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4302 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4303 used, when there is no default.
4304
4305 .vitem &%-om%&
4306 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4307 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4308 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4309 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4310 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4311
4312 .vitem &%-oo%&
4313 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4314 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4315 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4316 whatever that means.
4317
4318 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4319 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4320 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4321 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4322 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4323 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4324 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4325 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4326 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4327
4328 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4329 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4330 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4331 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4332 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4333 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4334 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4335
4336 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4337 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4338 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4339 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4340 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4341 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4342 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4343 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4344
4345 .vitem &%-ov%&
4346 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4347 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4348
4349 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4350 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4351 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4352 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4353 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4354 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4355 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4356 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4357 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4358 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4359
4360 .vitem &%-pd%&
4361 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4362 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4363 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4364 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4365 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4366 needed.
4367
4368 .vitem &%-ps%&
4369 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4370 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4371 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4372 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4373 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4374 started.
4375
4376 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4377 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4378 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4379 .display
4380 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4381 .endd
4382 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4383 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4384 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4385 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4386 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4387 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4388
4389 .vitem &%-q%&
4390 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4391 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4392 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4393 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4394 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4395 and &%-S%& options).
4396
4397 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4398 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4399 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4400 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4401 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4402 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4403 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4404
4405 If
4406 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4407 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4408 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4409 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4410 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4411 proceeding.
4412
4413 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4414 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4415 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4416 this to be repeated periodically.
4417
4418 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4419 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4420 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4421 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4422
4423 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4424 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4425 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4426
4427 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4428 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4429 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4430 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4431
4432 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4433 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4434 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4435 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4436 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4437 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4438 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4439 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4440 transports are run.
4441
4442 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4443 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4444 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4445 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4446 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4447 delivered down a single SMTP
4448 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4449 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4450 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4451 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4452 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4453 intermittently.
4454
4455 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4456 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4457 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4458 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4459 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4460 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4461 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4462
4463 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4464 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4465 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4466 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4467 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4468 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4469 their retry times are tried.
4470
4471 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4472 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4473 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4474 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4475 frozen or not.
4476
4477 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4478 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4479 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4480 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4481 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4482 for later delivery.
4483
4484 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4485 .oindex "&%-qG%&"
4486 .cindex queue named
4487 .cindex "named queues"
4488 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4489 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4490 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4491 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4492 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4493 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4494
4495 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4496 will specify a queue to operate on.
4497 For example:
4498 .code
4499 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4500 mailq -qGquarantine
4501 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4502 .endd
4503
4504 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4505 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4506 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4507 starting message id. For example:
4508 .code
4509 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4510 .endd
4511 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4512 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4513 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4514 .code
4515 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4516 .endd
4517 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4518 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4519 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4520 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4521 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4522 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4523
4524 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4525 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4526 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4527 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4528 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4529 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4530 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4531 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4532 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4533 .code
4534 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4535 .endd
4536 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4537 process every 30 minutes.
4538
4539 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4540 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4541
4542 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4543 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4544 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4545 compatibility.
4546
4547 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4548 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4549 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4550
4551 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4552 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4553 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4554 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4555 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4556 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4557 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4558 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4559 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4560
4561 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4562 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4563 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4564 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4565 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4566 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4567
4568 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4569 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4570 .code
4571 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4572 .endd
4573 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4574 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4575 applied to each queue run.
4576
4577 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4578 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4579 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4580 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4581 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4582 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4583 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4584 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4585 address will be skipped.
4586
4587 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4588 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4589 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4590 &'ff'& is present.
4591
4592 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4593 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4594 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4595 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4596 an arbitrary command instead.
4597
4598 .vitem &%-r%&
4599 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4600 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4601
4602 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4603 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4604 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4605 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4606 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4607 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4608 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4609 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4610
4611 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4612 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4613 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4614 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4615 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4616
4617 .vitem &%-t%&
4618 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4619 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4620 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4621 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4622 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4623 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4624 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4625 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4626 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4627 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4628
4629 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4630 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4631 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4632 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4633 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4634 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4635 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4636 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4637 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4638 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4639 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4640
4641 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4642 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4643 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4644 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4645 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4646 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4647
4648 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4649 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4650 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4651 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4652 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4653 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4654 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4655 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4656 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4657
4658 .vitem &%-ti%&
4659 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4660 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4661 compatibility with Sendmail.
4662
4663 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4664 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4665 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4666 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4667 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4668 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4669 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4670 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4671
4672
4673 .vitem &%-U%&
4674 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4675 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4676 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4677 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4678 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4679 set. Exim ignores this option.
4680
4681 .vitem &%-v%&
4682 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4683 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4684 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4685 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4686 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4687 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4688 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4689 unconditional.
4690
4691 .vitem &%-x%&
4692 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4693 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4694 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4695 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4696 this option.
4697
4698 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4699 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4700 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4701 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4702
4703 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4704 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4705 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4706 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4707 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4708 under most shells.
4709 .endlist
4710
4711 .ecindex IIDclo1
4712 .ecindex IIDclo2
4713
4714
4715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4716 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4717 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4718 . creates a man page for the options.
4719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4720
4721 .literal xml
4722 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4723 .literal off
4724
4725
4726
4727
4728
4729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4731
4732
4733 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4734 "The runtime configuration file"
4735
4736 .cindex "run time configuration"
4737 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4738 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4739 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4740 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4741 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4742 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4743 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4744 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4745 control.
4746
4747 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4748 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4749 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4750 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4751 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4752 actually alter the string.
4753
4754 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4755 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4756 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4757 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4758 existing file in the list.
4759
4760 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4761 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4762 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4763 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4764 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4765 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4766 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4767 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4768 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4769 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4770 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4771
4772 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4773 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4774 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4775 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4776 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4777
4778 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4779 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4780 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4781 compromise the Exim user account.
4782
4783 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4784 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4785 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4786 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4787 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4788 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4789 configuration.
4790
4791
4792
4793 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4794 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4795 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4796 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4797 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4798 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4799 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4800 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4801 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4802 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4803 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4804
4805 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4806 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4807 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4808 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4809 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4810 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4811 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4812 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4813 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4814 &%-M%&).
4815
4816 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4817 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4818 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4819 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4820 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4821
4822 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4823 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4824 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4825 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4826 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4827 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4828
4829 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4830 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4831 necessarily be discarded.
4832 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4833 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4834 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4835 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4836 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4837 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4838
4839 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4840 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4841 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4842 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4843 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4844 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4845 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4846
4847 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4848 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4849 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4850
4851
4852
4853 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4854 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4855 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4856 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4857 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4858 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4859 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4860 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4861
4862 .ilist
4863 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4864 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4865 .next
4866 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4867 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4868 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4869 .next
4870 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4871 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4872 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4873 .next
4874 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4875 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4876 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4877 .next
4878 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4879 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4880 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4881 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4882 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4883 .next
4884 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4885 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4886 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4887 .next
4888 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4889 want to use this feature, you must set
4890 .code
4891 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4892 .endd
4893 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4894 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4895 .endlist
4896
4897 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4898 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4899 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4900 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4901
4902 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4903 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4904 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4905 and does not introduce a comment.
4906
4907 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4908 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4909 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4910 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4911 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4912
4913 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4914 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4915 change settings as required.
4916
4917 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4918 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4919 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4920 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4921 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4922 described.
4923
4924
4925
4926 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4927 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4928 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4929 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4930 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4931 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4932 using this syntax:
4933 .display
4934 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4935 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4936 .endd
4937 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4938 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4939 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4940 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4941 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4942 name is required.
4943
4944 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4945 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4946 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4947 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4948
4949 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4950 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4951 for example:
4952 .code
4953 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4954 .include /some/file
4955 .endd
4956 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4957 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4958 inclusion appears.
4959
4960
4961
4962 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4963 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4964 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4965 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4966 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4967 definition, and must be of the form
4968 .display
4969 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4970 .endd
4971 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4972 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4973 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4974 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4975 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4976
4977 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4978 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4979 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4980
4981 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4982 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4983 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4984 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4985 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4986 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4987 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4988 define
4989 .display
4990 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4991 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4992 .endd
4993 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4994 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4995 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4996 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4997 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4998 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4999
5000
5001 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5002 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5003 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5004 &'='&. For example:
5005 .code
5006 MAC = initial value
5007 ...
5008 MAC == updated value
5009 .endd
5010 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5011 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5012 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5013 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5014 .code
5015 MAC = initial value
5016 ...
5017 MAC == MAC and something added
5018 .endd
5019 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5020 from a number of other files.
5021
5022 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5023 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5024 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5025 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5026 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5027 file to be ignored.
5028
5029
5030
5031 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5032 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5033 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5034 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5035 .code
5036 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5037 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5038 .endd
5039 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5040 .code
5041 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5042 .endd
5043 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5044 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5045 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5046
5047
5048 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5049 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5050 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5051 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5052 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5053 (see below).
5054
5055 The following classes of macros are defined:
5056 .display
5057 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5058 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5059 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5060 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5061 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5062 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5063 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5064 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5065 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5066 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5067 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5068 .endd
5069
5070 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5071
5072
5073 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5074 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5075 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5076 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5077 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5078 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5079 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5080
5081 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5082 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5083 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5084 line. Thus:
5085 .code
5086 .ifdef AAA
5087 message_size_limit = 50M
5088 .else
5089 message_size_limit = 100M
5090 .endif
5091 .endd
5092 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5093 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5094 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5095 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5096 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5097
5098 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5099 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5100 in this line"& will always be true.
5101
5102 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5103 to clarify complicated nestings.
5104
5105
5106
5107 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5108 .cindex "common option syntax"
5109 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5110 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5111 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5112 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5113 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5114 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5115 space) and then the value. For example:
5116 .code
5117 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5118 .endd
5119 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5120 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5121 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5122 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5123 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5124 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5125 word &"hide"&. For example:
5126 .code
5127 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5128 .endd
5129 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5130 .code
5131 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5132 .endd
5133 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5134 all instances of the same driver.
5135
5136 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5137 that are found in option settings.
5138
5139
5140 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5141 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5142 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5143 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5144 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5145 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5146 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5147 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5148 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5149 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5150 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5151 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5152 .code
5153 queue_only
5154 queue_only = true
5155 .endd
5156 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5157 .code
5158 no_queue_only
5159 queue_only = false
5160 .endd
5161 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5162
5163
5164
5165
5166 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5167 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5168 .cindex "format" "integer"
5169 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5170 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5171 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5172 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5173 hexadecimal number.
5174
5175 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5176 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5177 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5178 When the values
5179 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5180 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5181 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5182 used.
5183
5184
5185 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5186 .cindex "integer format"
5187 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5188 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5189 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5190 Such options are always output in octal.
5191
5192
5193 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5194 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5195 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5196 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5197 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5198
5199
5200
5201 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5202 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5203 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5204 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5205 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5206
5207 .table2 30pt
5208 .irow &%s%& seconds
5209 .irow &%m%& minutes
5210 .irow &%h%& hours
5211 .irow &%d%& days
5212 .irow &%w%& weeks
5213 .endtable
5214
5215 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5216 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5217 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5218
5219
5220
5221 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5222 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5223 .cindex "format" "string"
5224 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5225 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5226 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5227 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5228 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5229 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5230 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5231 therefore equivalent:
5232 .code
5233 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5234 trusted_users = uucp:\
5235 # This comment line is ignored
5236 mail
5237 .endd
5238 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5239 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5240 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5241 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5242 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5243
5244 .table2 100pt
5245 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5246 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5247 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5248 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5249 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5250 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5251 character"
5252 .endtable
5253
5254 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5255 character, that character replaces the pair.
5256
5257 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5258 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5259 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5260 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5261 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5262 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5263
5264
5265 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5266 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5267 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5268 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5269 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5270 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5271 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5272 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5273 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5274 within a quoted configuration string.
5275
5276
5277 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5278 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5279 .cindex "format" "user name"
5280 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5281 .cindex "format" "group name"
5282 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5283 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5284 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5285 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5286
5287
5288 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5289 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5290 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5291 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5292 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5293 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5294 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5295 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5296 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5297 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5298 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5299
5300 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5301 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5302 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5303 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5304 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5305 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5306 example, the list
5307 .code
5308 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5309 .endd
5310 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5311
5312 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5313 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5314 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5315 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5316
5317 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5318 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5319 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5320 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5321 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5322 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5323 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5324 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5325 .code
5326 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5327 .endd
5328 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5329 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5330 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5331
5332 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5333 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5334 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5335 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5336 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5337 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5338 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5339 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5340 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5341 .code
5342 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5343 .endd
5344 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5345 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5346 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5347 the value in quotes. For example:
5348 .code
5349 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5350 .endd
5351 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5352 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5353 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5354 enclosing an empty list item.
5355
5356
5357
5358 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5359 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5360 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5361 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5362 .code
5363 senders = user@domain :
5364 .endd
5365 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5366 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5367 items, the second of which is empty:
5368 .code
5369 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5370 .endd
5371 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5372 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5373 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5374 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5375 .code
5376 senders = :
5377 .endd
5378 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5379 is at the end of the list.
5380
5381
5382
5383
5384 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5385 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5386 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5387 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5388 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5389 a sequence of lines like this:
5390 .display
5391 <&'instance name'&>:
5392 <&'option'&>
5393 ...
5394 <&'option'&>
5395 .endd
5396 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5397 followed by three options settings:
5398 .code
5399 localuser:
5400 driver = accept
5401 check_local_user
5402 transport = local_delivery
5403 .endd
5404 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5405 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5406 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5407 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5408 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5409 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5410
5411 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5412 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5413
5414 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5415 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5416 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5417 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5418 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5419 server.
5420
5421 .cindex "generic options"
5422 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5423 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5424 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5425 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5426 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5427 .cindex "private options"
5428 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5429 they all have default values.
5430
5431 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5432 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5433 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5434
5435 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5436 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5437 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5438 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5439 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5440 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5441 configuration lines:
5442 .code
5443 remote_smtp:
5444 driver = smtp
5445 .endd
5446 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5447 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5448 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5449 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5450 thus:
5451 .code
5452 special_smtp:
5453 driver = smtp
5454 port = 1234
5455 command_timeout = 10s
5456 .endd
5457 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5458 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5459 lines.
5460
5461 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5462 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5463 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5464 option.
5465
5466
5467
5468
5469
5470
5471 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5472 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5473
5474 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5475 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5476 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5477 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5478 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5479 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5480 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5481 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5482 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5483 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5484 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5485
5486
5487
5488 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5489 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5490 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5491 the line
5492 .code
5493 # primary_hostname =
5494 .endd
5495 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5496 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5497 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5498 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5499
5500 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5501 .code
5502 domainlist local_domains = @
5503 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5504 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5505 .endd
5506 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5507 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5508 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5509 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5510
5511 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5512 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5513 on the local host.
5514
5515 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5516 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5517 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5518 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5519 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5520 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5521
5522 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5523 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5524 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5525 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5526 domain is permitted.
5527
5528 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5529 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5530 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5531 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5532 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5533 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5534
5535 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5536 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5537 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5538
5539 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5540 .code
5541 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5542 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5543 .endd
5544 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5545 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5546 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5547 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5548 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5549 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5550 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5551 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5552 contents of a message to be checked.
5553
5554 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5555 .code
5556 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5557 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5558 .endd
5559 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5560 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5561 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5562 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5563
5564 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5565 .code
5566 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5567 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5568 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5569 .endd
5570 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5571 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5572 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5573 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5574 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5575 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5576 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5577
5578 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5579 .code
5580 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5581 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5582 .endd
5583 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5584 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5585 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5586 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5587 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5588 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5589 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5590 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5591 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5592 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5593 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5594 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5595 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5596 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5597 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5598 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5599 consequences).
5600 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5601 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5602 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5603 which should be used in preference to 587.
5604 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5605 these ports.
5606 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5607
5608 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5609 .code
5610 # qualify_domain =
5611 # qualify_recipient =
5612 .endd
5613 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5614 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5615 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5616 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5617 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5618 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5619
5620 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5621 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5622 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5623 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5624 .code
5625 # allow_domain_literals
5626 .endd
5627 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5628 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5629 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5630 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5631 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5632 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5633
5634 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5635 .code
5636 never_users = root
5637 .endd
5638 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5639 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5640 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5641 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5642 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5643 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5644 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5645 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5646
5647 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5648 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5649 line,
5650 .code
5651 host_lookup = *
5652 .endd
5653 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5654 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5655 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5656 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5657 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5658 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5659 unreachable.
5660
5661 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5662 1413 (hence their names):
5663 .code
5664 rfc1413_hosts = *
5665 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5666 .endd
5667 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5668 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5669 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5670 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5671 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5672 information, you can change this.
5673
5674 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5675 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5676 .code
5677 prdr_enable = true
5678 .endd
5679
5680 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5681 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5682 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5683 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5684 .code
5685 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5686 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5687 .endd
5688 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5689 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5690
5691 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5692 over the default:
5693 .code
5694 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5695 +tls_certificate_verified
5696 .endd
5697
5698 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5699 .code
5700 # percent_hack_domains =
5701 .endd
5702 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5703 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5704 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5705
5706 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5707 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5708 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5709 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5710 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5711 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5712 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5713 always bounce messages.
5714 .code
5715 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5716 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5717 .endd
5718 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5719 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5720 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5721 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5722 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5723
5724 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5725 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5726 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5727 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5728 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5729 not often needed).
5730 .code
5731 # split_spool_directory = true
5732 .endd
5733
5734 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5735 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5736 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5737 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5738 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5739 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5740 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5741 .code
5742 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5743 .endd
5744
5745 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5746 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5747 that are not 8-bit clean.
5748 .code
5749 # accept_8bitmime = false
5750 .endd
5751
5752 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5753 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5754 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5755 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5756 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5757 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5758 .code
5759 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5760 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5761 .endd
5762
5763
5764 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5765 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5766 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5767 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5768 It starts with the line
5769 .code
5770 begin acl
5771 .endd
5772 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5773 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5774 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5775
5776 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5777 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5778 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5779 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5780 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5781 result of the ACL processing.
5782 .code
5783 acl_check_rcpt:
5784 .endd
5785 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5786 ACL, and names it.
5787 .code
5788 accept hosts = :
5789 .endd
5790 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5791 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5792 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5793 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5794 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5795 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5796
5797 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5798 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5799 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5800 manner.
5801 .code
5802 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5803 domains = +local_domains
5804 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5805
5806 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5807 domains = !+local_domains
5808 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5809 .endd
5810 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5811 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5812 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5813 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5814 in Internet mail addresses.
5815
5816 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5817 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5818 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5819 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5820 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5821 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5822 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5823 policy of being as safe as possible.
5824
5825 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5826 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5827 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5828 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5829 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5830 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5831
5832 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5833 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5834 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5835 have to modify this rule.
5836
5837 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5838 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5839 common convention of local parts constructed as
5840 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5841 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5842 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5843 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5844 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5845 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5846
5847 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5848 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5849 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5850 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5851 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5852 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5853 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5854 .code
5855 accept local_parts = postmaster
5856 domains = +local_domains
5857 .endd
5858 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5859 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5860 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5861 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5862 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5863
5864 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5865 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5866 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5867 .code
5868 require verify = sender
5869 .endd
5870 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5871 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5872 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5873 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5874 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5875 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5876 discusses the details of address verification.
5877 .code
5878 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5879 control = submission
5880 .endd
5881 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5882 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5883 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5884 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5885 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5886 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5887 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5888 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5889 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5890 .code
5891 accept authenticated = *
5892 control = submission
5893 .endd
5894 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5895 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5896 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5897 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5898 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5899 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5900 .code
5901 require message = relay not permitted
5902 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5903 .endd
5904 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5905 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5906 .code
5907 require verify = recipient
5908 .endd
5909 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5910 fails, the address is rejected.
5911 .code
5912 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5913 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5914 # $dnslist_text
5915 # dnslists = black.list.example
5916 #
5917 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5918 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5919 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5920 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5921 .endd
5922 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5923 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5924 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5925 line.
5926 .code
5927 # require verify = csa
5928 .endd
5929 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5930 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5931 records.
5932 .code
5933 accept
5934 .endd
5935 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5936 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5937 .code
5938 acl_check_data:
5939 .endd
5940 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5941 of this ACL are commented out:
5942 .code
5943 # deny malware = *
5944 # message = This message contains a virus \
5945 # ($malware_name).
5946 .endd
5947 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5948 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5949 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5950 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5951 .code
5952 # warn spam = nobody
5953 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5954 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5955 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5956 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5957 .endd
5958 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5959 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5960 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5961 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5962 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5963 whatever the spam score.
5964 .code
5965 accept
5966 .endd
5967 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5968
5969
5970 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5971 .cindex "default" "routers"
5972 .cindex "routers" "default"
5973 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5974 by the line
5975 .code
5976 begin routers
5977 .endd
5978 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5979 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5980 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5981 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5982 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5983 .code
5984 # domain_literal:
5985 # driver = ipliteral
5986 # domains = !+local_domains
5987 # transport = remote_smtp
5988 .endd
5989 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5990 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5991 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5992 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5993 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5994 .code
5995 dnslookup:
5996 driver = dnslookup
5997 domains = ! +local_domains
5998 transport = remote_smtp
5999 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6000 no_more
6001 .endd
6002 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
6003 domains. This is specified by the line
6004 .code
6005 domains = ! +local_domains
6006 .endd
6007 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6008 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6009 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6010 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6011 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6012 passed on to the following routers.
6013
6014 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6015 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6016 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6017 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6018 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6019
6020 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6021 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6022 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6023 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6024 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6025 the address fails and is bounced.
6026
6027 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6028 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6029 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6030 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6031 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6032 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6033 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6034 out.
6035 .code
6036 system_aliases:
6037 driver = redirect
6038 allow_fail
6039 allow_defer
6040 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6041 # user = exim
6042 file_transport = address_file
6043 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6044 .endd
6045 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6046 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6047 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6048 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6049 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6050 the next router.
6051
6052 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6053 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6054 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6055 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6056 .code
6057 userforward:
6058 driver = redirect
6059 check_local_user
6060 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6061 # local_part_suffix_optional
6062 file = $home/.forward
6063 # allow_filter
6064 no_verify
6065 no_expn
6066 check_ancestor
6067 file_transport = address_file
6068 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6069 reply_transport = address_reply
6070 .endd
6071 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6072 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6073 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6074 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6075 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6076 namely:
6077 .code
6078 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6079 # local_part_suffix_optional
6080 .endd
6081 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6082 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6083 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6084 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6085 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6086 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6087 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6088
6089 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6090 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6091 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6092 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6093
6094 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6095 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6096 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6097 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6098 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6099 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6100 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6101
6102 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6103 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6104 There are two reasons for doing this:
6105
6106 .olist
6107 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6108 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6109 unnecessary work.
6110 .next
6111 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6112 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6113 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6114 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6115 this time.
6116 .endlist
6117
6118 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6119 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6120 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6121 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6122
6123 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6124 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6125 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6126 .code
6127 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6128 .endd
6129 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6130 transport.
6131 .code
6132 localuser:
6133 driver = accept
6134 check_local_user
6135 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6136 # local_part_suffix_optional
6137 transport = local_delivery
6138 .endd
6139 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6140 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6141 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6142 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6143 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6144
6145
6146 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6147 .cindex "default" "transports"
6148 .cindex "transports" "default"
6149 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6150 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6151 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6152 .code
6153 begin transports
6154 .endd
6155 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6156 .code
6157 remote_smtp:
6158 driver = smtp
6159 hosts_try_prdr = *
6160 .endd
6161 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6162 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6163 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6164 It is negotiated between client and server
6165 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6166 All other options are defaulted.
6167 .code
6168 local_delivery:
6169 driver = appendfile
6170 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6171 delivery_date_add
6172 envelope_to_add
6173 return_path_add
6174 # group = mail
6175 # mode = 0660
6176 .endd
6177 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6178 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6179 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6180 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6181 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6182 show how this can be done.
6183
6184 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6185 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6186 similarly-named options above.
6187 .code
6188 address_pipe:
6189 driver = pipe
6190 return_output
6191 .endd
6192 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6193 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6194 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6195 be returned to the sender.
6196 .code
6197 address_file:
6198 driver = appendfile
6199 delivery_date_add
6200 envelope_to_add
6201 return_path_add
6202 .endd
6203 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6204 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6205 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6206 .code
6207 address_reply:
6208 driver = autoreply
6209 .endd
6210 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6211 filter files.
6212
6213
6214
6215 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6216 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6217 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6218 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6219 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6220 introduced by the line
6221 .code
6222 begin retry
6223 .endd
6224 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6225 errors:
6226 .code
6227 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6228 .endd
6229 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6230 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6231 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6232 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6233 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6234
6235 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6236 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6237 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6238
6239
6240 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6241 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6242 .code
6243 begin rewrite
6244 .endd
6245 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6246 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6247
6248
6249
6250 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6251 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6252 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6253 .code
6254 begin authenticators
6255 .endd
6256 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6257 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6258 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6259 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6260 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6261 to support most MUA software.
6262
6263 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6264 .code
6265 #PLAIN:
6266 # driver = plaintext
6267 # server_set_id = $auth2
6268 # server_prompts = :
6269 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6270 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6271 .endd
6272 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6273 .code
6274 #LOGIN:
6275 # driver = plaintext
6276 # server_set_id = $auth1
6277 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6278 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6279 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6280 .endd
6281
6282 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6283 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6284 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6285 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6286 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6287 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6288 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6289 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6290
6291 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6292 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6293 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6294 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6295
6296 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6297 usercode and password are in different positions.
6298 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6299
6300 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6301
6302
6303
6304 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6305 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6306
6307 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6308
6309 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6310 .cindex "PCRE"
6311 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6312 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6313 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6314 regular expressions is discussed in
6315 online Perl manpages, in
6316 many Perl reference books, and also in
6317 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6318 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6319
6320 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6321 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6322 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6323 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6324 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6325 case-insensitive.
6326
6327 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6328 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6329 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6330 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6331 .code
6332 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6333 .endd
6334 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6335 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6336 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6337 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6338 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6339 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6340 matched.
6341
6342 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6343 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6344 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6345 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6346 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6347 match anywhere in the subject string.
6348
6349 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6350 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6351 .code
6352 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6353 .endd
6354 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6355 You need to use:
6356 .code
6357 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6358 .endd
6359 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6360 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6361
6362
6363
6364 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6366
6367 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6368 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6369 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6370 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6371 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6372 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6373
6374 .olist
6375 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6376 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6377 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6378 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6379 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6380 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6381 .next
6382 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6383 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6384 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6385 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6386 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6387 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6388 .endlist
6389
6390 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6391 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6392 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6393 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6394 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6395 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6396
6397 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6398 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6399 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6400 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6401 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6402 .code
6403 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6404 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6405 .endd
6406 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6407 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6408 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6409 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6410 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6411 .code
6412 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6413 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6414 .endd
6415 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6416 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6417
6418 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6419 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6420 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6421 .code
6422 domain1:
6423 domain2:
6424 .endd
6425 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6426 matches the list item.
6427
6428 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6429 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6430 .code
6431 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6432 .endd
6433 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6434 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6435 causes a second lookup to occur.
6436
6437 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6438 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6439 lookup is permitted.
6440
6441
6442 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6443 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6444 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6445 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6446
6447 .ilist
6448 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6449 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6450 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6451 .next
6452 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6453 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6454 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6455 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6456 .endlist
6457
6458 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6459 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6460 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6461 .code
6462 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6463 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6464 .endd
6465 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6466 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6467 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6468
6469
6470
6471
6472 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6473 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6474 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6475 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6476
6477 .ilist
6478 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6479 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6480 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6481 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6482 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6483 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6484 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6485 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6486 be found in several places:
6487 .display
6488 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6489 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6490 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6491 .endd
6492 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6493 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6494 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6495 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6496 .next
6497 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6498 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6499 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6500 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6501 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6502 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6503 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6504
6505 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6506 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6507 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6508 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6509 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6510 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6511 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6512 .next
6513 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6514 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6515 .cindex "sasldb2"
6516 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6517 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6518 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6519 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6520 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6521 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6522 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6523 .next
6524 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6525 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6526 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6527 .cindex "Courier"
6528 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6529 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6530 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6531 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6532 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6533 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6534 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6535 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6536 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6537 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6538 .next
6539 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6540 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6541 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6542 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6543 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6544 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6545 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6546 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6547 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6548 .next
6549 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6550 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6551 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6552 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6553 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6554 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6555 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6556 .code
6557 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6558 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6559 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6560 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6561 .endd
6562 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6563 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6564 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6565 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6566 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6567
6568 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6569 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6570 lookup types support only literal keys.
6571
6572 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6573 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6574 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6575 .next
6576 .cindex "linear search"
6577 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6578 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6579 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6580 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6581 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6582 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6583 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6584 in the file is used.
6585
6586 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6587 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6588 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6589 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6590 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6591 colon, for example:
6592 .code
6593 baduser: :fail:
6594 .endd
6595 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6596 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6597 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6598 wildcarding of any kind.
6599
6600 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6601 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6602 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6603 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6604 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6605 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6606 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6607 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6608 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6609
6610 .next
6611 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6612 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6613 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6614 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6615 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6616 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6617 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6618 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6619
6620 .next
6621 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6622 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6623 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6624 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6625 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6626 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6627 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6628 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6629 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6630
6631 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6632 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6633 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6634 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6635
6636 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6637 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6638
6639 .olist
6640 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6641 .code
6642 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6643 *fish data for anythingfish
6644 .endd
6645 .next
6646 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6647 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6648 .code
6649 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6650 .endd
6651 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6652 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6653 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6654 .code
6655 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6656 .endd
6657 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6658 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6659 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6660 .code
6661 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6662 .endd
6663
6664 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6665 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6666 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6667 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6668 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6669
6670 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6671 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6672 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6673 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6674 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6675
6676 .next
6677 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6678 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6679 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6680 example:
6681 .code
6682 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6683 .endd
6684 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6685 .endlist olist
6686
6687 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6688 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6689 be followed by optional colons.
6690
6691 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6692 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6693 lookup types support only literal keys.
6694 .endlist ilist
6695
6696
6697 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6698 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6699 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6700 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6701 many of them are given in later sections.
6702
6703 .ilist
6704 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6705 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6706 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6707 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6708 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6709 .next
6710 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6711 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6712 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6713 .next
6714 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6715 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6716 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6717 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6718 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6719 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6720 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6721 .next
6722 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6723 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6724 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6725 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6726 .next
6727 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6728 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6729 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6730 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6731 .next
6732 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6733 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6734 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6735 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6736 .next
6737 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6738 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6739 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6740 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6741 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6742 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6743 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6744 password value. For example:
6745 .code
6746 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6747 .endd
6748 .next
6749 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6750 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6751 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6752 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6753
6754 .next
6755 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6756 .cindex lookup Redis
6757 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6758 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6759
6760 .next
6761 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6762 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6763 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6764 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6765
6766 .next
6767 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6768 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6769 .next
6770 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6771 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6772 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6773 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6774 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6775 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6776 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6777 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6778 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6779 .code
6780 require condition = \
6781 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6782 .endd
6783 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6784 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6785 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6786 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6787 .endlist
6788
6789
6790
6791 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6792 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6793 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6794 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6795 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6796 options such as a list of local domains.
6797
6798 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6799 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6800 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6801 or may give up altogether.
6802
6803
6804
6805 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6806 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6807 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6808 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6809 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6810 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6811 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6812 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6813
6814 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6815 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6816 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6817
6818 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6819 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6820 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6821
6822 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6823 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6824 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6825 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6826 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6827 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6828 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6829 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6830 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6831 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6832 .code
6833 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6834 .endd
6835 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6836 looks up these keys, in this order:
6837 .code
6838 jane@eyre.example
6839 *@eyre.example
6840 *
6841 .endd
6842 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6843 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6844 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6845 Exim move on to try the next key.
6846
6847
6848
6849 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6850 .cindex "partial matching"
6851 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6852 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6853 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6854 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6855 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6856 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6857 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6858 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6859 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6860 a key in a DBM file is
6861 .code
6862 *.dates.fict.example
6863 .endd
6864 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6865 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6866 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6867 file.
6868
6869 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6870 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6871 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6872
6873 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6874 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6875 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6876 partial matching keys
6877 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6878 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6879 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6880
6881 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6882 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6883 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6884 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6885 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6886 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6887 remains.
6888
6889 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6890 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6891 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6892 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6893 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6894 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6895 .code
6896 2250.dates.fict.example
6897 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6898 *.dates.fict.example
6899 *.fict.example
6900 .endd
6901 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6902 finishes.
6903
6904 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6905 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6906 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6907 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6908 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6909 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6910 .code
6911 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6912 .endd
6913 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6914 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6915 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6916 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6917 .code
6918 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6919 .endd
6920 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6921 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6922
6923 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6924 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6925 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6926
6927 .ilist
6928 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6929 .next
6930 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6931 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6932 .next
6933 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6934 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6935 for &"*"& on its own.
6936 .next
6937 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6938 .endlist
6939
6940
6941 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6942 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6943 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6944 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6945 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6946 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6947 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6948
6949 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6950 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6951 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6952 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6953 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6954
6955
6956
6957
6958 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6959 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6960 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6961 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6962 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6963 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6964 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6965
6966 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6967 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6968 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6969 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6970 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6971 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6972
6973 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6974 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6975 complete.
6976
6977
6978
6979
6980 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6981 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6982 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6983 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6984 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6985 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6986 .code
6987 [name=$local_part]
6988 .endd
6989 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6990 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6991 .code
6992 [name="$local_part"]
6993 .endd
6994 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6995 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6996 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6997 of the following form is provided:
6998 .code
6999 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7000 .endd
7001 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7002 .code
7003 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7004 .endd
7005 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7006 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7007 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7008
7009
7010
7011
7012 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7013 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7014 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7015 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7016 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7017 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7018 an expansion string could contain:
7019 .code
7020 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7021 .endd
7022 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7023 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7024 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7025 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7026
7027 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7028 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7029 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7030
7031 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7032 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7033 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7034 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7035 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7036 .code
7037 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7038 .endd
7039 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7040 white space is ignored.
7041 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7042 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7043 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7044
7045 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7046 When the type is PTR,
7047 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7048 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7049 .code
7050 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7051 .endd
7052 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7053 altered and nothing is added.
7054
7055 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7056 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7057 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7058 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7059 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7060 The field separator can be modified as above.
7061
7062 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7063 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7064 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7065 unless a field separator is specified.
7066 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7067 For SPF records the
7068 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7069 .code
7070 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7071 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7072 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7073 .endd
7074 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7075 white space is ignored.
7076
7077 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7078 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7079 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7080 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7081 specified.
7082 .code
7083 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7084 .endd
7085
7086 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7087 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7088 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7089 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7090 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7091 each followed by a comma,
7092 that may appear before the record type.
7093
7094 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7095 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7096 a defer-option modifier.
7097 The possible keywords are
7098 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7099 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7100 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7101 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7102 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7103 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7104 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7105 .code
7106 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7107 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7108 .endd
7109 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7110 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7111
7112 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7113 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7114 The possible keywords are
7115 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7116 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7117 with the lookup.
7118 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7119 is not labelled as authenticated data
7120 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7121 The default is &"never"&.
7122
7123 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7124
7125 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7126 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7127 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7128 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7129 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7130 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7131
7132 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7133 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7134 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7135
7136 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7137 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7138 .cindex DNS TTL
7139 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7140 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7141 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7142
7143
7144 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7145 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7146 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7147 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7148 the pseudo-type MXH:
7149 .code
7150 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7151 .endd
7152 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7153 returned.
7154
7155 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7156 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7157 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7158 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7159 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7160 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7161 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7162 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7163 .code
7164 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7165 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7166 .endd
7167 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7168 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7169 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7170
7171 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7172 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7173 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7174 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7175 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7176 such a list.
7177
7178 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7179 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7180 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7181 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7182 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7183 result of a successful lookup such as:
7184 .code
7185 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7186 .endd
7187 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7188 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7189 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7190
7191 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7192 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7193 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7194 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7195 .code
7196 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7197 .endd
7198
7199
7200 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7201 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7202 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7203 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7204 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7205 .code
7206 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7207 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7208 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7209 .endd
7210 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7211 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7212 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7213 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7214
7215 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7216 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7217 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7218
7219
7220
7221
7222 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7223 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7224 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7225 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7226 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7227 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7228 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7229 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7230 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7231 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7232 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7233 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7234 .code
7235 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7236 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7237 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7238 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7239 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7240 .endd
7241 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7242 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7243
7244 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7245 the way they handle the results of a query:
7246
7247 .ilist
7248 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7249 gives an error.
7250 .next
7251 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7252 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7253 .next
7254 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7255 from all of them are returned.
7256 .endlist
7257
7258
7259 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7260 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7261 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7262 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7263
7264
7265 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7266 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7267 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7268 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7269 .code
7270 data = ${lookup ldap \
7271 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7272 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7273 .endd
7274 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7275 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7276 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7277 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7278
7279 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7280 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7281 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7282
7283 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7284 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7285 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7286 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7287 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7288 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7289 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7290 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7291 &_exim.conf_&.
7292
7293
7294 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7295 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7296 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7297 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7298 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7299 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7300
7301 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7302 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7303 the string:
7304 .code
7305 * => \2A
7306 ( => \28
7307 ) => \29
7308 \ => \5C
7309 .endd
7310 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7311 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7312 .code
7313 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7314 .endd
7315 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7316 .code
7317 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7318 .endd
7319 yields
7320 .code
7321 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7322 .endd
7323 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7324 .code
7325 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7326 .endd
7327 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7328 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7329 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7330 .code
7331 , + " \ < > ;
7332 .endd
7333 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7334 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7335 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7336 .code
7337 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7338 .endd
7339 yields
7340 .code
7341 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7342 .endd
7343 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7344 .code
7345 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7346 .endd
7347 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7348 authentication below.
7349
7350
7351 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7352 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7353 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7354 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7355 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7356 by starting it with
7357 .code
7358 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7359 .endd
7360 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7361 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7362 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7363 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7364 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7365 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7366 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7367 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7368 failures, and timeouts.
7369
7370 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7371 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7372 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7373 doubled. For example
7374 .code
7375 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7376 .endd
7377 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7378 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7379 the local host) is used.
7380
7381 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7382 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7383 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7384 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7385 not available.
7386
7387 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7388 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7389 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7390 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7391 .code
7392 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7393 .endd
7394 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7395 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7396 .code
7397 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7398 .endd
7399 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7400 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7401 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7402 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7403 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7404 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7405 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7406 backup host.
7407
7408 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7409 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7410 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7411
7412 .ilist
7413 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7414 interface.
7415 .next
7416 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7417 .endlist
7418
7419
7420 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7421 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7422
7423
7424
7425 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7426 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7427 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7428 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7429 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7430 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7431 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7432 them. The following names are recognized:
7433 .display
7434 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7435 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7436 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7437 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7438 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7439 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7440 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7441 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7442 .endd
7443 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7444 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7445 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7446 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7447
7448 .cindex LDAP timeout
7449 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7450 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7451 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7452 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7453 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7454 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7455 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7456 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7457 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7458 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7459
7460 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7461 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7462
7463 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7464 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7465 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7466 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7467 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7468 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7469 alternate list (colon-separated).
7470
7471 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7472 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7473 .code
7474 ${lookup ldap
7475 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7476 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7477 {$value}fail}
7478 .endd
7479 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7480 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7481 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7482 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7483
7484 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7485 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7486 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7487
7488 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7489 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7490 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7491 quoting has two advantages:
7492
7493 .ilist
7494 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7495 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7496 .next
7497 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7498 .endlist
7499
7500 For example, a setting such as
7501 .code
7502 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7503 .endd
7504 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7505
7506 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7507 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7508 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7509 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7510 .code
7511 PASS=${quote:$3}
7512 .endd
7513 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7514 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7515 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7516
7517
7518
7519 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7520 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7521 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7522 as a sequence of values, for example
7523 .code
7524 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7525 .endd
7526 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7527 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7528 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7529 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7530 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7531 directory.
7532
7533 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7534 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7535 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7536 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7537
7538 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7539 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7540 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7541 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7542 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7543 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7544 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7545 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7546 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7547
7548 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7549 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7550 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7551 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7552 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7553
7554 .code
7555 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7556 value1.1,value1,,2
7557
7558 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7559 value two
7560
7561 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7562 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7563
7564 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7565 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7566
7567 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7568 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7569 .endd
7570 You can
7571 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7572 results of LDAP lookups.
7573 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7574 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7575 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7576 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7577 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7578 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7579
7580
7581
7582
7583 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7584 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7585 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7586 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7587 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7588 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7589 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7590 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7591 .code
7592 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7593 .endd
7594 might return the string
7595 .code
7596 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7597 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7598 .endd
7599 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7600 .code
7601 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7602 .endd
7603 would just return
7604 .code
7605 Martin Guerre
7606 .endd
7607 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7608 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7609 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7610
7611
7612
7613 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7614 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7615 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7616 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7617 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7618 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7619 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7620 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7621 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7622 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7623 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7624 .cindex lookup Redis
7625 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7626 and SQLite
7627 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7628 might be
7629 .code
7630 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7631 {$value}fail}
7632 .endd
7633 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7634 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7635 .code
7636 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7637 {$value}}
7638 .endd
7639 might be
7640 .code
7641 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7642 .endd
7643 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7644 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7645 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7646 .code
7647 Mister X
7648 .endd
7649 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7650 with a newline between the data for each row.
7651
7652
7653 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7654 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7655 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7656 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7657 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7658 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7659 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7660 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7661 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7662 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7663 .cindex lookup Redis
7664 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7665 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7666 or &%redis_servers%&
7667 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7668 information.
7669 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7670 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7671 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7672 For all but Redis
7673 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7674 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7675 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7676 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7677 .code
7678 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7679 .endd
7680 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7681 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7682 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7683 .code
7684 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7685 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7686 .endd
7687 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7688 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7689 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7690 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7691 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7692 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7693
7694 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7695 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7696 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7697 information.
7698 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7699 host, database number, and password.
7700 .olist
7701 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7702 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7703 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7704 .next
7705 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7706 .next
7707 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7708 .endlist
7709
7710 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7711 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7712 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7713 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7714
7715 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7716 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7717
7718 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7719 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7720 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7721 done by starting the query with
7722 .display
7723 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7724 .endd
7725 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7726 .olist
7727 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7728 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7729 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7730 taken from there.
7731 .next
7732 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7733 .endlist
7734 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7735 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7736 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7737
7738 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7739 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7740 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7741 like this:
7742 .code
7743 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7744 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7745 master/db/name/pw
7746 .endd
7747 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7748 .code
7749 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7750 .endd
7751 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7752 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7753 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7754 .code
7755 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7756 .endd
7757
7758
7759 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7760 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7761 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7762 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7763 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7764 the default value is &"exim"&.
7765 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7766 .display
7767 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7768 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7769 .endd
7770 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7771 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7772
7773 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7774 the queries.
7775
7776 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7777 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7778
7779 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7780 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7781 is zero because no rows are affected.
7782
7783
7784 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7785 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7786 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7787 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7788 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7789 looks like this:
7790 .code
7791 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7792 .endd
7793 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7794 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7795 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7796
7797 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7798 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7799 affected.
7800
7801 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7802 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7803 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7804 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7805 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7806 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7807 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7808 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7809 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7810 .code
7811 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7812 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7813 .endd
7814 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7815 .code
7816 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7817 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7818 .endd
7819 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7820 quote, which it doubles.
7821
7822 .cindex timeout SQLite
7823 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7824 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7825 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7826 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7827 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7828 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7829 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7830 option.
7831
7832 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7833 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7834 .cindex "redis lookup type"
7835 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7836 Examples:
7837 .code
7838 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7839 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7840 .endd
7841
7842 .new
7843 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
7844 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
7845 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
7846 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
7847 servers.
7848
7849 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, exim does not
7850 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
7851 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
7852 reached.
7853 .wen
7854
7855 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7856 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7857
7858
7859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7861
7862 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7863 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7864 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7865 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7866 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7867 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7868 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7869 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7870 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7871
7872 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7873 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7874 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7875 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7876
7877 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7878 support all the complexity available in
7879 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7880
7881
7882
7883 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7884 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7885 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7886
7887 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7888 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7889
7890 The result of
7891 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7892 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7893 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7894 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7895 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7896
7897
7898 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7899 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7900 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7901
7902 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7903 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7904 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7905 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7906 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7907 .code
7908 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7909 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7910 .endd
7911 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7912 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7913 senders based on the receiving domain.
7914
7915
7916
7917
7918 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7919 .cindex "list" "negation"
7920 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7921 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7922 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7923 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7924 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7925 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7926
7927 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7928 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7929 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7930 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7931 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7932 .code
7933 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7934 .endd
7935 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7936 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7937 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7938 .code
7939 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7940 .endd
7941 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7942 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7943 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7944
7945 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7946 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7947 item.
7948
7949
7950
7951 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7952 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7953 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7954 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7955 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7956 file names are not allowed,
7957 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7958 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7959 lines:
7960
7961 .ilist
7962 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7963 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7964 .next
7965 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7966 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7967 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7968 .code
7969 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7970 .endd
7971 .endlist
7972
7973 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7974 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7975 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7976 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7977
7978 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7979 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7980 .code
7981 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7982 .endd
7983 and the file contains the lines
7984 .code
7985 !a.b.c
7986 *.b.c
7987 .endd
7988 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7989 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7990
7991
7992
7993 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7994 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7995 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7996 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7997 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7998 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7999 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8000 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8001
8002 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8003 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
8004 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8005 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8006
8007
8008
8009
8010 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8011 .cindex "named lists"
8012 .cindex "list" "named"
8013 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8014 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8015 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8016 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8017 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8018 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8019 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8020 .code
8021 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8022 .endd
8023 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8024 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8025 configured with the line
8026 .code
8027 domains = +local_domains
8028 .endd
8029 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8030 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8031 .code
8032 dnslookup:
8033 driver = dnslookup
8034 domains = ! +local_domains
8035 transport = remote_smtp
8036 no_more
8037 .endd
8038 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8039 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8040 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8041 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8042 .code
8043 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8044 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8045 .endd
8046 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8047 .code
8048 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8049 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8050 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8051 .endd
8052 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8053 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8054 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8055 .code
8056 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8057 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8058 .endd
8059 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8060 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8061 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8062 .code
8063 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8064 .endd
8065 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8066 referenced lists if you can.
8067
8068 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8069 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8070 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8071 .code
8072 domains = +local_domains
8073 .endd
8074 on several of your routers
8075 or in several ACL statements,
8076 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8077 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8078 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8079 the same each time they are referenced.
8080
8081 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8082 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8083 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8084 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8085
8086
8087
8088 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8089 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8090 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8091 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8092 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8093 write
8094 .code
8095 ALIST = host1 : host2
8096 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8097 .endd
8098 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8099 .code
8100 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8101 .endd
8102 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8103 list, and write
8104 .code
8105 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8106 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8107 .endd
8108 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8109 .code
8110 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8111 .endd
8112
8113
8114 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8115 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8116 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8117 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8118 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8119 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8120 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8121 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8122 message. For example:
8123 .code
8124 domainlist special_domains = \
8125 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8126 .endd
8127 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8128 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8129 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8130 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8131 same list each time.
8132
8133 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8134 cache the result anyway. For example:
8135 .code
8136 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8137 .endd
8138 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8139 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8140
8141
8142
8143 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8144 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8145 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8146 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8147 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8148
8149 .ilist
8150 .cindex "primary host name"
8151 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8152 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8153 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8154 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8155 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8156 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8157 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8158 differ only in their names.
8159 .next
8160 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8161 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8162 .cindex "domain literal"
8163 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8164 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8165 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8166 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8167 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8168 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8169 .next
8170 .cindex "@mx_any"
8171 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8172 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8173 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8174 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8175 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8176 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8177 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8178 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8179 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8180 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8181 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8182
8183 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8184 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8185 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8186 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8187 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8188
8189 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8190 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8191 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8192 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8193 on a router). For example:
8194 .code
8195 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8196 .endd
8197 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8198 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8199
8200 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8201 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8202 contain negative items.
8203
8204 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8205 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8206 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8207 .code
8208 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8209 an.other.domain : ...
8210 .endd
8211 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8212 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8213 .code
8214 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8215 an.other.domain ? ...
8216 .endd
8217 .next
8218 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8219 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8220 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8221 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8222 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8223 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8224 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8225 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8226 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8227 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8228
8229 .next
8230 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8231 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8232 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8233 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8234 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8235 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8236 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8237 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8238 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8239
8240 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8241 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8242 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8243 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8244 expression by expansion, of course).
8245 .next
8246 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8247 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8248 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8249 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8250 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8251 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8252 .code
8253 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8254 .endd
8255 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8256 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8257 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8258 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8259 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8260 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8261 other statements in the same ACL.
8262
8263 .next
8264 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8265 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8266 .code
8267 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8268 .endd
8269 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8270 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8271
8272 .next
8273 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8274 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8275 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8276 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8277 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8278 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8279 expansion variable.
8280 .next
8281 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8282 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8283 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8284 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8285 .code
8286 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8287 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8288 .endd
8289 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8290 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8291 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8292 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8293 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8294 .next
8295 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8296 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8297 between the pattern and the domain.
8298 .endlist
8299
8300 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8301 .code
8302 domainlist funny_domains = \
8303 @ : \
8304 lib.unseen.edu : \
8305 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8306 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8307 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8308 nis;domains.byname : \
8309 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8310 .endd
8311 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8312 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8313 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8314 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8315 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8316 patterns earlier.
8317
8318
8319
8320 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8321 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8322 .cindex "list" "host list"
8323 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8324 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8325 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8326 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8327 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8328 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8329 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8330
8331
8332 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8333 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8334 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8335 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8336 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8337 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8338 not used.
8339
8340 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8341 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8342 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8343
8344
8345
8346 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8347 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8348 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8349 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8350 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8351 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8352 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8353 concerns.)
8354
8355 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8356 inspecting its IP address:
8357
8358 .ilist
8359 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8360 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8361 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8362 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8363 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8364 with the IP address of the subject host.
8365
8366 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8367 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8368 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8369 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8370 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8371
8372 .next
8373 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8374 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8375 domain name, as just described.
8376
8377 .next
8378 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8379 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8380 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8381 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8382 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8383 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8384 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8385 that can never match a client host.
8386
8387 .next
8388 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8389 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8390 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8391 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8392 .code
8393 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8394 accept hosts = @[]
8395 .endd
8396 .next
8397 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8398 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8399 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8400 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8401 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8402 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8403 significant end of the address.
8404
8405 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8406 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8407 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8408 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8409 .code
8410 192.168.23.236/31
8411 .endd
8412 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8413 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8414 matches.
8415
8416 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8417 .code
8418 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8419 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8420 .endd
8421 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8422 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8423 For example:
8424 .code
8425 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8426 .endd
8427 could make use of a file containing
8428 .code
8429 172.16.0.0/12
8430 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8431 .endd
8432 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8433 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8434 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8435 .code
8436 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8437 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8438 .endd
8439 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8440 list.
8441 .endlist
8442
8443
8444
8445 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8446 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8447 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8448 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8449 address, the pattern takes this form:
8450 .display
8451 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8452 .endd
8453 For example:
8454 .code
8455 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8456 .endd
8457 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8458 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8459 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8460 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8461 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8462 returned by the lookup is not used.
8463
8464 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8465 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8466 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8467 patterns of this form:
8468 .display
8469 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8470 .endd
8471 For example:
8472 .code
8473 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8474 .endd
8475 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8476 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8477 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8478 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8479 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8480
8481 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8482 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8483 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8484 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8485 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8486 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8487 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8488 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8489 addresses are always used.
8490
8491 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8492 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8493 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8494 configurations.
8495
8496 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8497 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8498 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8499 case the IP address is used on its own.
8500
8501
8502
8503 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8504 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8505 .cindex "unknown host name"
8506 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8507 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8508 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8509 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8510 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8511 above.)
8512
8513 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8514 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8515 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8516 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8517 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8518 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8519 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8520
8521 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8522 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8523
8524 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8525 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8526 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8527 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8528 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8529 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8530 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8531 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8532 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8533
8534 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8535 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8536
8537 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8538 .cindex "alias for host"
8539 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8540 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8541
8542 .ilist
8543 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8544 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8545 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8546 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8547 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8548 expression.
8549 .next
8550 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8551 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8552 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8553 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8554 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8555 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8556 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8557 example,
8558 .code
8559 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8560 .endd
8561 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8562 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8563 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8564 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8565 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8566 .code
8567 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8568 .endd
8569 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8570 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8571 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8572 required.
8573 .endlist
8574
8575
8576
8577
8578 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8579 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8580 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8581 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8582 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8583 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8584
8585 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8586 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8587
8588 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8589 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8590 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8591 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8592 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8593 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8594 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8595 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8596 not recognized in an indirected file).
8597
8598 .ilist
8599 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8600 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8601 .code
8602 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8603 .endd
8604 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8605 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8606
8607 .next
8608 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8609 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8610 example:
8611 .code
8612 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8613 192.168.4.5
8614 .endd
8615 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8616 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8617 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8618 .endlist
8619
8620 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8621 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8622 list.
8623
8624 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8625 "SECTmixwilhos"
8626 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8627
8628 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8629 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8630 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8631
8632 .ilist
8633 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8634 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8635 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8636 .code
8637 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8638 .endd
8639 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8640 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8641 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8642 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8643 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8644 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8645 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8646
8647 .next
8648 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8649 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8650 .code
8651 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8652 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8653 .endd
8654 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8655 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8656 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8657 this section.
8658 .endlist
8659
8660
8661 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8662 "SECTtemdnserr"
8663 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8664 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8665 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8666 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8667 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8668 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8669 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8670 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8671 host lists such as whitelists.
8672
8673
8674
8675 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8676 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8677 .cindex "unknown host name"
8678 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8679 If a pattern is of the form
8680 .display
8681 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8682 .endd
8683 for example
8684 .code
8685 dbm;/host/accept/list
8686 .endd
8687 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8688 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8689 is not used.
8690
8691 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8692 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8693 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8694 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8695 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8696 lookup, both using the same file.
8697
8698
8699
8700 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8701 If a pattern is of the form
8702 .display
8703 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8704 .endd
8705 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8706 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8707 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8708 .code
8709 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8710 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8711 .endd
8712 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8713 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8714 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8715 operator.
8716
8717 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8718 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8719 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8720
8721 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8722 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8723 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8724 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8725 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8726 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8727
8728
8729
8730
8731
8732 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8733 .cindex "list" "address list"
8734 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8735 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8736 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8737 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8738 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8739 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8740 using this option setting:
8741 .code
8742 senders = :
8743 .endd
8744 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8745 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8746 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8747 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8748
8749 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8750 example:
8751 .code
8752 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8753 .endd
8754 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8755 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8756 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8757 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8758 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8759 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8760 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8761 .code
8762 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8763 *@+hostile_domains:\
8764 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8765 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8766 .endd
8767 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8768 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8769 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8770 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8771 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8772
8773 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8774 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8775 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8776 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8777 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8778 .code
8779 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8780 .endd
8781
8782 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8783 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8784 senders:
8785
8786 .ilist
8787 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8788 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8789 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8790 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8791 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8792 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8793 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8794 .code
8795 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8796 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8797 .endd
8798 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8799 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8800
8801 .next
8802 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8803 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8804 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8805 example:
8806 .code
8807 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8808 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8809 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8810 .endd
8811 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8812 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8813 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8814 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8815
8816 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8817 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8818 panic log.
8819 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8820 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8821 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8822 default. For example, with this lookup:
8823 .code
8824 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8825 .endd
8826 the file could contains lines like this:
8827 .code
8828 user1@domain1.example
8829 *@domain2.example
8830 .endd
8831 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8832 that are tried is:
8833 .code
8834 nimrod@jaeger.example
8835 *@jaeger.example
8836 *
8837 .endd
8838 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8839 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8840
8841 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8842 .code
8843 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8844 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8845 .endd
8846 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8847 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8848 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8849 .endlist
8850
8851
8852 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8853 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8854 always fails.
8855
8856
8857 .ilist
8858 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8859 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8860 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8861 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8862 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8863 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8864 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8865 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8866 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8867
8868 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8869 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8870 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8871 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8872 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8873 with
8874 .code
8875 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8876 .endd
8877 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8878 .code
8879 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8880 .endd
8881 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8882
8883 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8884 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8885 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8886 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8887 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8888 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8889 .code
8890 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8891 spammer3 : spammer4
8892 .endd
8893 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8894 doubling.
8895
8896 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8897 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8898 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8899 might have entries like
8900 .code
8901 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8902 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8903 *: ^\d{8}$
8904 .endd
8905 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8906 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8907 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8908 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8909
8910 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8911 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8912 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8913
8914 .next
8915 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8916 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8917 can only return a single list of local parts.
8918 .endlist
8919
8920 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8921 in these two examples:
8922 .code
8923 senders = +my_list
8924 senders = *@+my_list
8925 .endd
8926 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8927 example it is a named domain list.
8928
8929
8930
8931
8932 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8933 .cindex "case of local parts"
8934 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8935 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8936 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8937 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8938 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8939 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8940 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8941 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8942 default.
8943
8944 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8945 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8946 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8947 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8948 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8949 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8950 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8951 case-independent.
8952
8953 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8954 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8955 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8956 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8957 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8958 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8959 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8960 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8961
8962
8963
8964 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8965 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8966 .cindex "local part" "list"
8967 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8968 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8969 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8970 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8971 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8972 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8973 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8974 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8975
8976 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8977 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8978 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8979 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8980 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8981 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8982 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8983 types.
8984 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8985
8986
8987
8988
8989 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8990 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8991
8992 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8993 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8994 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8995 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8996
8997 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8998 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8999 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9000 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9001 escape character, as described in the following section.
9002
9003 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9004 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9005 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9006 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9007 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9008 reasons.
9009
9010
9011
9012 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9013 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9014 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9015 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9016 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9017 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9018 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9019 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9020
9021 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9022 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9023 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9024 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9025 .code
9026 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9027 .endd
9028 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9029 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9030 string.
9031
9032
9033
9034 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9035 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9036 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9037 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9038 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9039 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9040 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9041 encoding.
9042
9043 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9044 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9045 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9046
9047
9048 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9049 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9050 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9051 .oindex "&%-be%&"
9052 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9053 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9054 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9055 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9056 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9057 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9058 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9059 and &%nhash%&.
9060
9061 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9062 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9063 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9064
9065 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
9066 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9067 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9068 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9069 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9070 .code
9071 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9072 .endd
9073 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9074 Exim message identifier. For example:
9075 .code
9076 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9077 .endd
9078 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9079 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9080
9081
9082 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9083 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9084 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9085 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9086 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9087 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9088 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9089 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9090 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9091 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9092 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9093 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9094 being expanded.
9095
9096
9097
9098
9099 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9100 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9101 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9102 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9103 white space is significant.
9104
9105 .vlist
9106 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9107 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9108 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9109 .code
9110 $local_part
9111 ${domain}
9112 .endd
9113 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9114 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9115 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9116 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9117 given, the expansion fails.
9118
9119 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9120 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9121 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9122 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9123 .code
9124 ${lc:$local_part}
9125 .endd
9126 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9127 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9128 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9129 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9130 string easier to understand.
9131
9132 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9133 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9134 expansion item below.
9135
9136
9137 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9138 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9139 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9140 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9141 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9142 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9143 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9144 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9145 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9146 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9147 the result of the expansion.
9148 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9149 the expansion result is an empty string.
9150 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9151
9152
9153 .new
9154 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9155 .cindex authentication "results header"
9156 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9157 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9158 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9159 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9160 header line.
9161 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9162 will ba a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9163 Methods that may be present in the result include:
9164 .code
9165 none
9166 iprev
9167 auth
9168 spf
9169 dkim
9170 .endd
9171
9172 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9173 .code
9174 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9175 .endd
9176 This is safe even if no authentication reselts are available.
9177 .wen
9178
9179
9180 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9181 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9182 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9183 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9184 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9185 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9186 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9187 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9188 .display
9189 &`version `&
9190 &`serial_number `&
9191 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9192 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9193 &`notbefore `& time
9194 &`notafter `& time
9195 &`sig_algorithm `&
9196 &`signature `&
9197 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9198 &`ocsp_uri `& list
9199 &`crl_uri `& list
9200 .endd
9201 If the field is found,
9202 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9203 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9204 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9205 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9206
9207 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9208 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9209 extracted is used.
9210
9211 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9212
9213 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9214 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9215 not quite
9216 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9217 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9218 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9219 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9220 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9221 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9222 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9223 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9224
9225 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9226 take an optional modifier of "int"
9227 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9228 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9229 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9230
9231 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9232 newline-separated by default,
9233 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9234 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9235 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9236
9237 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9238 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9239 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9240 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9241 if so the element tags are omitted.
9242
9243 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9244
9245 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9246 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9247 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9248 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9249 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9250 .code
9251 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9252 .endd
9253 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9254 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9255 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9256
9257 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9258 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9259 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9260 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9261 must have the following type:
9262 .code
9263 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9264 .endd
9265 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9266 function should return one of the following values:
9267
9268 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9269 into the expanded string that is being built.
9270
9271 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9272 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9273
9274 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9275 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9276
9277 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9278
9279 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9280 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9281 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9282
9283
9284 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9285 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9286 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9287 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9288 removed.
9289 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9290 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9291 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9292
9293 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9294 appear, for example:
9295 .code
9296 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9297 .endd
9298 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9299 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9300
9301 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9302 search failure.
9303 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9304 search success.
9305
9306 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9307 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9308
9309
9310 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9311 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9312 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9313 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9314 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9315 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9316 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9317 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9318 .display
9319 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9320 .endd
9321 .vindex "&$value$&"
9322 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9323 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9324 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9325 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9326 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9327 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9328 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9329 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9330 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9331
9332 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9333 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9334 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9335 yield &"2001"&:
9336 .code
9337 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9338 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9339 .endd
9340 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9341 appear, for example:
9342 .code
9343 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9344 .endd
9345 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9346 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9347
9348
9349 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9350 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9351 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9352 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9353 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9354 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9355 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9356 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9357 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9358 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9359 <&'string3'&> as before.
9360
9361 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9362 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9363 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9364 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9365 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9366 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9367 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9368 provided. For example:
9369 .code
9370 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9371 .endd
9372 yields &"42"&, and
9373 .code
9374 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9375 .endd
9376 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9377 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9378
9379
9380 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9381 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9382 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9383 .vindex "&$item$&"
9384 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9385 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9386 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9387 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9388 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9389 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9390 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9391 .code
9392 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9393 .endd
9394 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9395 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9396
9397
9398 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9399 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9400 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9401 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9402 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9403 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9404
9405 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9406 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9407 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9408 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9409 .code
9410 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9411 .endd
9412 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9413 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9414 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9415 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9416 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9417 .code
9418 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9419 .endd
9420 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9421 letters appear. For example:
9422 .display
9423 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9424 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9425 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9426 .endd
9427
9428 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9429 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9430 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9431 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9432 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9433 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9434 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9435 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9436 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9437 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9438 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9439 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9440 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9441 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9442 .code
9443 $header_reply-to:
9444 .endd
9445 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9446 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9447 lines) may be present.
9448
9449 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9450 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9451
9452 .ilist
9453 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9454 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9455 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9456
9457 .next
9458 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9459 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9460 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9461 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9462 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9463 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9464 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9465 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9466
9467 .next
9468 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9469 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9470 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9471 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9472 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9473 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9474 .endlist ilist
9475
9476 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9477 command of the following form:
9478 .code
9479 headers charset "UTF-8"
9480 .endd
9481 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9482 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9483 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9484 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9485 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9486 ISO-8859-1.
9487
9488 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9489 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9490 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9491 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9492
9493 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9494 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9495 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9496 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9497 router or transport are not accessible.
9498
9499 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9500 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9501 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9502 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9503 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9504 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9505 point they are added.
9506 When any of the above ACLs ar
9507 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9508
9509 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9510 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9511 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9512 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9513 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9514 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9515 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9516 header.)
9517
9518 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9519 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9520 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9521 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9522 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9523 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9524 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9525 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9526
9527
9528 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9529 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9530 .cindex &%hmac%&
9531 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9532 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9533 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9534 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9535 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9536 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9537 present. For example:
9538 .code
9539 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9540 .endd
9541 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9542 produces:
9543 .code
9544 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9545 .endd
9546 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9547 an Exim configuration:
9548 .code
9549 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9550 .endd
9551 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9552 .code
9553 headers_add = \
9554 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9555 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9556 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9557 .endd
9558 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9559 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9560 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9561 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9562 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9563 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9564
9565
9566 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9567 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9568 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9569 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9570 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9571 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9572 .code
9573 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9574 .endd
9575 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9576 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9577 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9578 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9579 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9580
9581 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9582 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9583 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9584 .code
9585 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9586 .endd
9587 you can use
9588 .code
9589 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9590 .endd
9591
9592
9593
9594 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9595 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9596 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9597 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9598 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9599 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9600
9601
9602
9603 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9604 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9605 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9606 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9607 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9608 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9609 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9610 some of the braces:
9611 .code
9612 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9613 .endd
9614 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9615 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9616 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9617
9618
9619 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9620 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9621 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9622 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9623 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9624 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9625 apart from an optional leading minus,
9626 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9627
9628 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9629 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9630
9631 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9632 If the number is negative, the fields are
9633 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9634 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9635 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9636
9637 If the modulus of the
9638 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9639 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9640
9641 For example:
9642 .code
9643 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9644 .endd
9645 yields &"42"&, and
9646 .code
9647 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9648 .endd
9649 yields &"result: 42"&.
9650
9651 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9652 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9653 extracted is used.
9654 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9655
9656
9657 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9658 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9659 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9660 described in the next item.
9661
9662 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9663 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9664 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9665 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9666 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9667 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9668 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9669 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9670 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9671
9672 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9673 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9674 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9675 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9676 out by the system administrator.
9677
9678 .vindex "&$value$&"
9679 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9680 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9681 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9682 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9683 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9684 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9685 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9686 original lookup fails.
9687
9688 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9689 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9690 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9691 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9692 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9693 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9694 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9695 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9696
9697 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9698 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9699 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9700 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9701
9702 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9703 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9704 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9705 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9706
9707 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9708 .code
9709 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9710 .endd
9711 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9712 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9713 .code
9714 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9715 {$value}fail}
9716 .endd
9717
9718
9719 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9720 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9721 .vindex "&$item$&"
9722 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9723 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9724 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9725 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9726 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9727 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9728 .code
9729 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9730 .endd
9731 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9732 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9733 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9734
9735 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9736 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9737 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9738 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9739 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9740 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9741 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9742 .code
9743 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9744 .endd
9745 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9746 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9747 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9748 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9749 example,
9750 .code
9751 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9752 .endd
9753 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9754
9755
9756
9757 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9758 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9759 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9760 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9761 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9762 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9763 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9764 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9765
9766 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9767 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9768 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9769 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9770 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9771 not its contents.
9772
9773 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9774 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9775 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9776
9777 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9778 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9779
9780
9781 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9782 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9783 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9784 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9785 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9786 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9787 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9788 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9789
9790 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9791 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9792 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9793 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9794 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9795 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9796 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9797 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9798 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9799 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9800
9801 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9802 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9803 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9804 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9805
9806 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9807 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9808 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9809 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9810 is the expansion of the third argument.
9811
9812 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9813 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9814 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9815
9816 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9817 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9818 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9819 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9820 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9821 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9822 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9823 newlines are left in the string.
9824 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9825 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9826 the string expansion fails.
9827
9828 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9829 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9830
9831
9832
9833 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9834 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9835 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9836 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9837 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9838 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9839 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9840 examples:
9841 .code
9842 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9843 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9844 .endd
9845 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9846 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9847 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9848 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9849 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9850 example:
9851 .code
9852 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9853 .endd
9854 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9855 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9856 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9857 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9858 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9859 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9860 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9861 .code
9862 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9863 .endd
9864 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9865 and must be present if the argument is given.
9866 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9867 One option type is currently recognised, defining whether (the default)
9868 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9869 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9870 .code
9871 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9872 .endd
9873 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9874 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9875 turns them into spaces:
9876 .code
9877 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9878 .endd
9879 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9880 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9881 addition, the following errors can occur:
9882
9883 .ilist
9884 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9885 .next
9886 Failure to connect the socket;
9887 .next
9888 Failure to write the request string;
9889 .next
9890 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9891 .endlist
9892
9893 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9894 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9895 errors occurs. For example:
9896 .code
9897 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9898 {socket failure}}
9899 .endd
9900 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9901 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9902 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9903 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9904 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9905
9906 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9907 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9908
9909
9910 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9911 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9912 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9913 .vindex "&$value$&"
9914 .vindex "&$item$&"
9915 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9916 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9917 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9918 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9919 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9920 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9921 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9922 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9923 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9924 .code
9925 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9926 .endd
9927 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9928 can be found:
9929 .code
9930 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9931 .endd
9932 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9933 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9934 expansion items.
9935
9936 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9937 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9938 expansion item above.
9939
9940 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9941 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9942 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9943 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9944 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9945 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9946 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9947 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9948 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9949
9950 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9951 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9952 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9953 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9954 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9955 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9956 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9957 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9958 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9959 character.
9960
9961 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9962 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9963 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9964 .vindex "&$value$&"
9965 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9966 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9967 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9968 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9969 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9970 &$value$&.
9971
9972 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9973 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9974 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9975 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9976
9977 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9978 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9979 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9980 troubleshoot:
9981 .code
9982 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9983 log_message = Output of id: $value
9984 .endd
9985 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9986 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9987 .code
9988 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9989 .endd
9990
9991 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9992 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9993 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9994 .code
9995 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9996 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9997 ...
9998 endif
9999 .endd
10000 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10001 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10002 commands.
10003
10004 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10005 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10006 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10007 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10008
10009 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10010 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10011
10012
10013 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10014 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10015 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10016 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10017 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10018 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10019 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10020 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10021 .code
10022 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10023 .endd
10024 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10025 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10026 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10027 .code
10028 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10029 .endd
10030 yields &"defabc"&, and
10031 .code
10032 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10033 .endd
10034 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10035 the regular expression from string expansion.
10036
10037
10038
10039 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10040 .cindex sorting "a list"
10041 .cindex list sorting
10042 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10043 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10044 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
10045 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10046 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10047 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10048 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10049 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10050 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10051 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10052 to give values for comparison.
10053
10054 The item result is a sorted list,
10055 with the original list separator,
10056 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10057
10058 Examples:
10059 .code
10060 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10061 .endd
10062 sorts a list of numbers, and
10063 .code
10064 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10065 .endd
10066 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10067
10068
10069 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10070 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10071 .cindex "substring extraction"
10072 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10073 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10074 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10075 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10076 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10077 .code
10078 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10079 .endd
10080 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10081 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10082 omitted.
10083
10084 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10085 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10086 length required. For example
10087 .code
10088 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10089 .endd
10090 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10091 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10092 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10093 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
10094
10095 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10096 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
10097 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10098 .code
10099 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10100 .endd
10101 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10102 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10103 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10104 .code
10105 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10106 .endd
10107 yields an empty string, but
10108 .code
10109 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10110 .endd
10111 yields &"1"&.
10112
10113 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10114 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
10115 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10116 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10117 .code
10118 ${substr_-1:abcde}
10119 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10120 .endd
10121 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10122
10123
10124
10125 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10126 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10127 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10128 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10129 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
10130 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10131 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10132 replacement list. For example
10133 .code
10134 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10135 .endd
10136 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10137 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10138 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10139 place.
10140 .endlist
10141
10142
10143
10144 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10145 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10146 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10147 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10148 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10149 following operations can be performed:
10150
10151 .vlist
10152 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10153 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10154 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10155 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10156 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10157 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10158
10159
10160 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10161 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10162 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10163 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10164 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10165 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10166 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10167 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10168 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10169
10170 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10171 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10172 character. For example:
10173 .code
10174 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10175 .endd
10176 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10177 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10178 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10179 separator explicitly:
10180 .code
10181 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10182 .endd
10183
10184 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10185 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10186 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10187 processing lists.
10188
10189 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10190 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10191 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10192 email address separator. For the example header line:
10193 .code
10194 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10195 .endd
10196 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10197 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10198 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10199 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10200 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10201 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10202 quoted.
10203 .code
10204 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10205 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10206 user@example.com
10207 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10208 Last:user@example.com
10209 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10210 user@example.com
10211 .endd
10212
10213 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10214 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10215 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10216 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10217 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10218 Only lowercase letters are used.
10219
10220 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10221 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10222 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10223 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10224 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10225
10226 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10227 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10228 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10229 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10230 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10231 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10232 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10233 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10234 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10235
10236 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10237 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10238 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10239 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10240 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10241 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10242 string.
10243
10244 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10245 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10246 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10247 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10248 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10249 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10250
10251 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10252 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10253
10254
10255 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10256 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10257 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10258 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10259 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10260
10261
10262 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10263 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10264 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10265 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10266 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10267
10268
10269 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10270 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10271 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10272 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10273 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10274 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10275 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10276
10277 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10278 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10279 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10280 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10281 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10282 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10283
10284
10285 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10286 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10287 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10288 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10289 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10290 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10291 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10292 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10293 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10294 C programming language):
10295 .table2 70pt 300pt
10296 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10297 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10298 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10299 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10300 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10301 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10302 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10303 .endtable
10304 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10305 space is permitted before or after operators.
10306
10307 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10308 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10309 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10310 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10311 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10312
10313 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10314 or 1024*1024*1024,
10315 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10316 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10317
10318 .display
10319 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10320 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10321 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10322 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10323 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10324 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10325 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10326 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10327 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10328 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10329 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10330 .endd
10331
10332 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10333 .code
10334 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10335 condition = \
10336 ${if and { \
10337 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10338 { \
10339 < \
10340 {$recipients_count} \
10341 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10342 } \
10343 }{yes}{no}}
10344 .endd
10345 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10346 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10347
10348
10349 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10350 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10351 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10352 example,
10353 .code
10354 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10355 .endd
10356 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10357 and then re-expands what it has found.
10358
10359
10360 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10361 .cindex "Unicode"
10362 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10363 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10364 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10365 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10366 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10367 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10368 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10369 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10370 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10371
10372 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10373 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10374 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10375 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10376 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10377 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10378 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10379
10380
10381 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10382 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10383 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10384 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10385 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10386 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10387 .code
10388 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10389 .endd
10390 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10391 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10392
10393
10394
10395 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10396 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10397 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10398 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10399 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10400 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10401
10402
10403
10404 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10405 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10406 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10407 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10408 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10409 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10410 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10411
10412
10413 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10414 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10415 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10416 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10417 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10418 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10419 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10420
10421 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10422 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10423 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10424 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10425 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10426 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10427 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10428 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10429 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10430
10431
10432 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10433 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10434 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10435 .cindex "lower casing"
10436 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10437 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10438 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10439 .code
10440 ${lc:$local_part}
10441 .endd
10442
10443 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10444 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10445 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10446 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10447 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10448 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10449 .code
10450 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10451 .endd
10452 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10453 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10454 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10455
10456
10457 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10458 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10459 .cindex "list" "item count"
10460 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10461 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10462 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10463
10464
10465 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10466 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10467 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10468 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10469 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10470 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10471 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10472 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10473 matching list is returned.
10474
10475
10476 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10477 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10478 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10479 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10480 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10481 empty.
10482
10483
10484 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10485 .cindex "masked IP address"
10486 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10487 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10488 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10489 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10490 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10491 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10492 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10493 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10494 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10495 .code
10496 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10497 .endd
10498 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10499 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10500 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10501 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10502 .code
10503 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10504 .endd
10505 returns the string
10506 .code
10507 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10508 .endd
10509 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10510
10511
10512 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10513 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10514 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10515 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10516 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10517 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10518 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10519
10520 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10521 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10522
10523
10524 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10525 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10526 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10527 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10528 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10529 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10530 .code
10531 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10532 .endd
10533 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10534
10535
10536 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10537 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10538 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10539 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10540 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10541 is an empty string or
10542 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10543 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10544 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10545 respectively For example,
10546 .code
10547 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10548 .endd
10549 becomes
10550 .code
10551 "ab\"*\"cd"
10552 .endd
10553 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10554 variable or a message header.
10555
10556 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10557 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10558 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10559 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10560 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10561 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10562 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10563
10564
10565 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10566 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10567 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10568 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10569 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10570 .code
10571 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10572 .endd
10573 returns
10574 .code
10575 two%20%5C2A%20two
10576 .endd
10577 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10578 yields an unchanged string.
10579
10580
10581 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10582 .cindex "random number"
10583 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10584 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10585 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10586 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10587 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10588 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10589 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10590 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10591 random().
10592
10593
10594 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10595 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10596 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10597 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10598 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10599 for DNS. For example,
10600 .code
10601 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10602 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10603 .endd
10604 returns
10605 .code
10606 4.2.0.192
10607 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10608 .endd
10609
10610
10611 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10612 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10613 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10614 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10615 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10616 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10617 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10618 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10619 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10620 characters
10621 .code
10622 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10623 .endd
10624 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10625 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10626 characters.
10627
10628
10629 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10630 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10631 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10632 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10633 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10634 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10635 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10636 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10637
10638 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10639 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10640 to use this operator as well.
10641
10642
10643
10644 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10645 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10646 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10647 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10648 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10649 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10650 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10651
10652
10653 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10654 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10655 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10656 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10657 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10658 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10659 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10660
10661 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10662 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10663
10664
10665 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10666 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10667 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10668 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10669 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10670 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10671 and returns
10672 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10673
10674 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10675 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10676
10677
10678 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10679 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10680 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10681 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10682 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10683 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10684 and returns
10685 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10686
10687 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10688 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10689 with 256 being the default.
10690
10691 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10692 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10693 .new
10694 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10695 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10696 .wen
10697
10698
10699 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10700 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10701 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10702 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10703 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10704 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10705 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10706 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10707 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10708 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10709 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10710 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10711 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10712
10713 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10714 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10715 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10716
10717 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10718 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10719 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10720
10721
10722
10723 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10724 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10725 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10726 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10727 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10728 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10729
10730
10731 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10732 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10733 .cindex "substring extraction"
10734 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10735 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10736 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10737 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10738 .code
10739 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10740 .endd
10741 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10742 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10743
10744 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10745 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10746 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10747 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10748 seconds.
10749
10750 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10751 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10752 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10753 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10754 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10755 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10756 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10757
10758 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10759 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10760 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10761 .cindex "upper casing"
10762 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10763 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10764 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10765
10766 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10767 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10768 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10769 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10770 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10771 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10772 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10773
10774 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10775 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10776 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10777 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10778 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10779 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10780 .cindex EAI
10781 .cindex internationalisation
10782 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10783 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10784 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10785 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10786 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10787 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10788 .endlist
10789
10790
10791
10792
10793
10794
10795 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10796 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10797 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10798 while expanding strings:
10799
10800 .vlist
10801 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10802 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10803 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10804 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10805 condition.
10806
10807 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10808 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10809 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10810 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10811 are:
10812 .display
10813 &`= `& equal
10814 &`== `& equal
10815 &`> `& greater
10816 &`>= `& greater or equal
10817 &`< `& less
10818 &`<= `& less or equal
10819 .endd
10820 For example:
10821 .code
10822 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10823 .endd
10824 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10825 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10826 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10827 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10828 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10829 zero.
10830
10831 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10832 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10833 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10834
10835
10836 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10837 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10838 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10839 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10840 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10841 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10842 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10843 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10844 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10845 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10846 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10847 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10848 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10849 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10850
10851 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10852 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10853 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10854 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10855 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10856 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10857 false if zero.
10858 An empty string is treated as false.
10859 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10860 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10861 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10862
10863 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10864 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10865 For example:
10866 .code
10867 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10868 .endd
10869
10870
10871 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10872 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10873 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10874 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10875 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10876 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10877 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10878 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10879
10880 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10881
10882 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10883 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10884 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10885 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10886 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10887 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10888 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10889 included in the binary.
10890
10891 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10892 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10893 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10894 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10895 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10896 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10897 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10898 string in LDAP form is:
10899 .code
10900 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10901 .endd
10902 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10903 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10904 .code
10905 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10906 .endd
10907 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10908 supported:
10909
10910 .ilist
10911 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10912 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10913 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10914 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10915 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10916 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10917 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10918 comparison fails.
10919
10920 .next
10921 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10922 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10923 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10924 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10925 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10926 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10927
10928 .next
10929 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10930 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10931 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10932 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10933 whatever its length.
10934
10935 .next
10936 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10937 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10938 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10939 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10940 .endlist
10941 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10942 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10943 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10944 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10945 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10946 support &[crypt16()]&.
10947
10948 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10949 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10950 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10951 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10952 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10953
10954 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10955 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10956 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10957
10958 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10959 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10960 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10961 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10962 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10963
10964 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10965 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10966 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10967 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10968 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10969 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10970 .code
10971 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10972 .endd
10973 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10974 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10975
10976 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10977 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10978 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10979 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10980 exists in the message. For example,
10981 .code
10982 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10983 .endd
10984 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10985 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10986
10987 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10988 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10989 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10990 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10991 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10992 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10993 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10994 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10995 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10996
10997 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10998 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10999 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11000 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11001 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11002 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11003 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11004 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11005
11006 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11007 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11008 .cindex "first delivery"
11009 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11010 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11011 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11012 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11013
11014
11015 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11016 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11017 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11018 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11019 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11020 .vindex "&$item$&"
11021 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11022 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11023 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11024 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11025 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11026 .ilist
11027 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11028 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11029 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11030 .next
11031 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11032 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11033 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11034 .endlist
11035 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11036 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11037 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11038 list separator is changed to a comma:
11039 .code
11040 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11041 .endd
11042 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11043 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11044
11045 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11046
11047
11048 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11049 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11050 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11051 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11052 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11053 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11054 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11055 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11056 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11057 case-independent.
11058
11059 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11060 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11061 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11062 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11063 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11064 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11065 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11066 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11067 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11068 case-independent.
11069
11070 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11071 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11072 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11073 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11074 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11075 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11076 is true.
11077
11078 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11079 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11080 .code
11081 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11082 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11083 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11084 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11085 .endd
11086
11087 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11088 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11089 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11090 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11091 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11092 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11093 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11094 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11095 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11096 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11097 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11098
11099 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11100 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11101 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11102 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11103 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11104
11105 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11106 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11107 check.
11108 This is no longer the case.
11109
11110 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11111 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11112 .code
11113 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11114 .endd
11115 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11116
11117 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11118 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11119 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11120 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11121 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11122 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11123 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11124 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11125 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11126 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11127 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11128 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11129 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11130 this can be used.
11131
11132
11133 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11134 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11135 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11136 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11137 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11138 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11139 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11140 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11141 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11142 case-independent.
11143
11144 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11145 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11146 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11147 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11148 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11149 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11150 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11151 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11152 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11153 case-independent.
11154
11155
11156 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11157 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11158 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11159 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11160 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11161 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11162 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11163 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11164 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11165 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11166 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11167 For example,
11168 .code
11169 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11170 .endd
11171 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11172 backslashes is also required.
11173
11174 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11175 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11176 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11177 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11178 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11179 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11180
11181 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11182 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11183 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11184 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11185 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11186 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11187 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11188 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11189
11190 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11191 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11192 See &*match_local_part*&.
11193
11194 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11195 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11196 See &*match_local_part*&.
11197
11198 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11199 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11200 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11201 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11202 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11203 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11204 .code
11205 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11206 .endd
11207 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11208
11209 .ilist
11210 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11211 .next
11212 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11213 .next
11214 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11215 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11216 in a single test such as
11217 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11218 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11219 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11220 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11221 .code
11222 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11223 .endd
11224 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11225 .next
11226 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11227 .next
11228 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11229 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11230 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11231 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11232 masks. For example:
11233 .code
11234 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11235 .endd
11236 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11237 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11238 address mask, for example:
11239 .code
11240 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11241 .endd
11242 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11243 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11244 .code
11245 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11246 .endd
11247 .endlist ilist
11248
11249 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11250 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11251
11252 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11253
11254 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11255 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11256 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11257 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11258 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11259 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11260 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11261 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11262 example is:
11263 .code
11264 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11265 .endd
11266 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11267 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11268 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11269 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11270 .code
11271 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11272 .endd
11273 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11274 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11275 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11276 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11277 caselessly.
11278
11279 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11280 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11281
11282 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11283 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11284 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11285 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11286
11287 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11288 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11289 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11290 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11291 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11292 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11293 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11294 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11295 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11296 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11297 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11298 .code
11299 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11300 .endd
11301 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11302 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11303
11304 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11305 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11306 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11307 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11308 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11309 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11310 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11311
11312 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11313 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11314 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11315 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11316 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11317 .code
11318 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11319 .endd
11320 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11321 .code
11322 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11323 .endd
11324 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11325 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11326 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11327 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11328 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11329 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11330 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11331 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11332
11333
11334 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11335 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11336 .cindex "Cyrus"
11337 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11338 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11339 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11340 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11341 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11342 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11343
11344 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11345 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11346 building Exim. For example:
11347 .code
11348 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11349 .endd
11350 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11351 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11352 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11353 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11354
11355 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11356 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11357 configuration, you might have this:
11358 .code
11359 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11360 .endd
11361 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11362 .code
11363 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11364 .endd
11365 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11366 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11367 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11368 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11369 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11370 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11371
11372
11373 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11374 .cindex "Radius"
11375 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11376 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11377 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11378 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11379 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11380 support.
11381
11382 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11383 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11384 this library, you need to set
11385 .code
11386 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11387 .endd
11388 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11389 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11390 .code
11391 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11392 .endd
11393 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11394 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11395 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11396
11397 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11398 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11399 the authentication is successful. For example:
11400 .code
11401 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11402 .endd
11403
11404
11405 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11406 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11407 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11408 .cindex "Cyrus"
11409 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11410 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11411 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11412 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11413 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11414 by a process that is not running as root.
11415
11416 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11417 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11418 building Exim. For example:
11419 .code
11420 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11421 .endd
11422 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11423 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11424 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11425
11426 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11427 two are mandatory. For example:
11428 .code
11429 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11430 .endd
11431 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11432 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11433 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11434 .endlist vlist
11435
11436
11437
11438 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11439 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11440 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11441 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11442 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11443 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11444 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11445
11446
11447 .vlist
11448 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11449 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11450 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11451 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11452 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11453 For example,
11454 .code
11455 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11456 .endd
11457 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11458 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11459 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11460
11461 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11462 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11463 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11464 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11465 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11466 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11467 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11468 parsed but not evaluated.
11469 .endlist
11470 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11471
11472
11473
11474
11475 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11476 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11477 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11478 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11479 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11480
11481 .vlist
11482 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11483 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11484 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11485 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11486 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11487 In the expansion condition case
11488 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11489 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11490 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11491 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11492 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11493 matching condition.
11494
11495 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11496 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11497 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11498 any unused variables being made empty.
11499
11500 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11501 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11502 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11503 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11504 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11505 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11506 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11507 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11508 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11509 during subsequent delivery.
11510
11511 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11512 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11513 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11514 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11515 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11516 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11517 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11518 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11519 delivery.
11520
11521 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11522 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11523 this variable has the number of arguments.
11524
11525 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11526 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11527 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11528 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11529 be preserved by coding like this:
11530 .code
11531 warn !verify = sender
11532 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11533 .endd
11534 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11535 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11536 failure.
11537
11538 .vitem &$address_data$&
11539 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11540 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11541 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11542 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11543 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11544 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11545 user filter files.
11546
11547 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11548 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11549 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11550 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11551 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11552 from the child's routing.
11553
11554 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11555 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11556 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11557 address.
11558
11559 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11560 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11561 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11562
11563 .vitem &$address_file$&
11564 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11565 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11566 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11567 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11568 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11569 .code
11570 /home/r2d2/savemail
11571 .endd
11572 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11573 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11574 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11575 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11576 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11577 to the relevant file.
11578
11579 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11580 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11581 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11582 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11583
11584 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11585 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11586 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11587 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11588
11589 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11590 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11591 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11592 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11593 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11594 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11595 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11596 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11597 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11598 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11599 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11600 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11601 command line option.
11602
11603 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11604 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11605 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11606 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11607 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11608 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11609 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11610 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11611 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11612 the ACL's as well.
11613
11614
11615 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11616 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11617 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11618 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11619 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11620 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11621 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11622 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11623 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11624 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11625 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11626
11627 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11628 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11629 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11630 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11631 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11632
11633
11634 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11635 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11636 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11637 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11638 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11639 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11640 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11641 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11642 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11643 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11644 an undefined mechanism.
11645
11646 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11647 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11648 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11649 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11650 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11651 the ACL malware condition.
11652
11653 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11654 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11655 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11656 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11657 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11658 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11659
11660 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11661 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11662 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11663 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11664 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11665 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11666 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11667
11668 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11669 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11670 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11671 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11672 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11673
11674 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11675 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11676 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11677 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11678 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11679
11680 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11681 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11682 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11683 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11684 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11685 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11686 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11687
11688 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11689 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11690 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11691 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11692 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11693 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11694 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11695
11696 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11697 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11698 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11699 address that was connected to.
11700
11701 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11702 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11703 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11704 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11705 compilations of the same version of the program.
11706
11707 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11708 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11709 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11710 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11711 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11712 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11713
11714 .vitem &$config_file$&
11715 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11716 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11717
11718 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
11719 Results of DKIM verification.
11720 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11721
11722 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11723 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11724 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11725 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11726 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11727 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11728 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11729 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11730 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11731 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11732 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11733 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11734 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11735 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11736 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11737 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11738 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11739 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11740 &$dkim_key_length$&
11741 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11742 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11743
11744 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11745 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11746 When a message has been received this variable contains
11747 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11748 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11749
11750 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11751 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11752 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11753 &$dnslist_value$&
11754 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11755 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11756 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11757 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11758 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11759 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11760 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11761 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11762 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11763
11764 .vitem &$domain$&
11765 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11766 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11767 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11768 case for &$domain$&.
11769
11770 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11771 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11772 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11773 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11774
11775 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11776 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11777 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11778 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11779 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11780 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11781
11782 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11783 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11784 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11785
11786 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11787
11788 .ilist
11789 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11790 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11791 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11792 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11793 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11794 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11795 the &(smtp)& transport.
11796
11797 .next
11798 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11799 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11800 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11801 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11802
11803 .next
11804 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11805 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11806 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11807 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11808 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11809 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11810
11811 .next
11812 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11813 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11814 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11815 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11816 .endlist
11817
11818
11819 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11820 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11821 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11822 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11823 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11824 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11825 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11826 used.
11827
11828 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11829 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11830 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11831 to nothing.
11832
11833 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11834 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11835 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11836
11837 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11838 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11839 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11840
11841 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11842 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11843 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11844
11845 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11846 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11847 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11848 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11849 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11850 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11851
11852 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11853 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11854 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11855 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11856 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11857
11858 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11859 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11860 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11861 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11862 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11863
11864 .vitem &$home$&
11865 .vindex "&$home$&"
11866 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11867 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11868 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11869 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11870 by a setting on the transport itself.
11871
11872 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11873 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11874 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11875
11876 .vitem &$host$&
11877 .vindex "&$host$&"
11878 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11879 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11880 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11881 to local and remote transports.
11882
11883 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11884 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11885 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11886 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11887 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11888 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11889 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11890 is connected.
11891
11892 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11893 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11894 client is connected.
11895
11896
11897 .vitem &$host_address$&
11898 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11899 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11900 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11901 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11902
11903 .vitem &$host_data$&
11904 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11905 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11906 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11907 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11908 .code
11909 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11910 message = $host_data
11911 .endd
11912 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11913 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11914 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11915 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11916 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11917 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11918 variables is set to &"1"&.
11919
11920 .ilist
11921 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11922 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11923
11924 .next
11925 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11926 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11927 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11928 .endlist ilist
11929
11930 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11931 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11932 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11933 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11934 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11935 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11936 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11937 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11938 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11939 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11940
11941 .new
11942 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
11943 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
11944 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11945 .wen
11946
11947
11948 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11949 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11950 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11951
11952 .vitem &$host_port$&
11953 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11954 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11955 for an outbound connection.
11956
11957 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11958 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11959 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11960 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11961 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11962 to &$spool_directory$& later.
11963
11964 .vitem &$inode$&
11965 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11966 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11967 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11968 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11969 a unique name for the file.
11970
11971 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11972 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11973 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11974
11975 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11976 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11977 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11978
11979 .vitem &$item$&
11980 .vindex "&$item$&"
11981 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11982 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11983 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11984 empty.
11985
11986 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11987 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11988 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11989 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11990 lookup.
11991
11992 .vitem &$load_average$&
11993 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11994 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11995 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11996 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11997
11998 .vitem &$local_part$&
11999 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12000 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12001 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12002 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12003 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12004
12005 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12006 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12007 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12008 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12009 once.
12010
12011 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12012 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12013 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12014 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12015 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12016 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12017
12018 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12019 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12020 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
12021 &$address_pipe$&).
12022
12023 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12024 local part of the recipient address.
12025
12026 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12027 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12028 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12029
12030 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12031 the addresses
12032 .code
12033 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12034 abc\:xyz@test.example
12035 .endd
12036 the value of &$local_part$& is
12037 .code
12038 abc:xyz
12039 .endd
12040 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12041 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12042 have:
12043 .code
12044 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12045 .endd
12046 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12047 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12048 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12049
12050 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12051 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12052 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12053 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12054 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12055 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12056 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12057
12058 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12059 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12060 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12061 variable expands to nothing.
12062
12063 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12064 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12065 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12066 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12067 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12068
12069 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12070 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12071 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12072 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12073 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12074
12075 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12076 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12077 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12078 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12079
12080 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12081 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12082 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12083
12084 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12085 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12086 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12087 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12088 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12089 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12090 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12091 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12092
12093 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12094 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12095 This contains the expanded value of the
12096 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12097 been read.
12098
12099 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12100 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12101 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12102 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12103 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12104 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12105
12106 .vitem &$log_space$&
12107 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12108 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12109 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12110 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12111 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12112 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12113
12114
12115 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12116 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12117 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12118 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12119 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12120 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12121 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12122 and &"yes"& if it was.
12123 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12124 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12125 as authenticated data.
12126
12127 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12128 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12129 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12130 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12131 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12132 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12133 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12134 variable is empty.
12135
12136 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12137 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12138 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12139 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12140 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12141
12142 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12143 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12144 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12145 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12146 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12147 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12148 character(s).
12149 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12150
12151 .vitem &$message_age$&
12152 .cindex "message" "age of"
12153 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12154 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12155 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12156 delivery attempt.
12157
12158 .vitem &$message_body$&
12159 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12160 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12161 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12162 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12163 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12164 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12165 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12166 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12167 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12168
12169 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12170 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12171 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12172 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12173 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12174
12175 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12176 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12177 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12178 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12179 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12180 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12181 &$message_body$&.
12182
12183 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12184 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12185 .cindex "message body" "size"
12186 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12187 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12188 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12189 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12190 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12191
12192 If the spool file is wireformat
12193 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12194 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12195
12196 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12197 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12198 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12199 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12200 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12201 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12202 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12203 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12204
12205 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12206 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12207 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12208 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12209 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12210 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12211
12212 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12213 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12214 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12215 contents of header lines is done.
12216
12217 .vitem &$message_id$&
12218 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12219
12220 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12221 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12222 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12223 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12224 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12225 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12226 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12227 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12228 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12229 from the body is not counted.
12230
12231 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12232 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12233 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12234 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12235 header and the body).
12236
12237 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12238 .code
12239 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12240 condition = \
12241 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12242 .endd
12243 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12244 message has not yet been received.
12245
12246 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12247
12248 .vitem &$message_size$&
12249 .cindex "size" "of message"
12250 .cindex "message" "size"
12251 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12252 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12253 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12254 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12255 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12256 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12257 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12258 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12259 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12260
12261 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12262 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12263 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12264 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12265
12266 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12267 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12268 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12269 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12270
12271 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12272 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12273 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12274
12275 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12276 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12277 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12278 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12279 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12280 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12281 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12282 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12283 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12284 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12285
12286 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12287 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12288 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12289
12290 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12291 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12292 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12293 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12294 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12295 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12296 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12297 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12298 the original address.
12299
12300 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12301 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12302 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12303 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12304 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12305
12306 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12307 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12308 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12309
12310 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12311 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12312 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12313 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12314 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12315 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12316 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12317 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12318 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12319
12320 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12321 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12322 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12323 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12324 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12325 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12326 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12327 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12328 user.
12329
12330 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12331 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12332 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12333 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12334
12335 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12336 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12337 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12338 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12339
12340 .vitem &$pid$&
12341 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12342 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12343 This variable contains the current process id.
12344
12345 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12346 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12347 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12348 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12349 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12350 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12351 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12352 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12353 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12354 variable"& error if encountered.
12355
12356 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12357 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12358 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12359 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12360 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12361 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12362 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12363
12364
12365 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12366 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12367 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12368 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12369 &$proxy_session$&
12370 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12371 or SOCKS5 support.
12372 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12373
12374 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12375 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12376 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12377 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12378
12379 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12380 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12381 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12382 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12383
12384 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12385 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12386 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12387 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12388
12389 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12390 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12391 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12392 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12393
12394 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12395 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12396 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12397
12398 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12399 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12400 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12401 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12402
12403 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12404 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12405 .cindex "named queues"
12406 .cindex queues named
12407 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12408
12409 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12410 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12411 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12412 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12413 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12414
12415 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12416 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12417 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12418 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12419 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12420 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12421
12422 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12423 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12424 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12425 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12426 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12427
12428 .vitem &$received_count$&
12429 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12430 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12431 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12432 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12433 delivering.
12434
12435 .vitem &$received_for$&
12436 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12437 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12438 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12439 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12440 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12441
12442 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12443 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12444 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12445 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12446 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12447 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12448 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12449 option.
12450
12451 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12452 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12453 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12454 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12455 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12456 time.
12457 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12458
12459 .vitem &$received_port$&
12460 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12461 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12462
12463 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12464 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12465 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12466 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12467 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12468 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12469 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12470 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12471 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12472
12473 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12474 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12475 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12476 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12477 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12478 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12479
12480 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12481 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12482 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12483
12484 .vitem &$received_time$&
12485 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12486 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12487 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12488
12489 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12490 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12491 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12492 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12493 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12494 .display
12495 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12496 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12497 .endd
12498 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12499 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12500 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12501 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12502
12503 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12504 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12505 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12506 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12507
12508 .ilist
12509 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12510 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12511
12512 .next
12513 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12514
12515 .next
12516 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12517 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12518 MAIL).
12519
12520 .next
12521 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12522 .next
12523
12524 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12525 .endlist
12526
12527 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12528 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12529
12530 .vitem &$recipients$&
12531 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12532 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12533 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12534 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12535 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12536 cases:
12537
12538 .olist
12539 In a system filter file.
12540 .next
12541 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12542 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12543 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12544 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12545 .next
12546 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12547 .endlist
12548
12549
12550 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12551 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12552 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12553 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12554 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12555 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12556
12557
12558 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12559 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12560 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12561 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12562
12563 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12564 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12565 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12566 these variables contain the
12567 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12568
12569
12570 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12571 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12572 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12573 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12574 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12575 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12576 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12577
12578 .vitem &$return_path$&
12579 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12580 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12581 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12582 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12583 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12584 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12585 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12586 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12587 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12588 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12589 envelope sender.
12590
12591 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12592 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12593 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12594
12595 .vitem &$router_name$&
12596 .cindex "router" "name"
12597 .cindex "name" "of router"
12598 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12599 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12600
12601 .vitem &$runrc$&
12602 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12603 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12604 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12605 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12606 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12607 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12608 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12609 another.
12610
12611 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12612 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12613 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12614 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12615 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12616 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12617 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12618 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12619
12620 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12621 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12622 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12623 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12624 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12625 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12626
12627 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12628 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12629 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12630 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12631 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12632 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12633 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12634 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12635
12636 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12637 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12638 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12639
12640 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12641 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12642 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12643
12644 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12645 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12646 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12647 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12648 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12649 this:
12650 .display
12651 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12652 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12653 .endd
12654 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12655 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12656 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12657 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12658
12659 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12660 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12661 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12662 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12663 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12664 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12665 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12666 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12667 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12668 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12669 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12670 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12671 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12672
12673 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12674 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12675 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12676 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12677 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12678
12679 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12680 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12681 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12682 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12683 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12684 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12685
12686 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12687 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12688 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12689 this variable contains that
12690 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12691
12692 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12693 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12694 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12695 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12696 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12697 &$authenticated_id$&.
12698
12699 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12700 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12701 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12702 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12703 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12704 resolver library states that both
12705 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12706 other times, this variable is false.
12707
12708 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12709 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12710 library, by setting:
12711 .code
12712 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12713 .endd
12714
12715 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12716 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12717
12718 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12719 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12720
12721 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12722 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12723 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12724 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12725
12726
12727 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12728 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12729 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12730 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12731 other means, this variable is empty.
12732
12733 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12734 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12735 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12736 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12737 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12738 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12739 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12740
12741 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12742 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12743 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12744 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12745
12746 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12747 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12748 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12749 is set to &"1"&.
12750
12751 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12752 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12753 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12754 following are true:
12755
12756 .ilist
12757 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12758 .next
12759 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12760 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12761 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12762 .next
12763 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12764 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12765 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12766 .next
12767 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12768 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12769 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12770 .next
12771 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12772 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12773 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12774 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12775 .code
12776 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12777 .endd
12778 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12779 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12780 .endlist
12781
12782
12783 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12784 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12785 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12786 number that was used on the remote host.
12787
12788 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12789 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12790 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12791 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12792 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12793 called Exim.
12794
12795 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12796 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12797 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12798 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12799
12800 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12801 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12802 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12803 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12804 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12805 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12806 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12807 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12808 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12809 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12810 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12811 the parentheses.
12812
12813 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12814 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12815 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12816 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12817 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12818
12819 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12820 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12821 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12822 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12823 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12824
12825 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12826 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12827 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12828 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12829 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12830 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12831 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12832
12833 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12834 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12835 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12836 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12837 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12838
12839 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12840 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12841 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12842 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12843 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12844 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12845
12846 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12847 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12848 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12849 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12850 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12851 .code
12852 MAIL FROM:<>
12853 MAIL FROM: <>
12854 .endd
12855 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12856 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12857 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12858 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12859
12860 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12861 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12862 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12863 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12864 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12865 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12866 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12867
12868 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
12869 .cindex SMTP "command history"
12870 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
12871 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
12872 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
12873 are remembered.
12874
12875 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12876 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12877 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12878 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12879 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12880 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12881 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12882 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12883 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12884 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12885 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12886
12887 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12888 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12889 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12890 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12891 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12892 message is junk mail.
12893
12894 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12895 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12896 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12897 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12898
12899 .new
12900 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
12901 &$spf_received$& &&&
12902 &$spf_result$& &&&
12903 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
12904 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
12905 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
12906 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
12907 .wen
12908
12909 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12910 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12911 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12912
12913 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12914 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12915 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12916 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12917 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12918 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12919
12920 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12921 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12922 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12923 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12924 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12925 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12926 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12927 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12928 .code
12929 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12930 .endd
12931 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12932
12933
12934 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12935 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12936 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12937 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12938 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12939 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12940
12941 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12942 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12943 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12944 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12945 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12946 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12947 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12948 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12949
12950 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12951 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12952 the outbound.
12953
12954 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12955 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12956 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12957 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12958 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12959 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12960
12961 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12962 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12963 .cindex certificate variables
12964 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12965 inbound connection when the message was received.
12966 It is only useful as the argument of a
12967 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12968 or a &%def%& condition.
12969
12970 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
12971 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
12972
12973 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12974 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12975 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12976 inbound connection when the message was received.
12977 It is only useful as the argument of a
12978 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12979 or a &%def%& condition.
12980 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12981 which is not the leaf.
12982
12983 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12984 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12985 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12986 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12987 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12988 or a &%def%& condition.
12989
12990 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12991 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12992 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12993 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12994 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12995 or a &%def%& condition.
12996 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12997 which is not the leaf.
12998
12999 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13000 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13001 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13002 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13003
13004 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13005 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13006 the outbound.
13007
13008 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13009 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13010 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13011 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13012 and &"0"& otherwise.
13013
13014 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13015 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13016 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13017 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13018 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13019 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13020 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13021 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13022 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13023
13024 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13025 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13026 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13027
13028 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13029 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13030 This variable is
13031 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13032 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13033 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13034 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13035
13036 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13037 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13038 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13039
13040 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13041 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13042 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13043 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13044 .code
13045 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13046 1 No response to request
13047 2 Response not verified
13048 3 Verification failed
13049 4 Verification succeeded
13050 .endd
13051
13052 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13053 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13054 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13055 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13056 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13057
13058 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13059 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13060 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13061 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13062 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13063 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13064 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13065 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13066 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13067 which is not the leaf.
13068
13069 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13070 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13071 the outbound.
13072
13073 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13074 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13075 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13076 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13077 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13078 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13079 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13080 which is not the leaf.
13081
13082 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13083 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13084 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13085 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13086 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13087 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13088 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13089 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13090 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13091 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13092 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13093
13094 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13095 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13096 the outbound.
13097
13098 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13099 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13100 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13101 During outbound
13102 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13103 the transport.
13104
13105 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13106 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13107 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13108
13109 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13110 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13111 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13112 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13113
13114 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13115 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13116 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13117
13118 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13119 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13120 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13121
13122 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13123 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13124 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13125 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13126 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13127 values for those that are behind (west).
13128
13129 .vitem &$tod_log$&
13130 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13131 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13132 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13133
13134 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13135 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13136 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13137 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13138 flag.
13139
13140 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13141 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13142 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13143 -0500.
13144
13145 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13146 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13147 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13148 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13149
13150 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13151 .cindex "transport" "name"
13152 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13153 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13154 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13155
13156 .vitem &$value$&
13157 .vindex "&$value$&"
13158 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13159 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13160 &*reduce*& expansion.
13161
13162 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13163 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13164 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13165 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13166 Otherwise, empty.
13167
13168 .vitem &$version_number$&
13169 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13170 The version number of Exim.
13171
13172 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13173 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13174 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13175 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13176
13177 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13178 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13179 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13180 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13181 .endlist
13182 .ecindex IIDstrexp
13183
13184
13185
13186 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13187 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13188
13189 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13190 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13191 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13192 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13193 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13194 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13195 the line
13196 .code
13197 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13198 .endd
13199 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13200
13201
13202 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13203 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13204 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13205 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13206 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13207 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13208 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13209 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13210 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13211
13212 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13213 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13214 should usually be something like
13215 .code
13216 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13217 .endd
13218 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13219 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13220 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13221 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13222 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13223 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13224 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13225 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13226 two ways:
13227
13228 .ilist
13229 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13230 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13231 a startup when Exim is entered.
13232 .next
13233 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13234 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13235 .endlist
13236
13237 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13238 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13239
13240 .ilist
13241 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13242 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13243 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13244 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13245 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13246 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13247 defaults to false.
13248
13249
13250 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13251 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13252 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13253 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13254 forms:
13255 .code
13256 ${perl{foo}}
13257 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13258 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13259 .endd
13260 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13261 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13262 with an error message of the form
13263 .code
13264 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13265 .endd
13266 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13267 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13268 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13269 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13270 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13271 that was passed to &%die%&.
13272
13273
13274 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13275 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13276 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13277 the Perl code
13278 .code
13279 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13280 .endd
13281 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13282 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13283 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13284
13285 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13286 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13287 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13288 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13289
13290 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13291 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13292 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13293 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13294 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13295 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13296 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13297
13298
13299 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13300 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13301 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13302 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13303 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13304 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13305 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13306 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13307 avoided, but the output is lost.
13308
13309 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13310 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13311 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13312 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13313 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13314 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13315 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13316 .code
13317 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13318 .endd
13319 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13320 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13321 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13322 as the first subroutine argument.
13323 .ecindex IIDperl
13324
13325
13326 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13327 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13328
13329 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13330 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13331 "Starting the daemon"
13332 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13333 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13334 .cindex "network interface"
13335 .cindex "interface" "network"
13336 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13337 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13338 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13339 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13340 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13341 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13342 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13343 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13344 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13345 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13346 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13347
13348 .olist
13349 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13350 and ports to listen on.
13351 .next
13352 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13353 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13354 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13355 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13356 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13357 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13358 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13359 as an error situation.
13360 .next
13361 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13362 for the outgoing connection.
13363 .endlist
13364
13365
13366 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13367 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13368 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13369 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13370 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13371
13372 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13373 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13374 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13375 chapter describes how they operate.
13376
13377 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13378 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13379
13380
13381
13382 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13383 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13384 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13385 following options:
13386
13387 .ilist
13388 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13389 or service names.
13390 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13391 .next
13392 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13393 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13394 .endlist
13395
13396 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13397 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13398 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13399 colons. For example:
13400 .code
13401 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13402 192.168.23.65 ; \
13403 ::1 ; \
13404 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13405 .endd
13406 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13407 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13408
13409 .olist
13410 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13411 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13412 .code
13413 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13414 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13415 .endd
13416 .next
13417 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13418 with a colon separator, for example:
13419 .code
13420 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13421 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13422 .endd
13423 .endlist
13424
13425 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13426 default setting contains just one port:
13427 .code
13428 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13429 .endd
13430 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13431 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13432 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13433 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13434 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13435
13436
13437
13438 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13439 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13440 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13441 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13442 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13443 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13444 .code
13445 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13446 .endd
13447 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13448 .code
13449 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13450 .endd
13451 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13452
13453
13454
13455 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13456 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13457 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13458 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13459 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13460 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13461 exim.
13462
13463 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13464 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13465 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13466 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13467 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13468 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13469 .code
13470 -oX 1225
13471 .endd
13472 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13473 whereas
13474 .code
13475 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13476 .endd
13477 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13478 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13479 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13480
13481
13482
13483 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13484 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13485 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13486 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13487 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13488 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13489 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13490 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13491 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13492 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13493 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13494 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13495 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13496 the 465 TCP ports.
13497
13498 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13499 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13500 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13501
13502 The common use of this option is expected to be
13503 .code
13504 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13505 .endd
13506 per RFC 8314.
13507 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13508 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13509
13510 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13511 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13512 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13513 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13514 connections via the daemon.)
13515
13516
13517
13518
13519 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13520 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13521 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13522 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13523 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13524 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13525 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13526 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13527 .code
13528 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13529 .endd
13530 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13531 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13532 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13533 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13534 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13535 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13536 .code
13537 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13538 .endd
13539 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13540 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13541 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13542 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13543 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13544
13545 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13546 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13547 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13548 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13549 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13550 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13551 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13552 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13553 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13554 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13555 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13556 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13557
13558 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13559 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13560 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13561 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13562 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13563
13564
13565
13566 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13567 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13568 .code
13569 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13570 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13571 .endd
13572 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13573 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13574 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13575 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13576
13577 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13578 .code
13579 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13580 .endd
13581 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13582 .code
13583 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13584 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13585 .endd
13586 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13587 IPv4 loopback address only:
13588 .code
13589 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13590 .endd
13591 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13592 .code
13593 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13594 .endd
13595 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13596
13597
13598
13599 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13600 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13601 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13602 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13603 treated as local.
13604
13605 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13606 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13607 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13608 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13609
13610 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13611 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13612 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13613 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13614 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13615 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13616 used for listening. Consider this example:
13617 .code
13618 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13619 192.168.53.235 ; \
13620 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13621
13622 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13623 .endd
13624 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13625 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13626 Exim is routing.
13627
13628 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13629 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13630 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13631 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13632 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13633 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13634 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13635 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13636
13637
13638
13639 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13640 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13641 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13642 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13643 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13644 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13645 details.
13646
13647
13648
13649
13650 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13651 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13652
13653 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13654 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13655 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13656 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13657
13658 .ilist
13659 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13660 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13661 .next
13662 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13663 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13664 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13665 .next
13666 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13667 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13668 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13669 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13670 settings.
13671 .endlist
13672
13673 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13674 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13675 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13676 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13677 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13678 listed in more than one group.
13679
13680 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13681 .table2
13682 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13683 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13684 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13685 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13686 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13687 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13688 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13689 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13690 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13691 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13692 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13693 .endtable
13694
13695
13696 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13697 .table2
13698 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13699 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13700 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13701 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13702 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13703 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13704 .endtable
13705
13706
13707
13708 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13709 .table2
13710 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13711 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13712 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13713 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13714 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13715 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13716 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13717 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13718 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13719 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13720 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13721 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13722 .endtable
13723
13724
13725
13726 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13727 .table2
13728 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13729 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13730 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13731 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13732 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13733 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13734 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13735 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13736 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13737 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13738 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13739 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13740 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13741 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13742 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13743 .endtable
13744
13745
13746
13747 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13748 .table2
13749 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13750 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13751 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13752 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13753 .endtable
13754
13755
13756
13757 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13758 .table2
13759 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13760 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13761 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13762 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13763 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13764 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13765 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13766 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13767 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13768 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13769 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13770 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13771 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13772 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13773 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13774 .endtable
13775
13776
13777
13778 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13779 .table2
13780 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13781 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13782 .endtable
13783
13784
13785
13786 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13787 .table2
13788 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13789 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13790 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13791 .endtable
13792
13793
13794
13795 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13796 .table2
13797 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13798 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13799 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13800 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13801 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13802 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13803 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13804 .endtable
13805
13806
13807
13808 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13809 .table2
13810 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13811 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13812 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13813 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13814 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13815 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13816 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13817 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13818 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13819 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13820 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13821 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13822 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13823 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13824 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13825 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13826 connection"
13827 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13828 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13829 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13830 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13831 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13832 .endtable
13833
13834
13835
13836 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13837 .table2
13838 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13839 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13840 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13841 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13842 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13843 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13844 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13845 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13846 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13847 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13848 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13849 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13850 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13851 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13852 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13853 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13854 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13855 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13856 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13857 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13858 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13859 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13860 words""&"
13861 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13862 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13863 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13864 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13865 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13866 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13867 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13868 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13869 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13870 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13871 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13872 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13873 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13874 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13875 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13876 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13877 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13878 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13879 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13880 .endtable
13881
13882
13883
13884 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13885 .table2
13886 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13887 item"
13888 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13889 item"
13890 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13891 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13892 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13893 .endtable
13894
13895
13896
13897 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13898 .table2
13899 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13900 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13901 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13902 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13903 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13904 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13905 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13906 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13907 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13908 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13909 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13910 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13911 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13912 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13913 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13914 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13915 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13916 .endtable
13917
13918
13919
13920 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13921 .table2
13922 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13923 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13924 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13925 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13926 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13927 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13928 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13929 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13930 .endtable
13931
13932
13933
13934 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13935 .table2
13936 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13937 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13938 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13939 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13940 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13941 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13942 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13943 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13944 .endtable
13945
13946
13947
13948
13949 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13950 .table2
13951 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13952 .endtable
13953
13954
13955
13956
13957
13958 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13959 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13960
13961 .table2
13962 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13963 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13964 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13965 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13966 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13967 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13968 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13969 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13970 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13971 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13972 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13973 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13974 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13975 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13976 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13977 connection"
13978 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13979 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13980 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13981 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13982 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13983 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13984 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13985 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13986 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13987 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13988 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13989 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13990 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13991 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13992 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13993 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13994 .endtable
13995
13996
13997
13998 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13999 .table2
14000 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14001 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14002 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14003 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14004 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14005 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14006 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14007 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14008 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14009 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14010 .endtable
14011
14012
14013
14014 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14015 .table2
14016 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14017 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14018 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14019 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14020 words""&"
14021 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14022 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14023 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14024 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14025 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14026 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14027 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14028 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14029 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14030 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14031 .endtable
14032
14033
14034
14035 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14036 .table2
14037 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14038 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14039 directory"
14040 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14041 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14042 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14043 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14044 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14045 .endtable
14046
14047
14048
14049 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14050 .table2
14051 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14052 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14053 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14054 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14055 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14056 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14057 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14058 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14059 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14060 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14061 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14062 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14063 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14064 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14065 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14066 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14067 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14068 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14069 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14070 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14071 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14072 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14073 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14074 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14075 .endtable
14076
14077
14078
14079 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14080 .table2
14081 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14082 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14083 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14084 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14085 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14086 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14087 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14088 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14089 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14090 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14091 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14092 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14093 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14094 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14095 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14096 .endtable
14097
14098
14099
14100 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14101 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14102 &dagger;.
14103
14104 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14105 .cindex "8BITMIME"
14106 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14107 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14108 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14109 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14110 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14111 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14112 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14113
14114 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14115 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14116 It now defaults to true.
14117 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14118 .display
14119 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14120 .endd
14121
14122 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14123 .code
14124 log_selector = +8bitmime
14125 .endd
14126
14127 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14128 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14129 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14130 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14131 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14132 further details.
14133
14134 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14135 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14136 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14137 SMTP messages.
14138
14139 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14140 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14141 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14142 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14143 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14144
14145 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14146 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14147 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14148 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14149 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14150
14151 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14152 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14153 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14154 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14155
14156 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14157 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14158 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14159 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14160 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14161
14162 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14163 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14164 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14165 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14166 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14167 This option defines the ACL that,
14168 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14169 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14170 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14171 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14172
14173 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14174 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14175 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14176 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14177 of a received message.
14178 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14179
14180 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14181 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14182 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14183 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14184
14185 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14186 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14187 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14188 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14189
14190 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14191 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14192 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14193 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14194 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14195
14196
14197 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14198 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14199 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14200 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14201
14202 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14203 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14204 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14205 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14206 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14207
14208 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14209 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14210 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14211 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14212 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14213
14214 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14215 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14216 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14217 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14218 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14219
14220 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14221 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14222 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14223 further details.
14224
14225 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14226 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14227 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14228 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14229
14230 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14231 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14232 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14233 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14234
14235 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14236 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14237 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14238 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14239
14240 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14241 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14242 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14243 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14244
14245 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14246 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14247 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14248 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14249 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14250
14251 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14252 .cindex "admin user"
14253 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14254 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14255 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14256 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14257 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14258 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14259 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14260
14261 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14262 .cindex "domain literal"
14263 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14264 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14265 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14266 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14267
14268 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14269 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14270 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14271 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14272 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14273 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14274 the local host's IP addresses.
14275
14276
14277 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14278 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14279 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14280 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14281 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14282 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14283 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14284 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14285 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14286
14287 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14288 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14289 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14290 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14291 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14292 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14293 experiment if they wish.
14294
14295 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14296 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14297 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14298 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14299 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14300 suitable setting is:
14301 .code
14302 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14303 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14304 .endd
14305 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14306 .code
14307 dns_check_names_pattern =
14308 .endd
14309 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14310
14311
14312 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14313 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14314 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14315 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14316 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14317 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14318 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14319 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14320 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14321 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14322 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14323
14324 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14325 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14326 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14327 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14328 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14329 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14330
14331 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14332 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14333 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14334 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14335 .code
14336 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14337 .endd
14338 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14339 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14340 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14341 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14342
14343
14344 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14345 .cindex "thawing messages"
14346 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14347 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14348 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14349 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14350 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14351 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14352
14353 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14354 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14355 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14356
14357
14358 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14359 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14360 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14361 .code
14362 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14363 .endd
14364 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14365 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14366
14367
14368 .option bi_command main string unset
14369 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
14370 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14371 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14372 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14373 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14374
14375
14376 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14377 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14378 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14379 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14380 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14381 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14382
14383
14384 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14385 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14386 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14387 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14388
14389 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14390 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14391 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14392 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14393 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14394 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14395 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14396 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14397 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14398 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14399
14400 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14401 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14402 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14403 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14404 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14405 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14406 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14407 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14408 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14409 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14410
14411 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14412 during reception of a message.
14413 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14414
14415 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14416
14417
14418 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14419 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14420 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14421 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14422
14423
14424 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14425 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14426 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14427 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14428 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14429 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14430 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14431 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14432 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14433
14434 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14435 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14436 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14437 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14438 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14439 messages.
14440
14441 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14442 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14443 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14444 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14445 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14446 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14447 connection. A typical setting might be:
14448 .code
14449 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14450 .endd
14451 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14452 .code
14453 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14454 .endd
14455 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14456 address.
14457
14458 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14459 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14460 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14461 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14462 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14463 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14464
14465
14466 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14467 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14468 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14469 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14470
14471
14472 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14473 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14474 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14475 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14476
14477
14478 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14479 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14480 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14481 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14482
14483
14484 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14485 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14486 callout verification. The default value is
14487 .code
14488 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14489 .endd
14490 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14491
14492
14493 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14494 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14495
14496
14497 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14498 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14499
14500 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14501 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14502 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14503 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14504 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14505 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14506 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14507 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14508 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14509 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14510
14511
14512 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14513 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14514
14515
14516 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14517 .cindex "checking disk space"
14518 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14519 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14520 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14521 message is accepted.
14522
14523 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14524 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14525 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14526 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14527 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14528 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14529 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14530 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14531
14532
14533 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14534 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14535 .code
14536 check_spool_space = 100M
14537 check_spool_inodes = 100
14538 .endd
14539 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14540 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14541 transit.
14542
14543 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14544 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14545 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14546
14547 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14548 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14549 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14550 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14551 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14552 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14553
14554 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14555 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14556 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14557
14558 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14559 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14560 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14561
14562 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14563 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14564 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14565 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14566
14567 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14568 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14569 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14570 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14571 these hosts.
14572 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14573
14574 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14575 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14576 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14577 administrative user.
14578 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14579
14580 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14581 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14582 .cindex memory debugging
14583 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14584 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14585 it should normally be left as default.
14586
14587 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14588 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14589 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14590 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14591 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14592 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14593
14594 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14595 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14596 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14597 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14598 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14599 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14600 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14601
14602 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14603 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14604
14605 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14606 .cindex "warning of delay"
14607 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14608 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14609 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14610 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14611 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14612 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14613 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14614 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14615 with
14616 .code
14617 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14618 .endd
14619 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14620 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14621 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14622 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14623 .code
14624 delay_warning = 6h
14625 .endd
14626 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14627 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14628 .code
14629 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14630 .endd
14631 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14632 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14633 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14634
14635 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14636 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14637 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14638 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14639 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14640 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14641 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14642 not sent. The default is:
14643 .code
14644 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14645 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14646 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14647 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14648 } {no}{yes}}
14649 .endd
14650 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14651 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14652 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14653 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14654
14655 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14656 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14657 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14658 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14659 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14660 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14661 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14662 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14663
14664 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14665 .cindex "load average"
14666 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14667 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14668 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14669 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14670 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14671
14672
14673 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14674 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14675 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14676 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14677 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14678 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14679 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14680 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14681
14682 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14683 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14684 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14685 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14686 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14687 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14688 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14689 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14690
14691 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14692 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14693 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14694 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14695
14696
14697 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14698 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14699 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14700 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14701 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14702 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14703 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14704
14705
14706 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14707 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14708 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14709 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14710 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14711 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
14712
14713
14714 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14715 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14716 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14717 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14718 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14719 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14720 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14721 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14722 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14723 by a setting such as this:
14724 .code
14725 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14726 .endd
14727 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14728 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14729 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14730 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14731 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14732 options are applied after this global option.
14733
14734 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14735 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14736 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14737 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14738 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14739 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14740 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14741 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14742 value of this option. The default pattern is
14743 .code
14744 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14745 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14746 .endd
14747 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14748 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14749 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14750 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14751 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14752 empty string.
14753
14754 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14755 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14756 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14757
14758 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14759 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14760 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14761 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14762
14763
14764 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14765 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14766 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14767 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14768 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14769 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14770
14771 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14772
14773
14774 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14775 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14776 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14777 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
14778 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14779 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14780 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14781 domain matches this list.
14782
14783 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14784 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14785 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14786
14787
14788 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14789 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14790 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14791 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14792 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14793 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14794 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14795 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14796 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14797 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14798 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14799 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14800 to set in them.
14801 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14802
14803
14804 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14805 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14806
14807
14808 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14809 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14810 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14811 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14812 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14813 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14814 match with this expanded domain list.
14815
14816 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14817 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14818 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14819 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14820 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14821 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14822
14823 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14824 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14825 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14826
14827 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14828 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14829 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14830 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14831 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14832
14833 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14834 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14835 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14836 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14837 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14838 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14839 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14840 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14841 on.
14842
14843 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14844
14845 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14846 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14847 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14848
14849
14850 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14851 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14852 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14853 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14854
14855 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14856 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14857 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14858 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14859 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14860 and accepted from, these hosts.
14861 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14862 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14863 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14864 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14865 are sent.
14866
14867 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14868 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14869 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14870 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14871 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14872 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14873 .code
14874 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14875 .endd
14876 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14877 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14878
14879 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14880 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14881 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14882 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14883 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14884 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14885 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14886 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14887 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14888
14889
14890 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14891 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14892 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14893 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14894 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14895 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14896 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14897 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14898 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14899
14900 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14901 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14902 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14903 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14904 are examined. For example:
14905 .code
14906 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14907 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14908 postmaster@mydomain.example
14909 .endd
14910 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14911 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14912 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14913 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14914 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14915 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14916 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14917
14918
14919 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14920 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14921 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14922 .display
14923 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14924 .endd
14925 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14926 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14927 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14928 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14929 overrides the default.
14930
14931 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14932 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14933 and warning messages. For example:
14934 .code
14935 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14936 .endd
14937 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14938 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14939 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14940 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14941 not used.
14942
14943
14944 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14945 .cindex events
14946 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14947 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14948
14949
14950 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14951 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14952 .cindex "Exim group"
14953 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14954 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14955 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14956 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14957 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14958 security issues.
14959
14960
14961 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14962 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14963 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14964 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14965 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14966 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14967 other place.
14968 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14969 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14970 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14971 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14972
14973
14974 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14975 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14976 .cindex "Exim user"
14977 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14978 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14979 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14980 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14981
14982 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14983 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14984 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14985 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14986
14987
14988 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14989 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14990 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14991 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14992
14993
14994 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14995 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14996
14997 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14998 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14999 .oindex "&%-t%&"
15000 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15001 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15002 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15003 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15004 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15005 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15006 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15007 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15008 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15009 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15010 addresses.
15011
15012
15013 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15014 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15015 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15016 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15017 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15018 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15019 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15020 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15021 retries.
15022
15023 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15024 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15025 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15026 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15027
15028
15029
15030 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15031 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15032 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15033 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15034 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15035 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15036 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15037 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15038 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15039 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15040 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15041 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15042 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15043 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15044 logging that you require.
15045
15046
15047 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15048 .cindex "HP-UX"
15049 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15050 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15051 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15052 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15053 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15054 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15055 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15056 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15057
15058 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15059 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15060 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15061 user's name.
15062
15063 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15064 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15065 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15066 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15067 .code
15068 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15069 gecos_name = $1
15070 .endd
15071
15072 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15073 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15074
15075
15076 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15077 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15078 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15079 implementations of TLS.
15080
15081
15082 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15083 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15084 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15085
15086 See
15087 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15088 for documentation.
15089
15090
15091
15092 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15093 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15094 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15095 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15096 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15097 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15098
15099
15100
15101 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15102 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15103 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15104 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15105 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15106 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15107 sections are rejected.
15108
15109
15110 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15111 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15112 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15113 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15114 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15115 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15116 zero means &"no limit"&.
15117
15118
15119
15120
15121 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15122 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15123 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15124 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15125 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15126 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15127 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15128 if you want to do semantic checking.
15129 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15130 set.
15131
15132
15133 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15134 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15135 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15136 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15137 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15138 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15139 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15140 .code
15141 helo_allow_chars = _
15142 .endd
15143 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15144
15145
15146 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15147 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15148 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15149 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15150 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15151 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15152 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15153 do.
15154
15155
15156 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15157 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15158 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15159 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15160 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15161 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15162 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15163 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15164 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15165 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15166 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15167 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15168
15169 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15170 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15171 EHLO command either:
15172
15173 .ilist
15174 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15175 .next
15176 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15177 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15178 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15179 calling host address, or
15180 .next
15181 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15182 .endlist
15183
15184 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15185 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15186 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15187
15188 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15189 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15190 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15191
15192 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15193 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15194 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15195 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15196 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15197 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15198 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15199 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15200 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15201 error.
15202
15203 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15204 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15205 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15206 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15207 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15208 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15209 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15210 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15211 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15212
15213 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15214 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15215 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15216 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15217 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15218
15219 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15220 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15221 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15222 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15223
15224
15225 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15226 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15227 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15228 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15229 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15230 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15231 default configuration file contains
15232 .code
15233 host_lookup = *
15234 .endd
15235 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15236 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15237
15238 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15239 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15240 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15241
15242 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15243 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15244 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15245 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15246 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15247 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15248
15249
15250 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15251 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15252 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15253 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15254 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15255 if you want.
15256
15257 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15258 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15259 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15260 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15261
15262
15263
15264 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15265 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15266 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15267 as soon as the connection is made.
15268 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15269 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15270 connections immediately.
15271
15272 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15273 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15274 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15275 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15276 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15277
15278
15279 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15280 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15281 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15282 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15283 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15284 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15285 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15286 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15287 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15288 .code
15289 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15290 .endd
15291 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15292
15293
15294
15295 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15296 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15297 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15298 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15299
15300
15301 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15302 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15303 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15304 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15305 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15306 records
15307 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15308 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15309
15310 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15311 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15312 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15313 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15314 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15315 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15316 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15317
15318
15319 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15320 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15321 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15322 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15323 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15324
15325
15326
15327 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15328 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15329 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15330 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15331 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15332 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15333
15334 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15335 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15336 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15337 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15338 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15339 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15340 for frozen messages. For example,
15341 .code
15342 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15343 .endd
15344 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15345 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15346 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15347 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15348 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15349 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15350
15351
15352 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15353 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15354 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15355 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15356 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15357 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15358 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15359 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15360 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15361 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15362
15363
15364 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15365 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15366
15367 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15368 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15369 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15370 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15371 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15372 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15373 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15374 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15375 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15376
15377 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15378 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15379
15380 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15381 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15382 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15383 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15384
15385 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15386 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15387 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15388 anymore.
15389
15390 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15391 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15392 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15393 details.
15394
15395
15396 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15397 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15398 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15399 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15400 logged.
15401
15402
15403 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15404 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15405 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15406 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15407 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15408 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15409 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15410 and constrained to be a directory.
15411
15412
15413 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15414 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15415 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15416 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15417 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15418 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15419 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15420 and constrained to be a file.
15421
15422
15423 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15424 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15425 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15426 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15427 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15428 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15429
15430
15431 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15432 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15433 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15434 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15435 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15436 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15437 identity to be proven.
15438
15439
15440 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15441 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15442 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15443 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15444 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15445
15446
15447 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15448 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15449 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15450 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15451 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15452 with LDAP support.
15453
15454
15455 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15456 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15457 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15458 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15459 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15460 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15461 to hard/demand.
15462
15463
15464 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15465 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15466 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15467 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15468 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15469 of SSL-on-connect.
15470 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15471 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15472 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15473
15474
15475 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15476 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15477 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15478 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15479 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15480 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15481 has been built with LDAP support.
15482
15483
15484
15485 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15486 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15487 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15488 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15489 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15490 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15491 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15492
15493 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15494 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15495 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15496
15497 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15498 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15499 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15500 and the default qualify domain.
15501
15502 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15503 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15504 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15505 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15506
15507 .cindex "envelope sender"
15508 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15509 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15510 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15511
15512 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15513 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15514 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15515
15516
15517
15518
15519 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15520 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15521 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15522 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15523 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15524 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15525 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15526 example, if
15527 .code
15528 local_from_prefix = *-
15529 .endd
15530 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15531 .code
15532 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15533 .endd
15534 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15535 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15536 qualify domain.
15537
15538
15539 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15540 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15541
15542
15543 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15544 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15545 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15546 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15547 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15548 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15549 &%local_interfaces%& is
15550 .code
15551 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15552 .endd
15553 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15554 .code
15555 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15556 .endd
15557
15558 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15559 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15560 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15561 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15562 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15563 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15564 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15565 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15566
15567
15568
15569 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15570 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15571 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15572 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15573 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15574 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15575 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15576 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15577
15578
15579
15580
15581 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15582 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15583 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15584 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15585 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15586 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15587 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15588 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15589 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15590 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15591 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15592 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15593 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15594 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15595 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15596
15597
15598
15599 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15600 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15601 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15602 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15603 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15604 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15605 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15606 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15607 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15608 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15609 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15610 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15611 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15612 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15613 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15614
15615
15616 .option log_selector main string unset
15617 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15618 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15619 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15620 minus characters. For example:
15621 .code
15622 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15623 .endd
15624 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15625 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15626
15627
15628 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15629 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15630 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15631 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15632 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15633 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15634 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15635 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15636 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15637 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15638 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15639 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15640 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15641
15642
15643 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15644 .cindex "too many open files"
15645 .cindex "open files, too many"
15646 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15647 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15648 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15649 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15650 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15651 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15652 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15653 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15654 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15655 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15656 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15657 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15658
15659
15660 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15661 .cindex "length of login name"
15662 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15663 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15664 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15665 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15666 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15667 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15668
15669
15670 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15671 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15672 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15673 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15674 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15675 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15676 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15677 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15678
15679
15680 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15681 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15682 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15683 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15684 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15685 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15686 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15687
15688
15689 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15690 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15691 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15692 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15693 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15694 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15695 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15696 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15697 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15698 empty string, the option is ignored.
15699
15700
15701 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15702 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15703 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15704 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15705 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15706 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15707 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15708 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15709 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15710 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15711 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15712 colons will become hyphens.
15713
15714
15715 .option message_logs main boolean true
15716 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15717 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15718 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15719 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15720 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15721 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15722 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15723 which is not affected by this option.
15724
15725
15726 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15727 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15728 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15729 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15730 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15731 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15732 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15733 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15734 optionally followed by K or M.
15735
15736 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15737 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15738 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15739 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15740 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15741
15742 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15743 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15744 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15745 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15746 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15747 message that an individual transport can process.
15748
15749 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15750 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15751 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15752 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15753 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15754 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15755 some problems may result.
15756
15757 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15758 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15759 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15760
15761
15762 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15763 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15764 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15765 .code
15766 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15767 .endd
15768 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15769 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15770 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15771 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15772 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15773
15774
15775 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15776 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15777 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15778 contains a full description of this facility.
15779
15780
15781
15782 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15783 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15784 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15785 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15786 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15787
15788
15789 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15790 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15791 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15792 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15793 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15794 safety precaution.
15795
15796 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15797 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15798 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15799 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15800 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15801
15802 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15803 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15804 example is
15805 .code
15806 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15807 .endd
15808 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15809 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15810 transport driver.
15811
15812
15813 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15814 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15815 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15816 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15817 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15818
15819 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15820 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15821 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15822 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15823 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15824 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15825 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15826
15827 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15828 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15829 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15830 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15831 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15832
15833 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15834
15835 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15836 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15837 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15838 some now infamous attacks.
15839
15840 Examples:
15841 .code
15842 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15843 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15844 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15845
15846 # Disable older protocol versions:
15847 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15848 .endd
15849
15850 Possible options may include:
15851 .ilist
15852 &`all`&
15853 .next
15854 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15855 .next
15856 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15857 .next
15858 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15859 .next
15860 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15861 .next
15862 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15863 .next
15864 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15865 .next
15866 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15867 .next
15868 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15869 .next
15870 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15871 .next
15872 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15873 .next
15874 &`no_compression`&
15875 .next
15876 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15877 .next
15878 &`no_sslv2`&
15879 .next
15880 &`no_sslv3`&
15881 .next
15882 &`no_ticket`&
15883 .next
15884 &`no_tlsv1`&
15885 .next
15886 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15887 .next
15888 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15889 .next
15890 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15891 .next
15892 &`single_dh_use`&
15893 .next
15894 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15895 .next
15896 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15897 .next
15898 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15899 .next
15900 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15901 .next
15902 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15903 .next
15904 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15905 .endlist
15906
15907 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15908 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15909 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15910 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15911 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15912 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15913
15914
15915 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15916 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15917 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15918 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15919 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15920
15921
15922 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15923 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15924 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15925 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15926 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15927 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15928 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15929 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15930 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15931 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15932 an ACL.
15933
15934 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15935 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15936 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15937 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15938 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15939 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15940 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15941
15942
15943 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15944 .cindex "Perl"
15945 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15946 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15947
15948
15949 .option perl_startup main string unset
15950 .cindex "Perl"
15951 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15952 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15953
15954 .option perl_startup main boolean false
15955 .cindex "Perl"
15956 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
15957
15958
15959 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15960 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15961 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15962 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15963 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15964 PostgreSQL support.
15965
15966
15967 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15968 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15969 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15970 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15971 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15972 to the host name:
15973 .code
15974 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15975 .endd
15976 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15977 spool directory.
15978 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15979 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15980 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15981
15982
15983 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15984 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15985 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15986 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15987 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15988 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15989 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15990 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15991 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15992
15993
15994 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15995 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15996 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15997 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15998 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15999 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16000 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16001 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16002
16003 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16004 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16005 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16006 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16007 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16008 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16009 volume of mail. Use with care!
16010
16011
16012 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16013 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16014 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16015 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16016 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16017 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16018 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16019 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16020 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16021 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16022
16023 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16024 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16025 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16026 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16027 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16028 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16029
16030
16031 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16032 .cindex "printing characters"
16033 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16034 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16035 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16036 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16037 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16038 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16039 characters.
16040
16041 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16042 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16043 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16044 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16045 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16046 standards.
16047
16048
16049 .option process_log_path main string unset
16050 .cindex "process log path"
16051 .cindex "log" "process log"
16052 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16053 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16054 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16055 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16056 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16057 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16058 different spool directories.
16059
16060
16061 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16062 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16063 .oindex "&%-M%&"
16064 .oindex "&%-R%&"
16065 .oindex "&%-q%&"
16066 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16067 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16068 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16069
16070
16071 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16072 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16073 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16074 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16075 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16076 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16077 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16078 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16079 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16080
16081 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16082 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16083 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16084 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16085 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16086 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16087 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16088
16089
16090 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16091 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16092 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16093
16094
16095
16096 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16097 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16098 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16099 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16100 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16101 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16102 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16103 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16104
16105
16106 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16107 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16108 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
16109 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16110 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16111 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16112 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16113
16114
16115 .option queue_only main boolean false
16116 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16117 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16118 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16119 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16120 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16121 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16122
16123 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16124 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16125 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16126 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16127
16128
16129 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16130 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16131 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16132 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16133 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16134 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16135 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16136 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16137 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16138 .code
16139 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16140 .endd
16141 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16142 &_/some/file_& exists.
16143
16144
16145 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16146 .cindex "load average"
16147 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16148 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16149 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16150 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16151 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16152 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16153 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16154 false.
16155
16156 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16157 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16158 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16159 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16160
16161
16162 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16163 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16164 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16165 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16166 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16167 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16168 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16169 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16170 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16171 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16172 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16173 re-evaluated for each message.
16174
16175
16176 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16177 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16178 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16179 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16180 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16181 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16182
16183
16184 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16185 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16186 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16187 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16188 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16189 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16190 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16191 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16192 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16193 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16194 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16195 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16196 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16197
16198
16199
16200 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16201 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16202 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16203 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16204 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16205 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16206 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16207 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16208 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16209
16210 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16211 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16212 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16213 the daemon's command line.
16214
16215 .cindex queues named
16216 .cindex "named queues"
16217 To set limits for different named queues use
16218 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16219
16220 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16221 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16222 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16223 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16224 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16225 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16226 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16227 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16228 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16229 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16230 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16231 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16232 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16233 &%queue_domains%&.
16234
16235
16236 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16237 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16238 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16239 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16240 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16241 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16242 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16243
16244 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16245 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16246 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16247 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16248 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16249 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16250 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16251 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16252 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16253 header lines. The default setting is:
16254
16255 .code
16256 received_header_text = Received: \
16257 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16258 {${if def:sender_ident \
16259 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16260 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16261 by $primary_hostname \
16262 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16263 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16264 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16265 ${if def:sender_address \
16266 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16267 id $message_exim_id\
16268 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16269 .endd
16270
16271 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16272 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16273 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16274 header lines such as the following:
16275 .code
16276 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16277 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16278 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16279 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16280 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16281 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16282 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16283 .endd
16284 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16285 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16286 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16287 message was accepted.
16288
16289
16290 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16291 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16292 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16293 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16294 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16295 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16296 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16297 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16298
16299
16300 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16301 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16302 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16303 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16304 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16305 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16306 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16307 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16308 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16309 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16310 option was not set.
16311
16312
16313 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16314 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16315 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16316 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16317 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16318 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16319 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16320 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16321 done.
16322
16323 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16324 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16325 RCPT commands in a single message.
16326
16327
16328 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16329 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16330 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16331 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16332 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16333 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16334 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16335
16336
16337 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16338 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16339 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16340 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16341 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16342 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16343 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16344 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16345 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16346 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16347 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16348 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16349 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16350 tagged with its process id.
16351
16352 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16353 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16354 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16355 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16356 is received.
16357
16358 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16359 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16360 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16361 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16362 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16363 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16364 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16365 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16366 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16367 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16368 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16369
16370 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16371 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16372 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16373 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16374
16375
16376 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16377 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16378 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16379 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16380 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16381 .code
16382 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16383 .endd
16384 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16385 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16386
16387
16388 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16389 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16390 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16391 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16392 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16393 past failures.
16394
16395
16396 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16397 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16398 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16399 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16400 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16401 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16402 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16403 the default value.
16404
16405
16406 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16407 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16408 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16409 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16410 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16411 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16412 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16413 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16414 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16415 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16416
16417
16418 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16419 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16420
16421
16422 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16423 .cindex "RFC 1413"
16424 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16425 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16426 an item in the list.
16427 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16428 for the system.
16429
16430 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16431 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16432 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16433 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16434 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16435
16436
16437 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16438 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16439 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16440 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16441 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16442 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16443 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16444 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16445 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16446 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16447
16448 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16449 .cindex "environment"
16450 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16451 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16452 default list is empty,
16453
16454
16455 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16456 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16457 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16458 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16459 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16460 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16461 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16462
16463
16464
16465 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16466 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16467 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16468 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16469 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16470 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16471 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16472 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16473 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16474 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16475 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16476
16477
16478
16479 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16480 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16481 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16482 .cindex "inetd"
16483 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16484 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16485 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16486 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16487 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16488 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16489
16490 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16491 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16492 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16493 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16494
16495
16496 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16497 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16498 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16499 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16500 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16501 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16502 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16503 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16504
16505 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16506 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16507 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16508 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16509 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16510 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16511 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16512 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16513
16514
16515 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16516 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16517 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16518 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16519 live with.
16520
16521
16522 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16523 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16524 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16525 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16526 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16527 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16528 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16529 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16530 . the option name to split.
16531
16532 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16533 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16534 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16535 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16536 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16537 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16538 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16539 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16540 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16541 seen).
16542
16543
16544 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16545 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16546 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16547 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16548 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16549 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16550 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16551 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16552 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16553 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16554 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16555
16556 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16557 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16558 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16559 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16560 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16561 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16562
16563
16564
16565 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16566 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16567 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16568 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16569 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16570 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16571 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16572 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16573 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16574 to all messages received in the same connection.
16575
16576 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16577 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16578 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16579 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16580
16581
16582 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16583
16584 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16585 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16586 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16587 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16588 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16589 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16590 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16591 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16592 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16593 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16594 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16595 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16596 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16597
16598
16599 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16600 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16601 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16602 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16603 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16604 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16605 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16606 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16607 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16608 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16609 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16610 individual host.
16611
16612 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16613 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16614 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16615 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16616
16617
16618 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16619 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16620 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16621 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16622 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16623 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16624 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16625 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16626 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16627
16628 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16629 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16630 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16631 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16632
16633 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16634 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16635 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16636 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16637 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16638 For example:
16639 .code
16640 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16641 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16642 .endd
16643
16644 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16645 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16646 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16647 &%helo_data%& value.
16648
16649 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16650 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16651 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16652 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16653 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16654 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16655 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16656 .code
16657 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16658 $version_number $tod_full
16659 .endd
16660 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16661 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16662 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16663 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16664 multiline response).
16665
16666
16667 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16668 .cindex "checking disk space"
16669 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16670 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16671 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16672 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16673 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16674 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16675 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16676
16677
16678 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16679 .cindex "connection backlog"
16680 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16681 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16682 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16683 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16684 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16685 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16686 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16687 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16688 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16689 attacks by SYN flooding.
16690
16691
16692 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16693 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16694 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16695 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16696 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16697 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16698 fewer, but they still exist.
16699
16700 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16701 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16702 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16703 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16704 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16705 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16706 does detect many instances.
16707
16708 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16709 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16710 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16711 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16712
16713
16714
16715 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16716 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16717 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16718 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16719 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16720 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16721 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16722 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16723 example:
16724 .code
16725 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16726 $sender_host_address
16727 .endd
16728 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16729 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16730 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16731 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16732 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16733 the command.
16734
16735
16736 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16737 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16738 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16739 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16740 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16741
16742
16743 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16744 .cindex "load average"
16745 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16746 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16747 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16748 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16749 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16750 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16751
16752
16753
16754 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16755 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16756 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16757 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16758 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16759 .code
16760 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16761 .endd
16762 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16763 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16764 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16765 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16766 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16767
16768 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16769 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16770 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16771 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16772 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16773 not count towards the limit.
16774
16775
16776
16777 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16778 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16779 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16780 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16781 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16782 that subvert web
16783 clients
16784 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16785 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16786
16787
16788
16789 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16790 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16791 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16792 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16793 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16794 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16795 recipients.
16796
16797 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16798 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16799 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16800 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16801
16802 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16803 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16804 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16805 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16806 values:
16807
16808 .ilist
16809 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16810 .next
16811 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16812 fractional parts are allowed here.
16813 .next
16814 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16815 .next
16816 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16817 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16818 .endlist
16819
16820 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16821 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16822 .code
16823 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16824 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16825 .endd
16826 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16827 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16828 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16829 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16830
16831
16832 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16833 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16834
16835
16836 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16837 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16838
16839
16840 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16841 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16842 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16843 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16844 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16845 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16846 the message is abandoned.
16847 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16848 .code
16849 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16850 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16851 .endd
16852 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16853 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16854
16855 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16856 expanded before use and may depend on
16857 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16858
16859
16860 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16861 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16862 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16863 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16864 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16865 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16866
16867
16868 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16869 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16870 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16871
16872
16873 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16874 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16875 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16876 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16877 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16878 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16879 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16880 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16881 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16882 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16883 .code
16884 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16885 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16886 .endd
16887
16888
16889 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16890 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16891 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16892 the availability thereof is advertised in
16893 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16894 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16895
16896
16897 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
16898 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16899 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16900 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16901
16902
16903
16904 .new
16905 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
16906 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
16907 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
16908 .wen
16909
16910
16911
16912 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16913 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16914 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16915 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16916 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16917 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16918 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16919 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16920 arrival of the message.
16921
16922 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16923 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16924 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16925 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16926 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16927
16928 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16929 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16930 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16931 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16932 automatically deleted.
16933
16934 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16935 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16936 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16937 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16938 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16939 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16940 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16941 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16942 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16943
16944
16945 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16946 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16947 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16948 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16949 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16950 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16951 &$primary_hostname$&.
16952
16953 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16954 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16955 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16956 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16957 as failures in the configuration file.
16958
16959 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16960 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16961
16962 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
16963 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
16964 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternate format
16965 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
16966 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
16967 Currently it is only done for messages received using the EMSTP CHUNKING
16968 option.
16969
16970 The following variables will not have useful values:
16971 .code
16972 $max_received_linelength
16973 $body_linecount
16974 $body_zerocount
16975 .endd
16976
16977 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
16978 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
16979 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
16980 will need to be aware of the potential different format.
16981
16982 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
16983 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
16984 The transmission benefit is maintained.
16985
16986 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16987 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16988 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16989 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16990
16991 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16992 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16993 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16994 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16995 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16996 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16997
16998 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16999 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17000 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17001 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17002 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17003 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17004 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17005
17006
17007 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17008 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17009 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17010 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17011 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17012 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17013 domain causes a syntax error.
17014 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17015 syntax checking.
17016
17017
17018 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17019 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17020 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17021 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17022 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17023 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17024 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17025 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17026 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17027 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17028 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17029 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17030
17031
17032 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17033 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17034 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17035 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17036 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17037 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17038 details of Exim's logging.
17039
17040
17041 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17042 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17043 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17044 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17045 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17046 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17047 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17048
17049
17050
17051 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17052 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17053 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17054 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17055 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17056
17057
17058
17059 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17060 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17061 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17062 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17063 details of Exim's logging.
17064
17065
17066 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17067 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17068 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17069 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17070 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17071 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17072 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17073 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17074 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17075 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17076 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17077 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17078
17079
17080 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17081 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17082 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17083 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17084 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17085 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17086
17087
17088 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17089 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17090 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17091 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17092 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17093
17094 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17095 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17096 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17097 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17098 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17099
17100 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17101 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17102 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17103 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17104 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17105 contains the pipe command.
17106
17107
17108 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17109 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17110 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17111 is used in a system filter.
17112
17113
17114 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17115 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17116 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17117 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17118 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17119 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17120 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17121 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17122 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17123 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17124
17125 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17126 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17127 transport option overrides.
17128
17129
17130 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17131 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17132 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17133 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17134 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17135 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17136 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17137 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17138 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17139 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17140 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17141 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17142 TCP_NODELAY.
17143
17144
17145 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17146 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17147 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17148 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17149 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17150 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17151 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17152 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17153 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17154 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17155
17156 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17157 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17158 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17159
17160
17161 .option timezone main string unset
17162 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17163 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17164 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17165 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17166 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17167 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17168 .code
17169 timezone = UTC
17170 .endd
17171 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17172 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17173 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17174 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17175 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17176 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17177
17178
17179 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17180 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17181 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17182 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17183 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17184 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17185 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17186 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17187 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17188 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17189 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17190
17191
17192 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17193 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17194 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17195 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17196 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17197 needed.
17198 The server's private key is also
17199 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17200 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17201
17202 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17203 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17204 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17205 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17206
17207 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17208 separator in the usual way to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17209
17210 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
17211 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17212
17213 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17214 when a list of more than one file is used.
17215
17216 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17217 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17218 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17219 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17220
17221 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17222 generated for every connection.
17223
17224 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17225 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17226 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17227 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17228 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17229
17230 .new
17231 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17232
17233 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17234 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17235 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17236 .wen
17237
17238 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17239
17240
17241 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17242 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17243 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17244 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17245 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17246 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17247
17248 The value must be at least 1024.
17249
17250 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17251 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17252 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17253
17254 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17255 number.
17256
17257 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17258 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17259 larger prime than requested.
17260
17261
17262 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17263 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17264 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17265 to be used by Exim.
17266
17267 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17268 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17269 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17270 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17271
17272 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17273 then it names a file from which DH
17274 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17275 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17276 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17277 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17278 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17279 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17280
17281 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17282 loaded by Exim.
17283
17284 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17285 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17286 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17287 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17288
17289 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17290 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17291
17292 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17293 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17294 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17295
17296 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17297 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17298 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17299 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17300 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17301
17302 The available standard primes are:
17303 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17304 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17305 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17306 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17307
17308 The available additional primes are:
17309 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17310
17311 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17312 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17313 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17314 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17315 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17316
17317 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17318 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17319 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17320
17321 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17322 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17323 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17324 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17325 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17326 userbase.
17327
17328 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17329 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17330 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17331 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17332 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17333 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17334 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17335
17336
17337 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17338 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17339 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17340 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17341
17342 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17343 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17344 for valid selections.
17345
17346 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17347 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17348 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17349
17350 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17351
17352
17353 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17354 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17355 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17356 This option
17357 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17358 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17359 Certificate Authority.
17360
17361 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17362
17363 .new
17364 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17365 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17366 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17367 .wen
17368
17369
17370 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17371 .cindex SSMTP
17372 .cindex SMTPS
17373 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17374 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17375 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17376 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17377
17378
17379
17380 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17381 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17382 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17383 files which contains the server's private keys.
17384 If this option is unset, or if
17385 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17386 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17387 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17388
17389 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17390
17391
17392 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17393 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17394 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17395 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17396 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17397 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17398 TLS session.
17399
17400
17401 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17402 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17403 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17404 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17405 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17406 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17407 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17408 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17409 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17410 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17411 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17412
17413
17414 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17415 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17416 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17417 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17418
17419
17420 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17421 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17422 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17423 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17424 word "system"
17425 or the absolute path to
17426 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17427 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17428
17429 The "system" value for the option will use a
17430 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17431 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17432 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17433 must be specified.
17434
17435 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17436 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17437
17438 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17439 explicitly
17440 either by file or directory
17441 are added to those given by the system default location.
17442
17443 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17444 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17445 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17446 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17447 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17448 use the explicit directory version.
17449
17450 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17451
17452 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17453 being unset.
17454
17455
17456 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17457 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17458 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17459 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17460 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17461 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17462 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17463 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17464
17465 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17466 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17467 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17468 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17469 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17470 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17471 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17472
17473 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17474 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17475 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17476 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17477 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17478 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17479 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17480 certificate"&.
17481
17482 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17483 certificates.
17484
17485
17486 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17487 .cindex "trusted groups"
17488 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17489 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17490 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17491 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17492 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17493 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17494 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17495 are trusted.
17496
17497 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17498 .cindex "trusted users"
17499 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17500 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17501 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17502 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17503 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17504 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17505 Exim user are trusted.
17506
17507 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17508 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17509 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17510 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17511 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17512 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17513 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17514 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17515 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17516 &%-F%& option.
17517
17518 .option unknown_username main string unset
17519 See &%unknown_login%&.
17520
17521 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17522 .cindex "trusted users"
17523 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17524 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17525 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17526 .cindex "envelope sender"
17527 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17528 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17529 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17530 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17531 is used) is ignored.
17532
17533 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17534 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17535 .code
17536 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17537 .endd
17538 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17539 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17540 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17541 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17542 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17543 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17544 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17545 followed by a hyphen
17546 by a setting like this:
17547 .code
17548 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17549 .endd
17550 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17551 restriction, you can use
17552 .code
17553 untrusted_set_sender = *
17554 .endd
17555 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17556 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17557 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17558 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17559 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17560 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17561 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17562 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17563
17564 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17565 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17566 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17567 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17568 sender address.
17569
17570
17571 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17572 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17573 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17574 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17575 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17576 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17577 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17578 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17579 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17580 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17581 .code
17582 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17583 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17584 .endd
17585 The pattern can be seen by running
17586 .code
17587 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17588 .endd
17589 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17590 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17591 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17592 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17593 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17594 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17595
17596
17597 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17598 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17599
17600
17601 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17602 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17603 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17604 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17605 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17606 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17607 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17608 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17609
17610
17611 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17612 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17613 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17614 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17615 .ecindex IIDconfima
17616 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17617
17618
17619
17620
17621 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17622 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17623
17624 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17625 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17626 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17627 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17628 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17629
17630 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17631 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17632 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17633 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17634 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17635
17636
17637
17638 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17639 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17640 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17641 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17642 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17643 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17644 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17645
17646 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17647 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17648 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17649 routers, and the eventual transport.
17650
17651 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17652 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17653 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17654 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17655 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17656
17657 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17658 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17659 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17660 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17661 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17662
17663 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17664 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17665 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17666 .code
17667 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17668 .endd
17669 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17670 .code
17671 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17672 .endd
17673 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17674 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17675
17676 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17677 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17678 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17679 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17680 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17681 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17682 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17683
17684
17685
17686 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17687 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17688 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17689 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17690 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17691 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17692 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17693 routing.
17694
17695
17696
17697 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17698 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17699 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17700 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17701 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17702 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17703 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17704 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17705 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17706 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17707 you could put:
17708 .code
17709 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17710 .endd
17711 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17712 and
17713 .code
17714 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17715 .endd
17716 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17717 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17718 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17719 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17720
17721
17722 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17723 .cindex "case of local parts"
17724 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17725 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17726 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17727 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17728 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17729 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17730 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17731 more details.
17732
17733 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17734 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17735 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17736 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17737 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17738 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17739 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17740 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17741 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17742
17743 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17744 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17745 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17746 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17747
17748
17749
17750 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17751 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17752 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17753 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17754 .vindex "&$home$&"
17755 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17756 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17757 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17758 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17759 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17760 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17761 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17762 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17763 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17764 the router is skipped.
17765
17766 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17767 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17768 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17769 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17770 setting to achieve this. For example:
17771 .code
17772 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17773 .endd
17774 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17775 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17776 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17777
17778
17779
17780 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17781 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17782 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17783 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17784 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17785 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17786 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17787 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17788
17789 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17790 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17791
17792 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17793 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17794
17795 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17796 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17797 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17798 .code
17799 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17800 .endd
17801 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17802 .code
17803 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17804 .endd
17805
17806 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17807 .code
17808 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17809 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17810 condition = foobar
17811 .endd
17812
17813 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17814 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17815 be specified using &%condition%&.
17816
17817 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17818 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17819 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17820 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17821 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17822 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17823 Router rules processing behavior.
17824
17825 This is best illustrated in an example:
17826 .code
17827 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17828 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17829
17830 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17831 true {yes} {no}}
17832
17833 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17834 {yes} {no}}
17835 .endd
17836 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17837 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17838 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17839 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17840 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17841 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17842 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17843 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17844
17845 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17846 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17847 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17848 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17849 string characters.
17850
17851 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17852 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17853 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17854 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17855 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17856
17857
17858 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17859 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17860 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17861 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17862 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17863 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17864 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17865 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17866 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17867 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17868 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17869 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17870 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17871 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17872
17873
17874
17875 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17876 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17877 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17878 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17879 transport option of the same name.
17880
17881 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17882 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17883 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17884 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17885 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17886 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17887 the dnssec request bit set.
17888 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17889
17890 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17891 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17892 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17893 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17894 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17895 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17896 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17897 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17898 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17899
17900
17901 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17902 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17903 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17904 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17905 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17906 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17907 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17908 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17909
17910
17911
17912 .option driver routers string unset
17913 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17914 to be used.
17915
17916
17917 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17918 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17919 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17920 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17921 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17922 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17923 Not effective on redirect routers.
17924
17925
17926
17927 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17928 .cindex "envelope sender"
17929 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17930 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17931 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17932 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17933 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17934 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17935 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17936
17937 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17938 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17939 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17940 setting.
17941
17942 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17943 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17944 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17945 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17946
17947 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17948 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17949 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17950 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17951 settings:
17952 .code
17953 errors_to =
17954 errors_to = ""
17955 .endd
17956 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17957 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17958 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17959 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17960 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17961
17962 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17963 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17964 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17965 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17966 setting &%return_path%&.
17967
17968 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17969 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17970 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17971
17972
17973
17974 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17975 .cindex "address" "testing"
17976 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17977 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17978 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17979 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17980 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17981 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17982 on for the system alias file.
17983 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17984 are evaluated.
17985
17986 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17987 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17988 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17989
17990
17991
17992 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17993 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17994 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17995 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17996
17997
17998
17999 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18000 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18001 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18002
18003
18004
18005 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18006 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18007 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18008
18009
18010
18011 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18012 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18013 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18014 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18015 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18016 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
18017 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18018 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18019 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18020
18021 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18022 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18023 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18024 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18025 transport for further details.
18026
18027
18028 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18029 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18030 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18031 .cindex "transport" "local"
18032 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18033 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18034 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18035 process.
18036 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18037 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18038 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18039 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18040 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18041
18042
18043
18044 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18045 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18046 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18047 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18048 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18049 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18050 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18051 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18052 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18053 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18054 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18055 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18056 &"see"& the added header lines.
18057
18058 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18059 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18060 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18061 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18062
18063 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18064 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18065
18066 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18067 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18068
18069 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18070 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18071 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18072 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18073 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18074 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18075 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18076 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18077 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18078 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18079
18080
18081
18082 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18083 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18084 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18085 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18086 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18087 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18088 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18089 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18090 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18091 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18092 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18093 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18094 &"see"& the original header lines.
18095
18096 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18097 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18098 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18099 errors.
18100
18101 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18102 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18103
18104 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18105 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18106
18107 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18108 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18109 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18110 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18111
18112 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18113 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18114 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18115
18116
18117
18118 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18119 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18120 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18121 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18122 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18123 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18124 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18125 like
18126 .code
18127 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18128 .endd
18129 by setting
18130 .code
18131 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18132 .endd
18133 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18134 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18135 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18136 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18137 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18138 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18139
18140 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18141 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18142 .code
18143 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18144 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18145 .endd
18146 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18147 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18148
18149 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18150 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18151 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18152 domain that is being routed.
18153
18154 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18155 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18156 checked.
18157
18158 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18159 .cindex "additional groups"
18160 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18161 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18162 .cindex "transport" "local"
18163 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18164 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18165 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18166 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18167 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18168
18169
18170
18171 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18172 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18173 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18174 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18175 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18176 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18177 evaluated.
18178
18179 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18180 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18181 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18182 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18183 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18184 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18185 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18186 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18187 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18188
18189 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18190 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18191 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18192 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18193 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18194 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18195 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18196 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18197 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18198 the relevant transport.
18199
18200 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18201 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18202 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18203 callout.
18204
18205 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18206 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18207 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18208 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18209 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18210 .code
18211 real_localuser:
18212 driver = accept
18213 local_part_prefix = real-
18214 check_local_user
18215 transport = local_delivery
18216 .endd
18217 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18218 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18219 .code
18220 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18221 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18222 .endd
18223
18224 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18225 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18226 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18227 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18228
18229
18230 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18231 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18232
18233
18234
18235 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18236 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18237 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18238 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18239 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18240 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18241 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18242 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18243 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18244 &%username-foo%&.
18245
18246
18247 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18248 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18249
18250
18251
18252 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18253 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18254 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18255 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18256 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18257 are evaluated, and
18258 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18259 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18260 example:
18261 .code
18262 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18263 .endd
18264 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18265 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18266 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18267 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18268 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18269 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18270 each virtual domain:
18271 .code
18272 postmaster:
18273 driver = redirect
18274 local_parts = postmaster
18275 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18276 .endd
18277
18278
18279 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18280 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18281 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18282 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18283 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18284 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18285 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18286 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18287 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18288 redirect addresses.
18289
18290
18291
18292 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18293 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18294 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18295 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18296 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18297 delivery to be deferred.
18298
18299 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18300 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18301 .oindex "&%self%&"
18302 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18303 means of the setting
18304 .code
18305 self = pass
18306 .endd
18307 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18308 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18309 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18310
18311 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18312 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18313 controls what happens next.
18314
18315
18316 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18317 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18318 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18319 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18320 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18321 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18322 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18323 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18324
18325 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18326 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18327 applies to all of them.
18328
18329
18330
18331 .option pass_router routers string unset
18332 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18333 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18334 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18335 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18336 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18337 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18338 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18339 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18340 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18341 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18342
18343
18344
18345 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18346 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18347 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18348 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18349 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18350 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18351
18352 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18353 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18354 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18355 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18356
18357
18358
18359 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18360 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18361 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18362 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18363 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18364 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18365 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18366
18367 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18368 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18369 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18370 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18371
18372 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18373 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18374 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18375 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18376 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18377
18378 .cindex "NFS"
18379 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18380 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18381 unavailable.
18382
18383 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18384 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18385 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18386 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18387 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18388 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18389 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18390 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18391
18392 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18393 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18394 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18395 operates as follows:
18396
18397 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18398 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18399 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18400 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18401 used. For example:
18402 .code
18403 require_files = mail:/some/file
18404 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18405 .endd
18406 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18407 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18408
18409 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18410 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18411 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18412 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18413
18414 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18415 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18416 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18417 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18418 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18419
18420 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18421 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18422 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18423 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18424 check again in that process.
18425
18426 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18427 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18428 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18429 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18430 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18431 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18432 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18433 .code
18434 require_files = +/some/file
18435 .endd
18436 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18437 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18438 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18439
18440
18441
18442 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18443 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18444 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18445 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18446 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18447 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18448 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18449 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18450 latter kind.
18451
18452 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18453 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18454 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18455 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18456 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18457 same name.
18458
18459 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18460 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18461 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18462
18463
18464
18465 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18466 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18467 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18468 .vindex "&$home$&"
18469 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18470 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18471 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18472 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18473 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18474 cause the router to defer.
18475
18476 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18477 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18478 place.
18479 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18480 are evaluated.)
18481 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18482 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18483
18484 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18485 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18486 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18487 of these values that is set:
18488
18489 .ilist
18490 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18491 .next
18492 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18493 .next
18494 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18495 .next
18496 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18497 .endlist
18498
18499 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18500 router, but not for the transport.
18501
18502
18503
18504 .option self routers string freeze
18505 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18506 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18507 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18508 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18509 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18510 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18511 of remote hosts.
18512 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18513 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18514 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18515 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18516 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18517
18518 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18519 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18520 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18521 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18522 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18523 cases:
18524
18525 .vlist
18526 .vitem &%defer%&
18527 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18528
18529 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18530 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18531 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18532 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18533
18534 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18535 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18536 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18537 rewritten.
18538
18539 .vitem &%pass%&
18540 .oindex "&%more%&"
18541 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18542 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18543 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18544 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18545 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18546 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18547 combination
18548 .code
18549 self = pass
18550 no_more
18551 .endd
18552 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18553 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18554 be passed to the next router.
18555
18556 .vitem &%fail%&
18557 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18558
18559 .vitem &%send%&
18560 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18561 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18562 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18563 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18564 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18565 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18566 .endlist
18567
18568
18569
18570 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18571 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18572 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18573 address matches something on the list.
18574 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18575 are evaluated.
18576
18577 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18578 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18579 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18580 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18581 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18582 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18583 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18584 matters.
18585
18586
18587 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18588 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18589 .cindex "packet radio"
18590 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18591 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18592 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18593 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18594 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18595 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18596 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18597 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18598
18599 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18600 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18601 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18602 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18603 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18604 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18605 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18606 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18607 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18608 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18609 .code
18610 translate_ip_address = \
18611 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18612 {$value}fail}}
18613 .endd
18614 The file would contain lines like
18615 .code
18616 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18617 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18618 .endd
18619 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18620 are doing.
18621
18622
18623
18624 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18625 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18626 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18627 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18628 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18629 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18630 delivery is deferred.
18631
18632 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18633 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18634 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18635
18636
18637
18638 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18639 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18640 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18641 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18642 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18643 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18644 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18645 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18646 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18647 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18648 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18649 environment.
18650
18651
18652
18653
18654 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18655 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18656 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18657 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18658 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18659 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18660 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18661 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18662 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18663 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18664
18665 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18666 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18667 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18668 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18669 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18670
18671 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18672 environment.
18673
18674
18675
18676
18677 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18678 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18679 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18680 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18681 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18682 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18683 delivery to be deferred.
18684
18685 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18686 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18687 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18688 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18689 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18690 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18691
18692 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18693 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18694 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18695 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18696 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18697 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18698 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18699 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18700
18701 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18702 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18703 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18704 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18705 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18706 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18707 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18708 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18709 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18710 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18711
18712 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18713 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18714 subsequent routers.
18715
18716
18717 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18718 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18719 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18720 .cindex "transport" "local"
18721 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18722 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18723 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18724 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18725 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18726 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18727 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18728 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18729 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18730 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18731 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18732 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18733
18734
18735
18736 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18737 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18738 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18739
18740
18741 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18742 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18743 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18744 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18745 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18746 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18747 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18748 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18749 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18750 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18751
18752 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18753 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18754 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18755 user or group.
18756
18757
18758 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18759 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18760 addresses,
18761 delivering in cutthrough mode
18762 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18763 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18764 are evaluated.
18765 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18766
18767
18768 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18769 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18770 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18771 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18772 are evaluated.
18773 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18774 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18775 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18776
18777
18778
18779
18780
18781
18782 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18783 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18784
18785 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18786 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18787 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18788 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18789 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18790 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18791 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18792 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18793 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18794 .code
18795 localusers:
18796 driver = accept
18797 domains = mydomain.example
18798 check_local_user
18799 transport = local_delivery
18800 .endd
18801 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18802 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18803 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18804 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18805
18806
18807
18808
18809
18810
18811 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18812 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18813
18814 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18815 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18816 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18817 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18818 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18819 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18820
18821 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18822 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18823 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18824 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18825 records.
18826
18827 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18828 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18829 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18830 .new
18831 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18832 .wen
18833 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18834 generic option, the router declines.
18835
18836 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18837 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18838 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18839
18840 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18841 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18842 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18843 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18844 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18845 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18846
18847
18848 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18849 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18850 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18851 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18852 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18853 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18854
18855 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18856 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18857 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18858 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18859 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18860 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18861 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18862 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18863 case routing fails.
18864
18865
18866 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18867 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18868 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18869 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18870 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18871
18872 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18873 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18874
18875 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18876 .ilist
18877 The domain does not exist in DNS
18878 .next
18879 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18880 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18881 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18882 .next
18883 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18884 .next
18885 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18886 .next
18887 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18888 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18889 .next
18890 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18891 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18892 .next
18893 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18894 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18895 .next
18896 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18897 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18898 .endlist
18899
18900
18901
18902
18903 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18904 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18905 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18906
18907 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18908 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18909 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18910 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18911 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18912 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18913 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18914
18915
18916 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18917 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18918 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18919 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18920 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18921 required. For example,
18922 .code
18923 check_srv = smtp
18924 .endd
18925 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18926 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18927 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18928 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18929 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18930 normal way.
18931
18932 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18933 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18934 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18935 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18936 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18937 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18938
18939 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18940 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18941 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18942 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18943 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18944 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18945 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18946 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18947
18948 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18949 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18950
18951
18952
18953
18954 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18955 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18956 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18957 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18958 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18959 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18960 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18961 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18962 also being queued.
18963
18964
18965 .new
18966 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
18967 .cindex IPv6 disabling
18968 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
18969 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18970 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18971 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18972 only A records are used.
18973
18974 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
18975 .cindex IPv4 preference
18976 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
18977 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18978 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18979 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18980 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
18981 .wen
18982
18983 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18984 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18985 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18986 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18987 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18988 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18989 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18990 setting:
18991 .code
18992 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18993 .endd
18994 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18995 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18996 the address record.
18997
18998
18999 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19000 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19001 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19002 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19003
19004
19005
19006
19007 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19008 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19009 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19010 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19011 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19012 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19013 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19014 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19015 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19016 &'resolv.conf'&.
19017
19018
19019
19020 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19021 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19022 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19023 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19024 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19025 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19026 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19027 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19028 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19029 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19030 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19031
19032 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19033 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19034 sense.
19035
19036 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19037 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19038 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19039 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19040 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19041 header rewriting.
19042
19043
19044 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19045 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19046 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19047 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19048 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19049 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19050 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19051 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19052
19053 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19054 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19055 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19056 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19057 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19058 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19059 without processing them independently,
19060 provided the following conditions are met:
19061
19062 .ilist
19063 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19064 &%headers_remove%&.
19065 .next
19066 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19067 the domain.
19068 .endlist
19069
19070
19071
19072
19073 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19074 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19075 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19076 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19077 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19078 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19079 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19080 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19081 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19082 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19083
19084 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19085 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19086 local wildcard.
19087
19088
19089
19090 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19091 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19092 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19093 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19094
19095
19096
19097
19098 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19099 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19100 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19101 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19102 if
19103 .code
19104 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19105 .endd
19106 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19107 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19108 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19109 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19110 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19111 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19112
19113
19114 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19115 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19116 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19117 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19118 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19119
19120 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19121 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19122 such as that implied by
19123 .code
19124 domains = @mx_any
19125 .endd
19126 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19127 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19128 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19129 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19130
19131
19132
19133
19134
19135
19136
19137
19138
19139 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19140 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19141
19142 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19143 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19144 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19145 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19146 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19147 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19148 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19149 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19150 router handles the address
19151 .code
19152 root@[192.168.1.1]
19153 .endd
19154 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19155 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19156 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19157 .code
19158 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19159 .endd
19160 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19161 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19162
19163 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19164 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19165 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19166 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19167
19168 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19169 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19170 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19171 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19172
19173
19174
19175 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19176 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19177
19178 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19179 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19180 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19181 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19182 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19183 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19184 must set
19185 .code
19186 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19187 .endd
19188 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19189
19190 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19191 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19192 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19193 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19194 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19195 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19196 must not be specified for it.
19197
19198 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19199 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19200 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19201 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19202 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19203 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19204 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19205
19206
19207 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19208 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19209 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19210 delivery to the address is deferred.
19211
19212
19213 .option port iplookup integer 0
19214 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19215 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19216 call.
19217
19218
19219 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19220 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19221 protocols is to be used.
19222
19223
19224 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19225 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19226 default value is:
19227 .code
19228 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19229 .endd
19230 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19231 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19232
19233
19234 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19235 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19236 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19237 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19238 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19239 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19240 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19241 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19242
19243
19244 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19245 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19246 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19247 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19248 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19249 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19250 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19251 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19252 following could be used:
19253 .code
19254 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19255 reroute = $local_part@$1
19256 .endd
19257
19258 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19259 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19260 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19261 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19262
19263
19264
19265
19266 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19267 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19268
19269 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19270 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19271 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19272 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19273 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19274 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19275 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19276 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19277 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19278 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19279
19280 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19281 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19282 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19283 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19284 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19285 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19286 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19287
19288 .vindex "&$host$&"
19289 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19290 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19291 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19292 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19293 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19294 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19295 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19296 text string.
19297
19298 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19299 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19300 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19301 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19302 below, following the list of private options.
19303
19304
19305 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19306
19307 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19308 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19309
19310 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19311 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19312
19313 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19314 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19315 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19316 of the following values:
19317 .code
19318 decline
19319 defer
19320 fail
19321 freeze
19322 ignore
19323 pass
19324 .endd
19325 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19326 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19327 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19328 &%pass_router%&),
19329 .oindex "&%more%&"
19330 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19331 router only if &%more%& is true.
19332
19333 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19334 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19335 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19336 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19337
19338 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19339 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19340 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19341
19342
19343 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19344 .cindex "randomized host list"
19345 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19346 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19347 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19348 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19349 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19350 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19351 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19352 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19353
19354 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19355 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19356 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19357 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19358 .code
19359 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19360 .endd
19361 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19362 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19363 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19364 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19365 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19366
19367
19368 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19369 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19370 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19371 example:
19372 .code
19373 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19374 .endd
19375 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19376 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19377 deferred.
19378
19379
19380 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19381 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19382 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19383 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19384
19385
19386 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19387 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19388 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19389 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19390 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19391 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19392 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19393 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19394
19395 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19396 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19397 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19398 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19399 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19400 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19401 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19402 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19403
19404
19405
19406
19407 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19408 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19409 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19410 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19411 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19412 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19413 .display
19414 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19415 .endd
19416 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19417 no options:
19418 .code
19419 route_list = \
19420 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19421 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19422 .endd
19423 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19424 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19425 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19426 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19427 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19428 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19429 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19430 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19431 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19432 in a &%route_list%&).
19433
19434 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19435 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19436 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19437 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19438
19439
19440
19441 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19442 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19443 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19444 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19445 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19446 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19447 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19448 like this:
19449 .code
19450 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19451 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19452 .endd
19453 This data can be accessed by setting
19454 .code
19455 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19456 .endd
19457 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19458 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19459 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19460 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19461 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19462
19463
19464
19465
19466 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19467 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19468 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19469 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19470 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19471 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19472 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19473
19474 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19475 variables are set during its expansion:
19476
19477 .ilist
19478 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19479 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19480 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19481 .code
19482 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19483 .endd
19484 .next
19485 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19486 .next
19487 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19488
19489 .next
19490 .vindex "&$value$&"
19491 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19492 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19493 .code
19494 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19495 .endd
19496 .endlist
19497
19498 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19499 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19500
19501
19502
19503 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19504 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19505 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19506 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19507 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19508 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19509
19510 .ilist
19511 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19512 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19513 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19514 .code
19515 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19516 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19517 .endd
19518 .next
19519 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19520 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19521 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19522 number follows. For example:
19523 .code
19524 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19525 .endd
19526 .endlist
19527
19528 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19529 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19530 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19531 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19532 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19533 transport.
19534
19535 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19536 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19537 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19538 records in the DNS. For example:
19539 .code
19540 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19541 .endd
19542 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19543 example:
19544 .code
19545 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19546 .endd
19547 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19548 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19549 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19550 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19551 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19552 happens is controlled by the
19553 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19554 &%self%& option of the router.
19555
19556 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19557 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19558 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19559 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19560 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19561 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19562 defined by MX preferences.
19563
19564 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19565 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19566 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19567
19568 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19569 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19570 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19571 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19572
19573 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19574 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19575 router.
19576
19577 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19578 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19579 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19580
19581 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19582 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19583
19584
19585
19586 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19587 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19588 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19589 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19590 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19591 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19592 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19593
19594 .ilist
19595 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19596 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19597 .next
19598 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19599 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19600 .next
19601 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19602 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19603 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19604 .next
19605 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19606 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19607 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19608 .new
19609 .next
19610 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19611 .next
19612 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19613 .wen
19614 .endlist
19615
19616 For example:
19617 .code
19618 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19619 domain2 host4:host5
19620 .endd
19621 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19622 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19623 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19624 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19625 call.
19626
19627 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19628 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19629 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19630 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19631 function called.
19632
19633 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19634 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19635 option specified.
19636
19637
19638
19639 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19640 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19641
19642 .vindex "&$host$&"
19643 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19644 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19645
19646
19647
19648 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19649 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19650 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19651
19652 .ilist
19653 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19654 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19655 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19656 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19657 .code
19658 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19659 .endd
19660 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19661 your first router something like this:
19662 .code
19663 smart_route:
19664 driver = manualroute
19665 domains = !+local_domains
19666 transport = remote_smtp
19667 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19668 .endd
19669 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19670 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19671 they are tried in order
19672 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19673 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19674 .code
19675 smart_route:
19676 driver = manualroute
19677 transport = remote_smtp
19678 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19679 .endd
19680 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19681 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19682 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19683 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19684 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19685 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19686 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19687 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19688
19689 .next
19690 .cindex "mail hub example"
19691 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19692 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19693 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19694 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19695 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19696 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19697 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19698 lookup is easier to manage.
19699
19700 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19701 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19702 example:
19703 .code
19704 hub_route:
19705 driver = manualroute
19706 transport = remote_smtp
19707 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19708 .endd
19709 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19710 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19711 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19712 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19713 domain can be used to find the host:
19714 .code
19715 through_firewall:
19716 driver = manualroute
19717 transport = remote_smtp
19718 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19719 .endd
19720 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19721 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19722 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19723 next router.
19724
19725 .next
19726 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19727 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19728 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19729 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19730 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19731 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19732 .code
19733 save_in_file:
19734 driver = manualroute
19735 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19736 route_list = saved.domain.example
19737 .endd
19738 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19739 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19740 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19741 .code
19742 save_in_file:
19743 driver = manualroute
19744 route_list = \
19745 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19746 *.saved.domain2.example \
19747 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19748 batch_pipe
19749 .endd
19750 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19751 .vindex "&$host$&"
19752 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19753 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19754 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19755 the address if the lookup fails.
19756
19757 .next
19758 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19759 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19760 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19761 one way it can be done:
19762 .code
19763 # Transport
19764 uucp:
19765 driver = pipe
19766 user = nobody
19767 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19768 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19769 return_fail_output = true
19770
19771 # Router
19772 uucphost:
19773 transport = uucp
19774 driver = manualroute
19775 route_data = \
19776 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19777 .endd
19778 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19779 .code
19780 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19781 .endd
19782 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19783 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19784 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19785 .endlist
19786 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19787 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19788
19789
19790
19791
19792
19793
19794
19795
19796 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19798
19799 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19800 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19801 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19802 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19803 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19804 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19805 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19806 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19807 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19808 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19809 options:
19810 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19811
19812 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19813 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19814 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19815 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19816 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19817
19818
19819 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19820 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19821 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19822 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19823 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19824 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19825
19826
19827 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19828 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19829 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19830 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19831 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19832 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19833 not set, a value for the gid also.
19834
19835 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19836 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19837 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19838 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19839 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19840 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19841 gid.
19842
19843
19844 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19845 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19846 before running the command.
19847
19848
19849 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19850 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19851 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19852 timeout.
19853
19854
19855 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19856 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19857 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19858 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19859 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19860
19861 .ilist
19862 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19863 below).
19864 .next
19865 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19866 &%no_more%& is set.
19867 .next
19868 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19869 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19870 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19871 included in the SMTP response.
19872 .next
19873 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19874 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19875 included in any SMTP response.
19876 .next
19877 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19878 .next
19879 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19880 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19881 .next
19882 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19883 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19884 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19885 .endlist
19886
19887 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19888 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19889 the page):
19890 .code
19891 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19892 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19893 .endd
19894 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19895 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19896 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19897 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19898
19899 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19900 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19901 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19902 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19903 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19904
19905 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19906 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19907 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19908 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19909 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19910
19911 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19912 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19913 variable. For example, this return line
19914 .code
19915 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19916 .endd
19917 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19918 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19919 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19920 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19921
19922
19923
19924
19925 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19926 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19927
19928 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19929 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19930 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19931 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19932 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19933 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19934 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19935 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19936 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19937 redirected in several different ways:
19938
19939 .ilist
19940 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19941 independently.
19942 .next
19943 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19944 .next
19945 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19946 .next
19947 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19948 .next
19949 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19950 .next
19951 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19952 .next
19953 It can be discarded.
19954 .endlist
19955
19956 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19957 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19958 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19959 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19960
19961 If success DSNs have been requested
19962 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19963 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19964 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19965
19966
19967
19968 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19969 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19970 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19971 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19972 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19973 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19974 .code
19975 system_aliases:
19976 driver = redirect
19977 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19978 .endd
19979 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19980 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19981 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19982 cause delivery to be deferred.
19983
19984 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19985 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19986 .code
19987 userforward:
19988 driver = redirect
19989 check_local_user
19990 file = $home/.forward
19991 no_verify
19992 .endd
19993 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19994 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19995 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19996 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19997 comments.
19998
19999
20000
20001 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20002 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20003 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20004 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20005
20006 .ilist
20007 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20008 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20009 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20010 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20011 .next
20012 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20013 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20014 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20015 saves some resources.
20016 .endlist
20017
20018
20019
20020
20021
20022
20023 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20024 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20025 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20026 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20027 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20028
20029 .ilist
20030 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20031 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20032 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20033 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20034 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20035 document is intended for use by end users.
20036 .next
20037 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20038 described in the next section.
20039 .endlist
20040
20041 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
20042 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20043 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20044 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20045 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20046
20047
20048
20049 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20050 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20051 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20052 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20053 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20054 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20055 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20056 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20057 commas or newlines.
20058 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20059 quotes.
20060
20061 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20062 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20063 next newline character is ignored.
20064
20065 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20066 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20067 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20068 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20069 removed.
20070
20071 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20072 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20073 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20074 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20075 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20076 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20077 setting:
20078 .code
20079 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20080 .endd
20081
20082
20083 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20084 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20085 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20086 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20087 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20088 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20089 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20090 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20091 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20092 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20093 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20094
20095 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20096 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20097 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20098 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20099 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20100 .code
20101 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20102 .endd
20103 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20104 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20105 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20106 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20107 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20108 synonymously.
20109
20110 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20111 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20112 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20113 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20114 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20115
20116 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20117 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20118 contains:
20119 .code
20120 Sam.Reman: spqr
20121 .endd
20122 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20123 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20124 this forward file:
20125 .code
20126 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20127 .endd
20128 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20129 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20130 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20131 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20132 should really contain
20133 .code
20134 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20135 .endd
20136 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20137 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20138 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20139
20140
20141
20142 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20143 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20144 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20145
20146 .ilist
20147 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20148 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20149 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20150 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20151 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20152 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20153 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20154
20155 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20156 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20157 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20158 in double quotes, for example:
20159 .code
20160 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20161 .endd
20162 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20163 quote just the command. An item such as
20164 .code
20165 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20166 .endd
20167 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20168
20169 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20170 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20171 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20172 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20173 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20174 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20175 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20176 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20177 an &%accept%& router.
20178
20179 .next
20180 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20181 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20182 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20183 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20184 .code
20185 /home/world/minbari
20186 .endd
20187 is treated as a file name, but
20188 .code
20189 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20190 .endd
20191 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20192 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20193 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20194 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20195
20196 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20197 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20198
20199 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20200 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20201 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20202 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20203
20204 .next
20205 .cindex "included address list"
20206 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20207 If an item is of the form
20208 .code
20209 :include:<path name>
20210 .endd
20211 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20212 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20213 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20214 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20215 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20216 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20217 .code
20218 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20219 .endd
20220 It must be given as
20221 .code
20222 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20223 .endd
20224 .next
20225 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20226 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20227 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20228 .cindex "black hole"
20229 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20230 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20231 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20232 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20233 .code
20234 :blackhole:
20235 .endd
20236 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20237 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20238 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20239
20240 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20241 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20242 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20243 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20244 &_/dev/null_&.
20245
20246 .next
20247 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20248 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20249 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20250 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20251 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20252 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20253 redirection items of the form
20254 .code
20255 :defer:
20256 :fail:
20257 .endd
20258 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20259 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20260 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20261 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20262 .code
20263 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20264 .endd
20265 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20266 of a
20267 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20268 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20269 default.
20270 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20271 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20272 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20273
20274 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20275 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20276 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20277 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20278 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20279 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20280 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20281 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20282 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20283 ignored.
20284
20285 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20286 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20287 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20288 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20289
20290 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20291 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20292 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20293 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20294 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20295
20296 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20297 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20298 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20299 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20300 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20301 rules still apply.
20302
20303 .next
20304 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20305 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20306 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20307 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20308 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20309 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20310 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20311 .endlist
20312
20313
20314 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20315 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20316 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20317 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20318 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20319 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20320 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20321 aliasing scheme of the type
20322 .code
20323 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20324 localpart1: pipe
20325 localpart2: pipe
20326 .endd
20327 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20328 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20329 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20330 such as
20331 .code
20332 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20333 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20334 .endd
20335 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20336 the pipes are distinct.
20337
20338
20339
20340 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20341 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20342 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20343 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20344 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20345 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20346 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20347 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20348 can be used to avoid this.
20349
20350
20351 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20352 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20353 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20354 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20355 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20356 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20357 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20358
20359
20360
20361 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20362
20363 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20364 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20365
20366
20367 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20368 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20369 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20370
20371
20372 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20373 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20374 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20375 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20376
20377
20378 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20379 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20380 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20381 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20382 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20383 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20384 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20385
20386 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20387 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20388
20389
20390 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20391 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20392 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20393 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20394 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20395
20396
20397
20398 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20399 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20400 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20401 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20402 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20403 let ordinary users do.
20404
20405
20406
20407 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20408 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20409 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20410 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20411 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20412 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20413
20414 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20415 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20416 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20417 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20418 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20419 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20420 .code
20421 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20422 .endd
20423 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20424 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20425 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20426 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20427 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20428 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20429 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20430 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20431
20432
20433 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20434 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20435 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20436 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20437 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20438 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20439 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20440 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20441
20442
20443
20444 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20445 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20446 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20447 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20448 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20449 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20450
20451
20452 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20453 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20454 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20455 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20456 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20457 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20458
20459 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20460 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20461 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20462 .code
20463 data = #Exim filter\n\
20464 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20465 .endd
20466 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20467 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20468 choice into a newline.
20469
20470
20471 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20472 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20473 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20474 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20475 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20476
20477
20478 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20479 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20480 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20481 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20482 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20483 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20484 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20485 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20486
20487 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20488 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20489 runs a check on the containing directory,
20490 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20491 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20492 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20493 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20494 not, the router declines.
20495
20496
20497 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20498 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20499 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20500 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20501 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20502 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20503 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20504
20505
20506 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20507 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20508 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20509 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20510 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20511
20512
20513 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20514 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20515 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20516 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20517 redirection list.
20518
20519
20520 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20521 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20522 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20523 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20524 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20525
20526
20527
20528
20529 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20530 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20531 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20532 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20533 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20534 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20535 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20536 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20537 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20538 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20539 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20540
20541
20542 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20543 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20544 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20545 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20546 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20547 functions.
20548
20549 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20550 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20551 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20552 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20553 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20554 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20555
20556 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20557 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20558 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20559 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20560 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20561 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20562 &_.forward_& files).
20563
20564
20565 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20566 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20567 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20568 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20569 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20570
20571
20572 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20573 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20574 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20575 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20576 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20577 of the embedded Perl support.
20578
20579
20580 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20581 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20582 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20583 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20584 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20585
20586
20587 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20588 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20589 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20590 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20591 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20592
20593
20594 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20595 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20596 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20597 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20598 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20599 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20600 &%one_time%& is set.
20601
20602
20603 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20604 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20605 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20606 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20607 to make use of &%run%& items.
20608
20609
20610 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20611 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20612 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20613 If this option is true, items of the form
20614 .code
20615 :include:<path name>
20616 .endd
20617 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20618
20619
20620 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20621 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20622 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20623 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20624 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20625 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20626 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20627
20628
20629 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20630 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20631 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20632 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20633 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20634
20635
20636 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20637 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20638 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20639 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20640 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20641
20642
20643
20644
20645 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20646 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20647 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20648 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20649 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20650 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20651 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20652
20653
20654 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20655 .cindex "EACCES"
20656 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20657 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20658 file did not exist.
20659
20660
20661 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20662 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
20663 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20664 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20665 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20666
20667 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20668 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20669 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20670 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20671 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20672 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20673 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20674 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20675
20676
20677
20678 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20679 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20680 redirection list must start with this directory.
20681
20682
20683 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20684 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20685 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20686
20687
20688 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20689 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20690 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20691 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20692 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20693 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20694 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20695 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20696 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20697 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20698 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20699 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20700 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20701 before they subscribed.
20702
20703 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20704 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20705 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20706 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20707 attempt.
20708
20709 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20710 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20711 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20712 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20713
20714 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20715 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20716 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20717
20718 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20719 &%one_time%&.
20720
20721 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20722 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20723 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20724 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20725 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20726 expansion.
20727
20728
20729 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20730 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20731 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20732 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20733 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20734 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20735 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20736 See &%check_owner%& above.
20737
20738
20739 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20740 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20741 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20742 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20743
20744
20745 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20746 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20747 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20748 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20749 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20750 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20751 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20752
20753
20754 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20755 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20756 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20757 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20758 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20759 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20760 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20761 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20762
20763 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20764 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20765 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20766 addresses.
20767
20768 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20769 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20770 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20771 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20772 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20773 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20774 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20775 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20776 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20777 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20778
20779
20780 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20781 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20782 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20783 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20784 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20785 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20786
20787
20788 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20789 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20790 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20791 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20792 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20793 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20794
20795
20796 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20797 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20798 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20799 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20800 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20801
20802
20803 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20804 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20805 :subaddress part of an address.
20806
20807 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20808 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20809 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20810 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20811
20812
20813 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20814 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20815 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20816 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20817 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20818 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20819 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20820
20821
20822
20823 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20824 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20825 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20826 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20827 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20828 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20829 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20830 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20831 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20832 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20833 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20834 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20835 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20836 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20837 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20838 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20839
20840 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20841 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20842 the following routers.
20843
20844 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20845 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20846 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20847 so it is passed to the following routers.
20848
20849 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20850 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20851 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20852 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20853
20854 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20855 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20856 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20857 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20858 .code
20859 userforward:
20860 driver = redirect
20861 allow_filter
20862 check_local_user
20863 file = $home/.forward
20864 file_transport = address_file
20865 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20866 reply_transport = address_reply
20867 no_verify
20868 skip_syntax_errors
20869 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20870 syntax_errors_text = \
20871 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20872 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20873 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20874 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20875 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20876 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20877 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20878 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20879 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20880 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20881 .endd
20882 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20883 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20884 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20885 .code
20886 real_localuser:
20887 driver = accept
20888 check_local_user
20889 local_part_prefix = real-
20890 transport = local_delivery
20891 .endd
20892 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20893 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20894 .code
20895 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20896 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20897 .endd
20898
20899
20900 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20901 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20902
20903
20904 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20905 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20906 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20907 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20908
20909
20910
20911
20912
20913
20914 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20915 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20916
20917 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20918 "Environment for local transports"
20919 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20920 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20921 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20922 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20923 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20924 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20925 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20926
20927 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20928 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20929 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20930 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20931
20932 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20933 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20934 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20935 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20936 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20937
20938
20939
20940 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20941 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20942 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20943 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20944 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20945 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20946 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20947 time.
20948
20949 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20950 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20951 .code
20952 my_transport:
20953 driver = pipe
20954 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20955 .endd
20956 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20957 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20958 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20959 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20960
20961
20962
20963
20964 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20965 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20966 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20967 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20968 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20969 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20970 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20971 group (set by the transport). For example:
20972 .code
20973 # Routers ...
20974 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20975 local_users:
20976 driver = accept
20977 check_local_user
20978 transport = group_delivery
20979
20980 # Transports ...
20981 # This transport overrides the group
20982 group_delivery:
20983 driver = appendfile
20984 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20985 group = mail
20986 .endd
20987 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20988 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20989 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20990 set.
20991
20992 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20993 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20994 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20995 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20996 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20997 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20998
20999 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21000 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21001 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21002 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21003 original gid is also used.
21004
21005 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21006 following that is set is used:
21007
21008 .ilist
21009 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21010 .next
21011 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21012 .next
21013 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21014 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21015 .next
21016 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21017 .next
21018 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21019 the uid is the creator's uid;
21020 .next
21021 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21022 .endlist
21023
21024 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21025 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21026 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21027 The first of the following that is set is used:
21028
21029 .ilist
21030 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21031 .next
21032 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21033 .next
21034 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21035 .next
21036 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21037 .next
21038 The Exim uid.
21039 .endlist
21040
21041 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21042 &%never_users%& list.
21043
21044
21045
21046
21047
21048 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21049 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21050 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21051 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21052 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21053 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21054 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21055 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21056 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21057 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21058
21059 .ilist
21060 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21061 .next
21062 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21063 .next
21064 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21065 .next
21066 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21067 .endlist
21068
21069 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21070
21071 .ilist
21072 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21073 .next
21074 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21075 .endlist
21076
21077
21078 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21079 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21080 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21081
21082
21083
21084 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21085 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21086 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21087 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21088 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21089 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21090 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21091 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21092 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21093 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21094 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21095 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21096 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21097 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21098
21099
21100
21101
21102
21103
21104
21105 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21106 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21107
21108 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21109 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21110 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21111 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21112 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21113
21114
21115 .option body_only transports boolean false
21116 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21117 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21118 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21119 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21120 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21121 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21122 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21123 automatically suppress them.
21124
21125
21126 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21127 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21128 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21129 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21130 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21131 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21132
21133
21134 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21135 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21136 deliveries by the transport or for any
21137 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21138 what you are doing.
21139
21140
21141 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21142 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21143 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21144 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21145 transport is run.
21146 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21147 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21148 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21149 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21150 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21151 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21152 one.
21153 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21154 transport and the router that called it.
21155
21156 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21157 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21158 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21159 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21160 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21161 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21162 safely be resent to other recipients.
21163
21164
21165 .option driver transports string unset
21166 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21167 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21168
21169
21170 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21171 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21172 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21173 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21174 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21175 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21176 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21177 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21178 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21179 resent to other recipients.
21180
21181
21182 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21183 .cindex events
21184 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21185 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21186
21187
21188 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21189 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21190 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21191 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21192 &%user%& (see below).
21193
21194
21195 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21196 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21197 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21198 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21199 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21200 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21201 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21202 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21203 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21204 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21205 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21206
21207 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21208 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21209
21210
21211 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21212 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21213 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21214 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21215 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21216 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21217 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21218 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21219
21220
21221 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21222 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21223 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21224 This option specifies a list of header names,
21225 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21226 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21227 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21228 routers.
21229 Each list item is separately expanded.
21230 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21231 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21232 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21233
21234 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21235 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21236
21237 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21238 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21239 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21240
21241
21242
21243 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21244 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21245 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21246 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21247 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21248 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21249 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21250 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21251 example,
21252 .code
21253 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21254 x@y w@z
21255 .endd
21256 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21257 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21258 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21259 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21260 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21261 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21262 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21263 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21264 change envelope recipients at this time.
21265
21266
21267 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21268 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21269 .vindex "&$home$&"
21270 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21271 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21272 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21273 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21274 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21275 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21276 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21277 deferred.
21278
21279
21280 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21281 .cindex "additional groups"
21282 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21283 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21284 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21285 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21286 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21287
21288
21289 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21290 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21291 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21292 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21293 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21294 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21295 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21296 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21297
21298 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21299 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21300 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21301 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21302 Obviously there is scope for
21303 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21304 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21305
21306 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21307 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21308 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21309 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21310 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21311
21312
21313 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21314 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21315 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21316 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21317 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21318 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21319 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21320 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21321 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21322 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21323 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21324 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21325 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21326 delivered.
21327
21328
21329
21330 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21331 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21332 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21333 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21334 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21335 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21336 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21337 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21338 that contains
21339 .code
21340 local_part_prefix = *-
21341 .endd
21342 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21343 is delivered with
21344 .code
21345 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21346 .endd
21347 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21348 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21349 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21350 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21351 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21352
21353
21354 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21355 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21356 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21357 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21358 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21359 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21360 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21361 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21362 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21363
21364 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21365 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21366 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21367 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21368
21369 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21370 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21371 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21372
21373
21374 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21375 .cindex "envelope sender"
21376 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21377 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21378 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21379 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21380 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21381 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21382 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21383 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21384 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21385
21386 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21387 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21388
21389 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21390 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21391 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21392 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21393 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21394 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21395 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21396
21397 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21398 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21399 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21400 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21401 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21402
21403
21404
21405 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21406 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21407 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21408 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21409 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21410 have easy access to it.
21411
21412 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21413 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21414 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21415 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21416 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21417 recipients.
21418
21419
21420 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21421 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21422
21423
21424 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21425 .cindex "shadow transport"
21426 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21427 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21428 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21429
21430 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21431 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21432 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21433 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21434 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21435 cause a log line to be written.
21436
21437 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21438 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21439 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21440 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21441 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21442 of the form
21443 .code
21444 ST=<shadow transport name>
21445 .endd
21446 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21447 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21448 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21449 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21450 headers that some sites insist on.
21451
21452
21453 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21454 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21455 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21456 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21457 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21458 individual users or via a system filter.
21459 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21460
21461 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21462 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21463 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21464 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21465 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21466
21467 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21468 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21469 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21470 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21471 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21472 &(pipe)& transports.
21473
21474 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21475 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21476 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21477 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21478 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21479
21480 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21481 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21482 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21483 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21484
21485 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21486 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21487 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21488 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21489 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21490 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21491
21492 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21493 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21494 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21495 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21496 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21497 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21498 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21499 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21500
21501 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21502 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21503 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21504 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21505 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21506 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21507 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21508 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21509 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21510 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21511
21512 .vindex "&$host$&"
21513 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21514 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21515 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21516 which the message is being sent. For example:
21517 .code
21518 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21519 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21520 .endd
21521
21522 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21523 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21524 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21525 .ilist
21526 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21527 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21528 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21529 example:
21530 .code
21531 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21532 .endd
21533 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21534 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21535 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21536 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21537 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21538 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21539 .next
21540 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21541 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21542 arguments. Consider this example:
21543 .code
21544 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21545 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21546 .endd
21547 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21548 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21549 .code
21550 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21551 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21552 .endd
21553 .endlist
21554
21555 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21556 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21557 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21558 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21559 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21560 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21561 bounced from a transport filter.
21562
21563 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21564 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21565 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21566
21567
21568 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21569 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21570 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21571 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21572 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21573 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21574 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21575 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21576 becomes a temporary error.
21577
21578
21579 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21580 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21581 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21582 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21583 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21584 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21585 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21586 option is not set.
21587
21588 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21589 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21590 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21591
21592 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21593 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21594 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21595 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21596 retry data.
21597 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21598 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21599 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21600
21601
21602
21603
21604
21605
21606 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21608
21609 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21610 "Address batching"
21611 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21612 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21613 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21614 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21615 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21616 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21617 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21618
21619 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21620 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21621 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21622 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21623 local transport, for example:
21624
21625 .ilist
21626 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21627 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21628 recipients saves space.
21629 .next
21630 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21631 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21632 .next
21633 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21634 to a scanner program or
21635 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21636 acceptable.
21637 .endlist
21638
21639 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21640 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21641 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21642
21643 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21644 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21645 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21646 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21647 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21648 to certain conditions:
21649
21650 .ilist
21651 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21652 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21653 batching is possible.
21654 .next
21655 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21656 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21657 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21658 .next
21659 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21660 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21661 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21662 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21663 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21664 from taking place.
21665 .next
21666 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21667 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21668 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21669 be the same.
21670 .endlist
21671
21672 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21673 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21674 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21675 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21676 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21677 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21678 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21679 .code
21680 check_string = "."
21681 escape_string = ".."
21682 .endd
21683 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21684 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21685 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21686
21687 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21688 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21689 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21690 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21691 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21692 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21693
21694 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21695 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21696 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21697 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21698 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21699 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21700 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21701 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21702 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21703
21704
21705
21706
21707 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21708 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21709
21710 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21711 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21712 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21713 .cindex "directory creation"
21714 .cindex "creating directories"
21715 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21716 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21717 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21718 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21719 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21720 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21721 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21722 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21723 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21724 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21725
21726 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21727 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21728 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21729 included.
21730
21731 .cindex "quota" "system"
21732 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21733 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21734 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21735
21736 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21737 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21738 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21739 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21740
21741 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21742 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21743 private options.
21744
21745 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21746 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21747 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21748 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21749 option).
21750
21751
21752
21753 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21754 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21755 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21756 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21757 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21758
21759 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21760 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21761 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21762 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21763 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21764 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21765 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21766 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21767 operation. There are two cases:
21768
21769 .ilist
21770 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21771 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21772 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21773 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21774 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21775 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21776 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21777 .next
21778 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21779 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21780 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21781 .endlist
21782
21783
21784 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21785 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21786 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21787 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21788 form:
21789 .code
21790 save folder23
21791 .endd
21792 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21793 .code
21794 require "fileinto";
21795 fileinto "folder23";
21796 .endd
21797 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21798 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21799 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21800 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21801 way of handling this requirement:
21802 .code
21803 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21804 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21805 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21806 {$address_file} \
21807 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21808 }} \
21809 }
21810 .endd
21811 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21812 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21813 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21814
21815 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21816 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21817 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21818 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21819 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21820 path to the transport.
21821
21822 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21823 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21824
21825
21826
21827
21828 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21829 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21830
21831
21832
21833 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21834 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21835 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21836 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21837 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21838 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21839 delivery is deferred.
21840
21841
21842 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21843 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21844 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21845 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21846 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21847 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21848 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21849 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21850
21851
21852 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21853 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21854 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21855 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21856 file.
21857
21858
21859 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21860 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21861
21862
21863 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21864 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21865 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21866 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21867 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21868
21869
21870 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21871 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21872 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21873 process is running.
21874
21875
21876 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21877 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21878 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21879 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21880 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21881 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21882 contains is significant.
21883
21884 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21885 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21886 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21887 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21888 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21889
21890 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21891 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21892 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21893 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21894 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21895 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21896 .code
21897 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21898 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21899 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21900 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21901 .endd
21902 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21903 .cindex "directory creation"
21904 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21905 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21906 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21907
21908 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21909 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21910 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21911 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21912 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21913
21914
21915
21916 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21917 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21918 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21919 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21920 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21921 beneath.
21922
21923 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21924 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21925 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21926 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21927 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21928 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21929 &%file_must_exist%&.
21930
21931
21932 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21933 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21934 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21935 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21936
21937 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21938 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21939 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21940 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21941 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21942
21943
21944 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21945 .cindex "base62"
21946 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21947 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21948 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21949 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21950 .code
21951 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21952 .endd
21953 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21954 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21955 option.
21956
21957
21958 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21959 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21960 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21961
21962
21963 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21964 See &%check_string%& above.
21965
21966
21967 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21968 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21969 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21970 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21971 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21972 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21973 &%file%&.
21974
21975 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21976 .cindex "locking files"
21977 .cindex "lock files"
21978 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21979 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21980
21981 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21982 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21983 examples:
21984 .code
21985 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21986 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21987 file = $home/inbox
21988 .endd
21989 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21990 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21991 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21992 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21993 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21994 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21995
21996
21997
21998 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21999 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22000 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22001 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22002 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22003 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22004 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22005 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22006 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22007 this added to it:
22008 .code
22009 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22010 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22011 .endd
22012 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22013 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22014 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22015 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22016 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22017 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22018 delivery is deferred.
22019
22020
22021 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22022 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22023 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22024 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22025
22026
22027 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22028 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22029 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22030 .cindex "locking files"
22031 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22032 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22033 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22034 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22035 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22036 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22037 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22038 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22039
22040 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22041 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22042 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22043 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22044
22045 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22046 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22047 retries is
22048 .code
22049 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22050 .endd
22051 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22052 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22053 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22054
22055 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22056 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22057 .code
22058 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22059 .endd
22060
22061 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22062 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22063 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22064 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22065
22066
22067 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22068 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22069 for details of locking.
22070
22071
22072 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22073 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22074 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22075
22076
22077 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22078 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22079 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22080
22081
22082 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22083 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22084 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22085 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22086 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22087
22088
22089 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22090 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22091 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22092 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22093 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22094 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22095 external source that maintains the data.
22096
22097
22098 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22099 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22100 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22101 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22102 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22103 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22104 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22105 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22106
22107
22108
22109 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22110 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22111 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22112 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22113 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22114 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22115 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22116 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22117 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22118 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22119
22120
22121 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22122 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22123 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22124 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22125 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22126 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22127 calculation. The default value is:
22128 .code
22129 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22130 .endd
22131 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22132 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22133 &_Trash_&
22134 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22135 .code
22136 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22137 .endd
22138 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22139 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22140 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22141 directly into that directory.
22142
22143
22144 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22145 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22146 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22147
22148
22149 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22150 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22151 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22152
22153
22154 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22155 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22156 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22157 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22158 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22159 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22160 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22161 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22162
22163 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22164 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22165 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22166 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22167 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22168 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22169 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22170 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22171 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22172 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22173
22174
22175 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22176 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22177 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22178 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22179 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22180 below for further details.
22181
22182
22183 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22184 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22185 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22186
22187
22188 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22189 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22190 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22191
22192
22193 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22194 .cindex "locking files"
22195 .cindex "file" "locking"
22196 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22197 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22198 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22199 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22200 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22201 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22202 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22203
22204 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22205 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22206 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22207 combination:
22208 .code
22209 mbx_format = true
22210 message_prefix =
22211 message_suffix =
22212 .endd
22213 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22214 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22215 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22216 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22217 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22218 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22219 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22220 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22221
22222 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22223 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22224 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22225 append messages to it.
22226
22227
22228 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22229 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22230 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22231 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22232 in which case it is:
22233 .code
22234 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22235 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22236 .endd
22237 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22238 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22239
22240 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22241 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22242 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22243 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22244 setting
22245 .code
22246 message_suffix =
22247 .endd
22248 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22249 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22250
22251 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22252 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22253 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22254 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22255 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22256 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22257 value, and this option is ignored.
22258
22259
22260 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22261 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22262 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22263 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22264 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22265
22266
22267 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22268 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22269 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22270 on users about incoming mail.
22271
22272
22273 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22274 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22275 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22276 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22277 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22278 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22279 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22280 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22281 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22282
22283 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22284 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22285 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22286
22287 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22288 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22289 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22290 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22291 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22292 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22293
22294 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22295 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22296 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22297 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22298 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22299 be handled.
22300
22301 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22302 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22303
22304 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22305
22306 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22307 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22308 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22309 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22310 system quota failures.
22311
22312 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22313 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22314 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22315 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22316 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22317 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22318 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22319 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22320 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22321 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22322
22323
22324 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22325 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22326 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22327 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22328 delivery directory.
22329
22330
22331 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22332 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22333 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22334 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22335 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22336 &"no quota"&.
22337
22338 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22339 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22340
22341 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22342 See &%quota%& above.
22343
22344
22345 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22346 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22347 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22348 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22349 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22350 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22351 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22352
22353 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22354 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22355 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22356 the file length to the file name. For example:
22357 .code
22358 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22359 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22360 .endd
22361 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22362 number of lines in the message.
22363
22364 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22365 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22366 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22367
22368 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22369
22370
22371 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22372 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22373 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22374 .code
22375 quota_warn_message = "\
22376 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22377 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22378 This message is automatically created \
22379 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22380 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22381 a warning threshold that is\n\
22382 set by the system administrator.\n"
22383 .endd
22384
22385
22386 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22387 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22388 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22389 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22390 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22391 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22392 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22393 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22394 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22395 sign. For example:
22396 .code
22397 quota = 10M
22398 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22399 .endd
22400 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22401 percent sign is ignored.
22402
22403 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22404 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22405 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22406 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22407 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22408 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22409 .code
22410 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22411 .endd
22412 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22413 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22414 option.
22415
22416 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22417 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22418 percentage.
22419
22420
22421 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22422 .cindex "envelope sender"
22423 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22424 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22425 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22426 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22427 for details of batch SMTP.
22428
22429
22430 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22431 .cindex "carriage return"
22432 .cindex "linefeed"
22433 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22434 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22435 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22436 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22437
22438 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22439 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22440 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22441 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22442 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22443 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22444
22445
22446 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22447 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22448 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22449 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22450 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22451 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22452
22453
22454 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22455 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22456 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22457 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22458 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22459
22460 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22461 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22462 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22463 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22464
22465 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22466 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22467 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22468 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22469 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22470 error.
22471
22472 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22473 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22474
22475
22476 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22477 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22478 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22479 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22480 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22481 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22482 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22483
22484 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22485 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22486 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22487 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22488 file corruption.
22489
22490 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22491 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22492 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22493
22494
22495 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22496 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22497 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22498 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22499 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22500 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22501 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22502 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22503 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22504
22505 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22506 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22507 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22508 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22509
22510
22511
22512
22513 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22514 .cindex "appending to a file"
22515 .cindex "file" "appending"
22516 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22517
22518 .ilist
22519 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22520 return is given.
22521
22522 .next
22523 .cindex "directory creation"
22524 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22525 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22526 &%directory_mode%& option.
22527
22528 .next
22529 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22530 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22531 transport.
22532
22533 .next
22534 .cindex "file" "locking"
22535 .cindex "locking files"
22536 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22537 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22538 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22539
22540 .olist
22541 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22542 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22543 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22544 .next
22545 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22546 .next
22547 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22548 Unlink the hitching post name.
22549 .next
22550 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22551 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22552 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22553 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22554 .next
22555 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22556 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22557 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22558 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22559 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22560 it before trying again.
22561 .endlist olist
22562
22563 .next
22564 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22565 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22566 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22567
22568 .next
22569 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22570 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22571 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22572 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22573 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22574 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22575 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22576 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22577 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22578 checked.
22579
22580 .next
22581 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22582 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22583 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22584 delivery is deferred.
22585
22586 .next
22587 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22588 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22589 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22590 permissions.
22591
22592 .next
22593 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22594 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22595 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22596
22597 .next
22598 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22599 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22600 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22601
22602 .next
22603 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22604 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22605 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22606 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22607 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22608 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22609 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22610 that prevents link following.
22611
22612 .next
22613 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22614 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22615 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22616 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22617 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22618
22619 .next
22620 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22621
22622 .next
22623 .cindex "file" "locking"
22624 .cindex "locking files"
22625 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22626 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22627 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22628 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22629 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22630 .code
22631 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22632 .endd
22633 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22634 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22635 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22636
22637 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22638 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22639 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22640
22641 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22642 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22643 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22644 delivery is deferred.
22645
22646 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22647 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22648 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22649 immediately. It retries up to
22650 .code
22651 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22652 .endd
22653 times (rounded up).
22654 .endlist
22655
22656 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22657 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22658
22659
22660 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22661 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22662 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22663 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22664 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22665 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22666 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22667 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22668 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22669 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22670
22671 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22672 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22673 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22674 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22675 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22676 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22677 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22678
22679 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22680 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22681 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22682 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22683
22684
22685 .cindex "maildir format"
22686 .cindex "mailstore format"
22687 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22688 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22689 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22690 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22691 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22692
22693 .cindex "directory creation"
22694 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22695 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22696 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22697 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22698 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22699 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22700 deferred.
22701
22702
22703
22704 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22705 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22706 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22707 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22708 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22709 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22710 &_new_& subdirectory.
22711
22712 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22713 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22714 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22715 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22716 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22717 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22718 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22719
22720 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22721 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22722 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22723 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22724 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22725 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22726 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22727 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22728
22729 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22730 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22731 folders. Consider this example:
22732 .code
22733 maildir_format = true
22734 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22735 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22736 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22737 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22738 .endd
22739 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22740 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22741 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22742 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22743 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22744 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22745
22746 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22747 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22748 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22749 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22750 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22751
22752 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22753 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22754 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22755
22756 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22757 .cindex "maildir++"
22758 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22759 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22760 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22761 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22762 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22763 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22764 amount of space used.
22765
22766 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22767 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22768 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22769 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22770 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22771 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22772
22773
22774
22775
22776 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22777 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22778 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22779 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22780 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22781 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22782
22783
22784 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22785 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22786 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22787 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22788 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22789 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22790 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22791 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22792 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22793 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22794 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22795 backwards compatibility).
22796
22797 For one common implementation, you might set:
22798 .code
22799 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22800 .endd
22801 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22802
22803 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22804 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22805 &[stat()]& each message file.
22806
22807
22808 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22809 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22810 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22811 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22812 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22813 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22814 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22815 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22816 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22817
22818 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22819 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22820 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22821 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22822 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22823 need to know the quota.
22824
22825 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22826 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22827
22828 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22829 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22830 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22831 details.
22832
22833
22834 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22835 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22836 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22837 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22838 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22839 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22840 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22841 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22842
22843 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22844 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22845 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22846 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22847 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22848 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22849
22850 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22851 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22852 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22853 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22854 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22855 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22856
22857 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22858 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22859 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22860 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22861
22862
22863 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22864 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22865 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22866 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22867 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22868 .code
22869 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22870 .endd
22871 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22872 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22873 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22874 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22875 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22876
22877
22878
22879
22880
22881
22882 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22883 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22884
22885 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22886 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22887 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22888 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22889 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22890 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22891 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22892 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22893
22894 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22895 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22896 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22897 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22898 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22899
22900
22901 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22902 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22903 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22904 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22905 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22906
22907 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22908 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22909 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22910 transport is run as a consequence of a
22911 &%mail%&
22912 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22913 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22914 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22915 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22916 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22917 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22918
22919 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22920 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22921 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22922 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22923
22924 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22925 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22926 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22927 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22928 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22929 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22930 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22931
22932 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22933 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22934 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22935 the transport defers.
22936 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22937 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22938
22939 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22940 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22941 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22942 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22943
22944 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22945 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22946 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22947 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22948 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22949 problems. They are just discarded.
22950
22951
22952
22953 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22954 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22955
22956 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22957 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22958 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22959
22960
22961 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22962 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22963 when the message is specified by the transport.
22964
22965
22966 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22967 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22968 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22969 string comes first.
22970
22971
22972 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22973 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22974 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22975
22976
22977 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22978 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22979 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22980
22981
22982 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22983 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22984 specified by the transport.
22985
22986
22987 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22988 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22989 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22990 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22991
22992
22993 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22994 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22995 the message is specified by the transport.
22996
22997
22998 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22999 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23000 used.
23001
23002
23003 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23004 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23005 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23006 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23007 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23008
23009
23010
23011 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23012 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23013 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23014 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23015
23016 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23017 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
23018 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23019 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23020 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23021 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23022 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23023 infinity.
23024
23025 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23026 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23027 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23028 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23029 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23030
23031 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23032 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23033 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23034 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23035 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23036 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23037
23038
23039 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23040 See &%once%& above.
23041
23042
23043 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23044 See &%once%& above.
23045 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23046
23047
23048 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23049 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23050 specified by the transport.
23051
23052
23053 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23054 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23055 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23056 configuration option.
23057
23058
23059 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23060 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23061 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23062 automatic responses. For example:
23063 .code
23064 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23065 .endd
23066 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23067 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23068 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23069 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23070 small.
23071
23072
23073
23074 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23075 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23076 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23077 the text comes first.
23078
23079
23080 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23081 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23082 when the message is specified by the transport.
23083 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23084 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23085
23086
23087
23088
23089 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23090 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23091
23092 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23093 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23094 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23095 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23096 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23097 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23098 specified command
23099 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23100 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23101 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23102 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23103 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23104 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23105 .code
23106 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23107 .endd
23108 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23109 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23110 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23111 as follows:
23112
23113 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23114 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23115
23116
23117 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23118 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23119 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23120 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23121 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23122
23123
23124 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23125 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23126 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23127 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23128 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23129 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23130 LMTP protocol.
23131
23132 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23133 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23134 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23135 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23136 in its response to the LHLO command.
23137
23138 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23139 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23140 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23141 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23142
23143
23144 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23145 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23146 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23147 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23148 LMTP transport:
23149 .code
23150 lmtp:
23151 driver = lmtp
23152 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23153 batch_max = 20
23154 user = exim
23155 .endd
23156 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23157 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23158
23159
23160
23161 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23162 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23163
23164 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23165 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23166 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23167 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23168 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23169 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23170 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23171 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23172 following ways:
23173
23174 .ilist
23175 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23176 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23177 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23178 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23179 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23180 .next
23181 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23182 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23183 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23184 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23185 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23186 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23187 that are routed to the transport.
23188 .next
23189 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23190 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23191 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23192 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23193 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23194 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23195 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23196 .endlist
23197
23198
23199 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23200 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23201 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23202
23203 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23204 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23205 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23206 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23207 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23208 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23209 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23210
23211
23212 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23213 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23214 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23215 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23216 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23217 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23218 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23219
23220
23221
23222
23223 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23224 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23225 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23226 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23227 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23228 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23229 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23230 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23231 &"local delivery failed"&.
23232
23233 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23234 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23235 will be sent as normal.
23236
23237 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23238 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23239 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23240 apply in this case.
23241
23242 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23243 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23244 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23245 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23246
23247 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23248 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23249 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23250 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23251 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23252 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23253 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23254 &%temp_errors%&.
23255
23256
23257
23258 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23259 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23260 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23261 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23262 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23263 run.
23264
23265 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23266 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23267 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23268 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23269
23270 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23271 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23272 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23273 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23274 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23275 .code
23276 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23277 .endd
23278 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23279 arguments. You have to write
23280 .code
23281 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23282 .endd
23283 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23284 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23285 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23286 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23287 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23288 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23289 example:
23290 .code
23291 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23292 .endd
23293
23294 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23295 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23296 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23297 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23298 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23299 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23300 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23301 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23302 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23303 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23304
23305 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23306 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23307 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23308 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23309 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23310 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23311 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23312 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23313
23314 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23315 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23316 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23317 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23318 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23319 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23320 control what is done with it.
23321
23322 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23323 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23324 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23325 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23326 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23327 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23328 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23329 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23330 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23331 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23332 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23333
23334
23335
23336 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23337 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23338 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23339 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23340 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23341 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23342 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23343 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23344 .display
23345 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23346 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23347 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23348 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23349 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23350 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23351 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23352 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23353 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23354 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23355 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23356 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23357 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23358 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23359 &`USER `& see below
23360 .endd
23361 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23362 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23363 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23364 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23365 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23366 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23367 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23368
23369 .cindex "HOST"
23370 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23371 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23372 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23373 the router.
23374
23375 .cindex "HOME"
23376 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23377 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23378 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23379 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23380
23381
23382 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23383 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23384
23385
23386
23387 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23388 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23389 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23390 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23391 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23392 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23393 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23394 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23395 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23396 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23397 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23398 example, if
23399 .code
23400 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23401 .endd
23402 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23403 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23404 &%use_shell%& is set.
23405
23406
23407 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23408 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23409
23410
23411 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23412 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23413 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23414
23415
23416 .option check_string pipe string unset
23417 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23418 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23419 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23420 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23421 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23422 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23423 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23424 ignored.
23425
23426
23427 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23428 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23429 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23430 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23431 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23432 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23433 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23434
23435
23436 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23437 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23438 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23439 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23440 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23441 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23442 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23443
23444
23445 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23446 See &%check_string%& above.
23447
23448
23449 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23450 .cindex "exec failure"
23451 .cindex "failure of exec"
23452 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23453 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23454 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23455 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23456 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23457
23458
23459 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23460 .cindex "signal exit"
23461 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23462 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23463 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23464 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23465
23466
23467 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23468 .cindex "force command"
23469 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23470 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23471 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23472 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23473 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23474 command. For example:
23475 .code
23476 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23477 force_command
23478 .endd
23479
23480 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23481 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23482 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23483
23484
23485 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23486 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23487 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23488 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23489 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23490 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23491
23492 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23493 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23494
23495
23496 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23497 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23498 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23499 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23500 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23501 written to the main log.
23502
23503
23504 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23505 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23506 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23507 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23508 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23509 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23510 be set.
23511
23512
23513 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23514 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23515 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23516 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23517 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23518
23519
23520 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23521 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23522 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23523 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23524 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23525 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23526 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23527 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23528
23529
23530 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23531 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23532 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23533 .code
23534 message_prefix = \
23535 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23536 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23537 .endd
23538 .cindex "Cyrus"
23539 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23540 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23541 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23542 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23543 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23544 setting
23545 .code
23546 message_prefix =
23547 .endd
23548 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23549 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23550
23551
23552 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23553 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23554 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23555 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23556 .code
23557 message_suffix =
23558 .endd
23559 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23560 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23561
23562
23563 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23564 This option is expanded and
23565 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23566 variable of the subprocess.
23567 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23568 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23569 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23570
23571
23572 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23573 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23574 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23575 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23576 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23577 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23578 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23579 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23580 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23581
23582
23583 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23584 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23585 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23586 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23587 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23588 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23589 accept the message is used.
23590
23591
23592 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23593 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23594 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23595 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23596 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23597 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23598
23599
23600 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23601 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23602 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23603 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23604 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23605 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23606 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23607
23608
23609
23610 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23611 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23612 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23613 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23614 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23615 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23616 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23617 of them may be set.
23618
23619
23620
23621 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23622 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23623 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23624 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23625 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23626 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23627 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23628 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23629 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23630 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23631 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23632 and 73, respectively.
23633
23634
23635 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23636 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23637 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23638 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23639 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23640 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23641 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23642
23643 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23644 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23645 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23646 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23647 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23648 delivery to be deferred.
23649
23650 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23651 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23652
23653
23654 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23655 .cindex "envelope sender"
23656 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23657 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23658 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23659 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23660 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23661
23662 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23663 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23664 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23665 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23666 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23667 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23668 class database.
23669
23670
23671 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23672 .cindex "carriage return"
23673 .cindex "linefeed"
23674 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23675 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23676 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23677 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23678
23679 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23680 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23681 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23682 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23683 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23684
23685
23686 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23687 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23688 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23689 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23690 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23691 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23692 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23693 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23694 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23695 its &%-c%& option.
23696
23697
23698
23699 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23700 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23701 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23702 .cindex "external local delivery"
23703 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23704 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23705 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23706 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23707 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23708 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23709 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23710 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23711 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23712 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23713 .code
23714 # transport
23715 procmail_pipe:
23716 driver = pipe
23717 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23718 return_path_add
23719 delivery_date_add
23720 envelope_to_add
23721 check_string = "From "
23722 escape_string = ">From "
23723 umask = 077
23724 user = $local_part
23725 group = mail
23726
23727 # router
23728 procmail:
23729 driver = accept
23730 check_local_user
23731 transport = procmail_pipe
23732 .endd
23733 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23734 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23735 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23736 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23737 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23738 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23739
23740 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23741 .code
23742 IFS=" "
23743 .endd
23744 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23745 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23746
23747 .cindex "Cyrus"
23748 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23749 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23750 .code
23751 # transport
23752 local_delivery_cyrus:
23753 driver = pipe
23754 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23755 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23756 user = cyrus
23757 group = mail
23758 return_output
23759 log_output
23760 message_prefix =
23761 message_suffix =
23762
23763 # router
23764 local_user_cyrus:
23765 driver = accept
23766 check_local_user
23767 local_part_suffix = .*
23768 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23769 .endd
23770 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23771 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23772 sender.
23773 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23774 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23775
23776
23777 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23778 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23779
23780 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23781 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23782 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23783 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23784 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23785 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23786 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23787 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23788
23789
23790 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23791 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23792 two ways:
23793
23794 .ilist
23795 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23796 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23797 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23798 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23799 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23800 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23801 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23802 .next
23803 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23804 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23805 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23806 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23807 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23808 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23809 process.
23810 .endlist
23811
23812
23813 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23814 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23815 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23816
23817
23818
23819 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23820 .vindex "&$host$&"
23821 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23822 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23823 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23824 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23825 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23826 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23827 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23828 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23829
23830
23831 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23832 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23833 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23834 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23835 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23836 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23837 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23838 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23839 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23840 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23841 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23842 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23843 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23844 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23845
23846 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23847 and will be removed in a future release.
23848
23849
23850 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23851 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23852 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23853
23854
23855 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23856 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23857 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23858 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23859 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23860 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23861 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23862 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23863
23864 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23865 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23866 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23867 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23868 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23869 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23870 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23871 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23872 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23873
23874
23875 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23876 .cindex "Cyrus"
23877 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23878 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23879 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23880 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23881 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23882 ignored.
23883
23884 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23885 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23886 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23887 particular connection.
23888
23889 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23890 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23891 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23892 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23893
23894 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23895 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23896 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23897 .code
23898 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23899 .endd
23900 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23901 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23902
23903 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23904 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23905 value.
23906
23907
23908 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23909 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23910 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23911 authenticated as a client.
23912
23913
23914 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23915 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23916 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23917 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23918
23919
23920 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23921 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23922 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23923 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23924 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23925 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23926 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23927
23928
23929 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23930 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23931 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23932 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23933 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23934 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23935 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23936 option.
23937
23938
23939 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23940 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23941 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23942 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23943
23944
23945 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
23946 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23947 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23948 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23949 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23950 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
23951 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
23952 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
23953 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23954
23955
23956 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23957 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23958 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23959 cutoff times.
23960
23961 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23962 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23963 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23964 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23965 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23966 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23967
23968 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23969 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23970 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23971 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23972 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23973 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23974 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23975 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23976 to them.
23977
23978
23979 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23980 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23981 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23982 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23983 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23984
23985
23986 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23987 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23988 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23989 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23990 details.
23991
23992
23993 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23994 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23995 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23996 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23997 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23998 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23999 the dnssec request bit set.
24000 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24001
24002
24003
24004 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24005 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24006 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24007 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24008 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24009 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24010 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24011 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24012 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24013
24014
24015
24016 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24017 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24018 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24019 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24020 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24021 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24022 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24023
24024 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24025 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24026 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24027 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24028 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24029
24030
24031 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24032 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24033 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24034 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24035 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24036 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24037 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24038 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24039
24040 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24041 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24042 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24043 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24044 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24045 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24046
24047 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24048 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24049 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24050 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24051 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24052
24053 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24054 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24055 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24056 copy of the message is sent.
24057
24058 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24059 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24060 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24061 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24062 fails"& facility.
24063
24064
24065 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24066 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24067 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24068 zero.
24069
24070 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24071 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24072 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24073 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24074 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24075 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24076
24077 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24078 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24079 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24080 implementations of TLS.
24081
24082 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24083 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24084 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24085 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24086 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24087 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24088 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24089 option is:
24090 .code
24091 $primary_hostname
24092 .endd
24093 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24094 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24095 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24096 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24097 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24098 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24099 interface address, you could use this:
24100 .code
24101 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24102 {$primary_hostname}}
24103 .endd
24104 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24105 callouts.
24106
24107 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24108 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24109 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24110 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24111 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24112 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24113
24114 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24115 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24116 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24117 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24118
24119 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24120 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24121 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24122 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24123 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24124 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24125 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24126
24127 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24128 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24129 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24130 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24131 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24132 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24133 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24134 address are used.
24135
24136 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24137 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24138
24139
24140 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24141 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24142 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24143 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24144 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24145 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24146 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24147 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24148 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24149 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24150
24151
24152 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24153 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24154 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24155 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24156
24157
24158 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24159 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24160 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24161 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24162
24163 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24164 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24165 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24166 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24167 to any host that matches this list.
24168
24169
24170 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24171 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24172 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24173 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24174 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24175 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24176 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24177 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24178
24179
24180 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24181 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24182 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24183 why it exists.
24184
24185
24186
24187 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24188 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24189 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24190 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24191 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24192 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24193 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24194 explanation of when this might be needed.
24195
24196 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24197 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24198 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24199 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24200 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24201 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24202 message on the same session.
24203
24204 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24205 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24206 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24207 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24208 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24209 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24210 logging.
24211
24212
24213
24214 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24215 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24216 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24217 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24218 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24219
24220
24221 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24222 .cindex "randomized host list"
24223 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24224 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24225 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24226 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24227 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24228 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24229 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24230 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24231
24232 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24233 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24234 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24235 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24236 .code
24237 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24238 .endd
24239 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24240 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24241 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24242
24243 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24244 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24245 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24246 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24247 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24248 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24249 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24250 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24251 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24252
24253
24254 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24255 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24256 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24257 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24258 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24259
24260 .new
24261 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24262 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24263 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24264 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24265 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24266 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24267 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24268 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24269 .wen
24270
24271 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24272 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24273 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24274 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24275 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24276
24277 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24278 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24279 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24280 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24281 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24282 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24283
24284 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24285 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24286 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24287 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24288 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24289 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24290 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24291
24292 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24293 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24294 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24295 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24296 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24297 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24298 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24299
24300 .new
24301 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24302 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24303 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24304 If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24305 TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24306 If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24307 a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24308 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24309 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24310 .wen
24311
24312 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24313 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24314 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24315 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24316 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24317 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24318 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24319 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24320 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24321 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24322
24323 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24324 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24325
24326 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24327 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24328 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24329 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24330 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24331
24332 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24333 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24334 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24335 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24336 for multi-recipient messages.
24337 The option can usually be left as default.
24338
24339 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24340 .cindex "bind IP address"
24341 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24342 .vindex "&$host$&"
24343 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24344 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24345 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24346 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24347 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24348 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24349 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24350 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24351 unknown.
24352
24353 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24354 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24355 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24356 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24357 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24358 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24359 .code
24360 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24361 .endd
24362 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24363 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24364 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24365 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24366
24367
24368 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24369 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24370 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24371 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24372 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24373 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24374 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24375 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24376 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24377 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24378 unreachable hosts.
24379
24380
24381 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24382 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24383 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24384 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24385 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24386
24387 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24388 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24389 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24390 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24391 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24392 permits this.
24393
24394
24395 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24396 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24397 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24398 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24399 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24400 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24401 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24402 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24403
24404 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24405 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24406 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24407
24408 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24409 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24410 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24411 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24412 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24413 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24414 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24415 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24416
24417 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24418 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24419 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24420 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24421 is deferred.
24422
24423
24424
24425 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24426 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24427 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24428 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24429 .vindex "&$port$&"
24430 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24431 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24432 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24433 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24434 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24435
24436 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24437 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24438 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24439 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24440
24441
24442 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24443 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24444 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24445 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24446 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24447 addresses is not affected.
24448
24449 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24450 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24451 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24452 Exim to use only the host name.
24453 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24454
24455
24456 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24457 .cindex "serializing connections"
24458 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24459 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24460 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24461 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24462 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24463 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24464 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24465
24466 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24467 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24468 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24469 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24470 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24471 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24472
24473 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24474 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24475 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24476 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24477 are used for ETRN serialization.
24478
24479 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24480
24481
24482 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24483 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24484 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24485 .cindex "size" "of message"
24486 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24487 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24488 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24489 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24490 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24491 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24492 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24493 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24494
24495 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24496 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24497
24498
24499 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24500 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24501 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24502 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24503
24504
24505 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24506 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24507 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24508 .vindex "&$host$&"
24509 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24510 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24511 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24512 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24513 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24514 details of TLS.
24515
24516 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24517 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24518 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24519 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24520 client.
24521
24522
24523 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24524 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24525 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24526 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24527 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24528
24529
24530 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24531 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24532 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24533 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24534 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24535 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24536 will fail.
24537
24538 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24539
24540
24541 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24542 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24543 .vindex "&$host$&"
24544 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24545 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24546 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24547 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24548 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24549 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24550 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24551 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24552
24553
24554 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24555 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24556 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24557 .vindex "&$host$&"
24558 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24559 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24560 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24561 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24562 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24563 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24564 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24565 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24566 ciphers is a preference order.
24567
24568
24569
24570 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24571 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24572 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24573 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24574 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24575 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24576 certificate and private key for the session.
24577
24578 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24579
24580 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24581 TLS extensions.
24582
24583
24584
24585
24586 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24587 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24588 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24589 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24590 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24591 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24592 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24593 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24594 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24595 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24596 in clear.
24597
24598
24599 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24600 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24601 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24602 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24603 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24604 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24605 Note that unless the host is in this list
24606 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24607 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24608 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24609 certificate verification succeeds.
24610
24611
24612 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24613 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24614 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24615 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24616 while verifying the server certificate,
24617 checks will be included on the host name
24618 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24619 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24620 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24621
24622 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24623
24624
24625 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24626 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24627 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24628 .vindex "&$host$&"
24629 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24630 The value of this option must be either the
24631 word "system"
24632 or the absolute path to
24633 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24634 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24635
24636 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24637 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24638 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24639 must be specified.
24640
24641 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24642 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24643
24644 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24645 explicitly
24646 either by file or directory
24647 are added to those given by the system default location.
24648
24649 The values of &$host$& and
24650 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24651 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24652
24653 For back-compatibility,
24654 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24655 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24656 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24657
24658
24659 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24660 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24661 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24662 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24663 certificate verification must succeed.
24664 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24665 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24666 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24667
24668
24669
24670
24671 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24672 "SECTvalhosmax"
24673 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24674 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24675 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24676 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24677 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24678
24679
24680 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24681 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24682 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24683 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24684 retrying.
24685
24686 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24687 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24688 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24689
24690 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24691 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24692 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24693 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24694 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24695
24696 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24697 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24698 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24699 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24700 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24701 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24702 see below for an exception).
24703
24704 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24705 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24706 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24707 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24708 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24709
24710 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24711 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24712 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24713 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24714 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24715 reached their retry times.
24716
24717 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24718 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24719 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24720 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24721 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24722 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24723 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24724 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24725 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24726 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24727 reached.
24728
24729 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24730 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24731 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24732 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24733 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24734 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24735
24736 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24737 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24738 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24739 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24740 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24741 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24742
24743
24744
24745
24746
24747 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24748 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24749
24750 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24751 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24752 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24753 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24754 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24755 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24756
24757 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24758 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24759 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24760 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24761 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24762 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24763 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24764
24765 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24766 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24767 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24768 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24769
24770
24771 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24772 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24773 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24774 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24775
24776 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24777 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24778 facility; you do not have to use it.
24779
24780 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24781 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24782 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24783 address to which it applies.
24784
24785 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24786 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24787 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24788 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24789 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24790 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24791 rules.
24792
24793 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24794 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24795 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24796 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24797
24798
24799 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24800 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24801 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24802 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24803 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24804 discouraged.
24805
24806 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24807 illustrated by these examples:
24808
24809 .ilist
24810 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24811 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24812 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24813 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24814 .next
24815 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24816 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24817 .endlist
24818
24819
24820
24821 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24822 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24823 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24824 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24825 message's processing.
24826
24827 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24828 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24829 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24830 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24831 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24832 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24833 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24834 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24835 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24836
24837 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24838 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24839 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24840 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24841 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24842 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24843 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24844 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24845 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24846 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24847
24848 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24849 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24850 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24851 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24852 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24853 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24854
24855 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24856 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24857 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24858
24859 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24860 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24861 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24862 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24863 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24864 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24865 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24866 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24867 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24868
24869 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24870 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24871 transport time.
24872
24873
24874
24875
24876 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24877 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24878 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24879 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24880 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24881 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24882 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24883 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24884 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24885 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24886 .code
24887 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24888 .endd
24889 might produce the output
24890 .code
24891 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24892 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24893 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24894 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24895 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24896 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24897 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24898 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24899 .endd
24900 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24901 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24902 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24903 set for a particular transport.
24904
24905
24906 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24907 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24908 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24909 rules in the form
24910 .display
24911 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24912 .endd
24913 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24914 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24915 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24916 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24917
24918 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24919 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24920 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24921 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24922 ignored.
24923
24924 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24925 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24926 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24927
24928 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24929 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24930 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24931 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24932 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24933 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24934 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24935
24936 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24937 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24938 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24939 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24940 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24941 .code
24942 *@* ${lookup ...
24943 .endd
24944 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24945 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24946
24947
24948 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24949 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24950 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24951 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24952 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24953 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24954 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24955 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24956 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24957
24958 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24959 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24960 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24961
24962 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24963 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24964 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24965 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24966 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24967 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24968 of pattern they are set as follows:
24969
24970 .ilist
24971 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24972 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24973 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24974 pattern
24975 .code
24976 *queen@*.fict.example
24977 .endd
24978 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24979 .code
24980 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24981 $1 = hearts-
24982 $2 = wonderland
24983 .endd
24984 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24985 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24986
24987 .next
24988 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24989 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24990 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24991 rewriting rule of the form
24992 .display
24993 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24994 .endd
24995 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24996 .code
24997 $1 = foo
24998 $2 = bar
24999 $3 = baz.example
25000 .endd
25001 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25002 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25003 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25004 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25005 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25006 .endlist
25007
25008
25009 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25010 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25011 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25012 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25013 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25014 .code
25015 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25016 .endd
25017 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25018 &'From:'& headers.
25019
25020 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25021 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25022 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25023 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25024 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25025 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25026 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25027 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25028 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25029 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25030 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25031 entry written to the panic log.
25032
25033
25034
25035 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25036 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25037
25038 .ilist
25039 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25040 c, f, h, r, s, t.
25041 .next
25042 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25043 .next
25044 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25045 .endlist
25046
25047 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25048 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25049
25050
25051
25052 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25053 "SECID154"
25054 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25055 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25056 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25057 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25058 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25059 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25060 .display
25061 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25062 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25063 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25064 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25065 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25066 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25067 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25068 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25069 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25070 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25071 .endd
25072 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25073 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25074 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25075
25076 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25077 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25078
25079
25080 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25081 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25082 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25083 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25084 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25085 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25086 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25087 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25088 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25089
25090 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25091 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25092 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25093 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25094 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25095 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25096 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25097 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25098
25099
25100 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25101 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25102 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25103 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25104
25105 .ilist
25106 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25107 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25108 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25109 .next
25110 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25111 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25112 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25113 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25114 .next
25115 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25116 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25117 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25118 .next
25119 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25120 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25121 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25122 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25123 .code
25124 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25125 .endd
25126 into
25127 .code
25128 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25129 .endd
25130 .cindex "RFC 2047"
25131 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25132 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25133 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25134 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25135 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25136 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25137 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25138 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25139
25140 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25141 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25142 .endlist
25143
25144
25145 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25146 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25147 .code
25148 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25149 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25150 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25151 .endd
25152 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25153 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25154 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25155 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25156 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25157 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25158 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25159 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25160
25161 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25162 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25163 .code
25164 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25165 .endd
25166 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25167 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25168
25169 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25170 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25171 messages that originate outside the local host:
25172 .code
25173 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25174 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25175 .endd
25176 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25177 space.
25178
25179 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25180 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25181 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25182 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25183 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25184 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25185 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25186 components. For example, the rule
25187 .code
25188 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25189 .endd
25190 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25191 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25192 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25193 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25194 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25195 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25196 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25197 .ecindex IIDaddrew
25198
25199
25200
25201
25202
25203 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25204 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25205
25206 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25207 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25208 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25209 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25210 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25211 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25212 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25213 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25214 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25215 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25216 address, domain and error.
25217
25218 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25219 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25220 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25221 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25222 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25223 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25224 log selector is set, the message
25225 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25226 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25227 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25228 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25229
25230 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25231 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25232 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25233 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25234 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25235 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25236 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25237 domain are maintained independently.
25238
25239 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25240 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25241 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25242 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25243 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25244 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25245 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25246 the local address is reached.
25247
25248 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25249 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25250 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25251 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25252 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25253
25254 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25255 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25256 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25257 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25258 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25259 messages that it should now be retaining.
25260
25261
25262
25263 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25264 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25265 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25266 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25267 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25268 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25269 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25270 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25271 message's sender, respectively.
25272
25273
25274 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25275 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25276 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25277 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25278 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25279 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25280 example,
25281 .code
25282 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25283 .endd
25284 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25285 whereas
25286 .code
25287 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25288 .endd
25289 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25290 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25291 part.
25292
25293 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25294 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25295 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25296 expressions work in address lists.
25297 .display
25298 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25299 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25300 .endd
25301
25302
25303 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25304 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25305 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25306 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25307 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25308 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25309 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25310 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25311 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25312
25313 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25314 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25315 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25316 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25317 local transports).
25318
25319 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25320 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25321 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25322 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25323 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25324 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25325 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25326 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25327 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25328 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25329 commands.
25330
25331
25332
25333 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25334 "SECID160"
25335 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25336 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25337 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25338 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25339 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25340 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25341 .code
25342 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25343 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25344 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25345 .endd
25346 and the retry rules are
25347 .code
25348 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25349 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25350 .endd
25351 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25352 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25353 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25354 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25355 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25356 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25357
25358 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25359 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25360 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25361 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25362
25363 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25364 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25365 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25366 .code
25367 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25368 .endd
25369 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25370 textual form of the IP address.
25371
25372 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25373 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25374 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25375 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25376
25377 .vlist
25378 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25379 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25380 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25381
25382 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25383 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25384 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25385
25386 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25387 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25388
25389 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25390 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25391 .endlist
25392
25393 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25394 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25395 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25396 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25397 retry rule of this form:
25398 .code
25399 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25400 .endd
25401 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25402 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25403
25404 .vlist
25405 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25406 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25407 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25408 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25409
25410 .vitem &%lookup%&
25411 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25412 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25413 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25414 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25415 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25416
25417 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25418 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25419
25420 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25421 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25422
25423 .vitem &%refused%&
25424 A connection was refused.
25425
25426 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25427 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25428
25429 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25430 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25431
25432 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25433 A connection attempt timed out.
25434
25435 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25436 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25437 obtained from an MX record.
25438
25439 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25440 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25441 obtained from an MX record.
25442
25443 .vitem &%timeout%&
25444 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25445
25446 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25447 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25448 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25449 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25450
25451 .vitem &%quota%&
25452 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25453 transport.
25454
25455 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25456 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25457 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25458 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25459 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25460 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25461 for four days.
25462 .endlist
25463
25464 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25465 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25466 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25467 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25468 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25469 heuristic rules:
25470
25471 .ilist
25472 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25473 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25474 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25475 .next
25476 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25477 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25478 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25479 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25480 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25481 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25482 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25483 .next
25484 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25485 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25486 .endlist
25487
25488 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25489 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25490 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25491 error).
25492
25493
25494
25495 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25496 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25497 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25498 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25499 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25500 form:
25501 .display
25502 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25503 .endd
25504 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25505 .code
25506 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25507 .endd
25508 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25509 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25510 For example:
25511 .code
25512 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25513 .endd
25514 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25515 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25516 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25517 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25518 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25519
25520 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25521 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25522 .code
25523 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25524 .endd
25525 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25526 list is never matched.
25527
25528
25529
25530
25531
25532 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25533 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25534 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25535 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25536 .display
25537 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25538 .endd
25539 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25540 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25541 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25542 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25543 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25544
25545 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25546 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25547 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25548 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25549 The available algorithms are:
25550
25551 .ilist
25552 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25553 the interval.
25554 .next
25555 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25556 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25557 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25558 .next
25559 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25560 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25561 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25562 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25563 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25564 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25565 queue processing times.
25566 .endlist
25567
25568 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25569 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25570 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25571 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25572 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25573 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25574 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25575 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25576 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25577 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25578 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25579 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25580
25581 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25582 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25583 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25584 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25585 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25586 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25587 time.
25588
25589 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25590 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25591 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25592 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25593 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25594 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25595 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25596 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25597 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25598 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25599 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25600 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25601
25602 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25603 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25604 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25605 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25606 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25607 deliveries that have been deferred.
25608
25609
25610 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25611 Here are some example retry rules:
25612 .code
25613 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25614 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25615 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25616 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25617 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25618 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25619 .endd
25620 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25621 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25622 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25623 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25624 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25625 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25626 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25627 days.
25628
25629 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25630 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25631 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25632 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25633 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25634
25635 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25636 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25637 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25638 were not obtained from an MX record.
25639
25640 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25641 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25642 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25643 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25644 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25645
25646
25647
25648 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25649 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25650 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25651 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25652 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25653 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25654 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25655 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25656 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25657 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25658 failing for the first time.
25659
25660 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25661 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25662 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25663 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25664
25665 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25666 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25667 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25668
25669
25670
25671
25672 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25673 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25674 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25675 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25676 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25677 default retry rule:
25678 .code
25679 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25680 .endd
25681 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25682 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25683 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25684
25685 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25686 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25687 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25688 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25689 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25690
25691 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25692 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25693 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25694
25695 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25696 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25697 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25698 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25699 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25700 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25701 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25702 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25703
25704 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25705 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25706 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25707 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25708 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25709 notice.
25710
25711 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25712 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25713 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25714 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25715 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25716 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25717 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25718 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25719 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25720 true.
25721
25722 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25723 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25724 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25725 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25726 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25727 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25728 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25729 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25730 reached.
25731
25732 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25733 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25734 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25735 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25736 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25737 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25738 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25739 time out the address.
25740
25741 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25742 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25743 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25744 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25745 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25746 considered immediately.
25747 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25748 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25749
25750
25751
25752
25753
25754
25755 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25756 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25757
25758 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25759 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25760 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25761 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25762 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25763 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25764 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25765 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25766 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25767 other.
25768
25769 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25770 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25771
25772 .ilist
25773 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25774 the client's EHLO command.
25775 .next
25776 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25777 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25778 .next
25779 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25780 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25781 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25782 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25783 with the AUTH command.
25784 .next
25785 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25786 .next
25787 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25788 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25789 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25790 connection.
25791 .next
25792 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25793 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25794 unauthenticated connection.
25795 .endlist
25796
25797 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25798 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25799 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25800 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25801 .display
25802 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25803 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25804 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25805 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25806 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25807 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25808 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25809 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25810 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25811 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25812 &`250 HELP`&
25813 .endd
25814 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25815 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25816 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25817 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25818 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25819 included by setting
25820 .code
25821 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25822 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25823 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25824 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25825 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25826 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25827 AUTH_SPA=yes
25828 AUTH_TLS=yes
25829 .endd
25830 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25831 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25832 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25833 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25834 work via a socket interface.
25835 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25836 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25837 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25838 supporting setting a server keytab.
25839 The sixth can be configured to support
25840 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25841 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25842 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25843 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25844 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25845
25846 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25847 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25848 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25849 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25850 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25851 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25852 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25853
25854 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25855 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25856 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25857 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25858 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25859 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25860 .code
25861 cram:
25862 driver = cram_md5
25863 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25864 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25865 client_name = ph10
25866 client_secret = secret2
25867 .endd
25868 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25869 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25870
25871 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25872 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25873 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25874 in Exim.
25875
25876 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25877 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25878 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25879 authenticating data.
25880
25881 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25882 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25883 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25884 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25885 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25886 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25887 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25888 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25889 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25890 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25891 choose to honour.
25892
25893 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25894 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25895 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25896 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25897
25898
25899
25900 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25901 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25902 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25903
25904 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25905 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25906 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25907 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25908 encrypted by a setting such as:
25909 .code
25910 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25911 .endd
25912
25913
25914 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25915 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25916 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25917 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25918
25919
25920 .option driver authenticators string unset
25921 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25922 authenticators is to be used.
25923
25924
25925 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25926 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25927 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25928 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25929 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25930 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25931
25932
25933 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25934 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25935 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25936 mechanism is not advertised.
25937 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25938 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25939 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25940
25941
25942 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25943 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25944 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25945 for details.
25946
25947 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25948 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25949
25950 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25951 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25952 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25953 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25954 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25955 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25956 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25957 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25958 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25959 the error text.
25960
25961
25962 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25963 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25964 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25965 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25966 out the values of variables.
25967 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25968 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25969
25970
25971 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25972 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25973 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25974 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25975 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25976 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25977 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25978 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25979 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25980
25981
25982 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25983 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25984 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25985 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25986 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25987 remembered for later use.
25988 How it is used is described in the following section.
25989
25990
25991
25992
25993
25994 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25995 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25996 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25997 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25998 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25999 message:
26000
26001 .ilist
26002 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26003 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26004 .next
26005 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26006 .next
26007 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26008 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26009 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26010 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26011 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26012 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26013 given for the MAIL command.
26014 .next
26015 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26016 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26017 authenticated.
26018 .next
26019 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26020 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26021 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26022 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26023 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26024 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26025 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26026 message.
26027 .endlist
26028
26029
26030 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26031 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26032 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26033 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26034
26035 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26036 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26037 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26038 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26039 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26040 ACL is run.
26041
26042
26043
26044 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26045 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26046 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26047 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26048 conditions:
26049
26050 .ilist
26051 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26052 .next
26053 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26054 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26055 .endlist
26056
26057 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26058 the mechanisms are advertised.
26059
26060 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26061 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26062 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26063 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26064 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26065 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26066 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26067 .code
26068 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26069 .endd
26070 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26071
26072 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26073 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26074 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26075 such as:
26076 .code
26077 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26078 .endd
26079 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26080 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26081 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26082
26083 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26084 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26085 command. This is the case if
26086
26087 .ilist
26088 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26089 .next
26090 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26091 .next
26092 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26093 server authenticators.
26094 .endlist
26095
26096
26097 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26098 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26099 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26100
26101 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26102 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26103 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26104 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26105 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26106 rejected with a 504 error.
26107
26108 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26109 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26110 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26111 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26112 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26113 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26114 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26115 no successful authentication.
26116
26117 .new
26118 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26119 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26120 &$authresults$& expansion item.
26121 .wen
26122
26123
26124
26125
26126 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26127 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26128 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26129 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26130 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26131 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26132 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26133 script:
26134 .code
26135 use MIME::Base64;
26136 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26137 .endd
26138 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26139 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26140 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26141 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26142 command line to run this script on such data might be
26143 .code
26144 encode '\0user\0password'
26145 .endd
26146 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26147 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26148 whose code value is zero.
26149
26150 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26151 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26152 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26153 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26154
26155 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26156 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26157 example, a command such as
26158 .code
26159 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26160 .endd
26161 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26162
26163 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26164 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26165 .code
26166 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26167 .endd
26168 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26169 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26170 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26171 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26172
26173
26174
26175 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26176 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26177 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26178 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26179 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26180 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26181
26182 .ilist
26183 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26184 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26185 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26186 of the authenticator.
26187 .next
26188 .vindex "&$host$&"
26189 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26190 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26191 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26192 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26193 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26194 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26195 delivery to be deferred.
26196 .next
26197 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26198 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26199 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26200 usual way.
26201 .next
26202 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26203 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26204 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26205 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26206 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26207 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26208 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26209 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26210 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26211 .endlist
26212
26213 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26214 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26215 on and the transport running. For example, with a manualroute
26216 router given a host name, and DNS "round-robin" use by that name: if
26217 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26218 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26219 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26220 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26221
26222 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26223
26224 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26225 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26226 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26227 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26228 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26229 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26230 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26231 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26232 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26233 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26234 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26235 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26236 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26237
26238
26239
26240
26241
26242
26243 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26244 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26245
26246 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26247 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26248 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26249 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26250 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26251 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26252 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26253 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26254 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26255 connections as you do for login accounts.
26256
26257 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26258 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26259 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26260
26261 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26262 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26263 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26264
26265 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26266 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26267 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26268 given.
26269
26270 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26271 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26272 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26273 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26274 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26275 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26276 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26277
26278 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26279 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26280 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26281 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26282 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26283 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26284 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26285
26286 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26287 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26288 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26289 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26290
26291 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26292 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26293 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26294
26295 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26296 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26297 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26298 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26299 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26300 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26301 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26302 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26303 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26304 string as the error text
26305
26306 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26307 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26308 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26309
26310
26311
26312 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26313 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26314 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26315 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26316 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26317 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26318 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26319 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26320
26321 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26322 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26323 configured as follows:
26324 .code
26325 fixed_plain:
26326 driver = plaintext
26327 public_name = PLAIN
26328 server_prompts = :
26329 server_condition = \
26330 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26331 server_set_id = $auth2
26332 .endd
26333 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26334 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26335 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26336 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26337
26338 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26339 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26340 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26341 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26342 .code
26343 250-AUTH PLAIN
26344 .endd
26345 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26346 .code
26347 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26348 .endd
26349 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26350 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26351 .code
26352 AUTH PLAIN
26353 .endd
26354 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26355 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26356
26357 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26358 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26359 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26360 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26361 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26362
26363 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26364 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26365 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26366
26367 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26368 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26369 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26370 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26371 This is an incorrect example:
26372 .code
26373 server_condition = \
26374 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26375 .endd
26376 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26377 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26378 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26379 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26380 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26381 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26382 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26383 .code
26384 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26385 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26386 .endd
26387 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26388 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26389 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26390 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26391 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26392
26393
26394 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26395 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26396 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26397 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26398 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26399 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26400 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26401 .code
26402 fixed_login:
26403 driver = plaintext
26404 public_name = LOGIN
26405 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26406 server_condition = \
26407 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26408 server_set_id = $auth1
26409 .endd
26410 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26411 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26412 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26413 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26414
26415 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26416 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26417 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26418 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26419 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26420 .code
26421 login:
26422 driver = plaintext
26423 public_name = LOGIN
26424 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26425 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26426 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
26427 ldapauth{\
26428 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26429 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26430 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26431 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26432 .endd
26433 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26434 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26435 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26436 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26437 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26438 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26439 uninterpreted string.
26440
26441
26442 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26443 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26444 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26445 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26446 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26447 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
26448
26449
26450
26451
26452 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26453 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26454 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26455
26456 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26457 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26458 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26459 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26460 usual.
26461
26462 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26463 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26464 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26465 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26466 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26467 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26468 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26469 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26470 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26471 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26472 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26473 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26474
26475 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26476 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26477
26478 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26479 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26480 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26481 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26482 the string.
26483
26484 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26485 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26486 .code
26487 fixed_plain:
26488 driver = plaintext
26489 public_name = PLAIN
26490 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26491 .endd
26492 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26493 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26494 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26495 .code
26496 fixed_login:
26497 driver = plaintext
26498 public_name = LOGIN
26499 client_send = : username : mysecret
26500 .endd
26501 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26502 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26503 prompts.
26504 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26505 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26506
26507
26508
26509
26510 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26511 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26512
26513 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26514 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26515 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26516 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26517 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26518 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26519 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26520 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26521 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26522 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26523 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26524 available in plain text at either end.
26525
26526
26527 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26528 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26529 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26530 authenticator as a server:
26531
26532 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26533 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26534 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26535 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26536 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26537 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26538 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26539 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26540 returned to the client.
26541
26542 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26543 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26544 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26545 numeric variables for other things.
26546
26547 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26548 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26549 user name, authentication fails.
26550 .code
26551 fixed_cram:
26552 driver = cram_md5
26553 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26554 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26555 server_set_id = $auth1
26556 .endd
26557 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26558 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26559 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26560 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26561 .code
26562 lookup_cram:
26563 driver = cram_md5
26564 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26565 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26566 {$value}fail}
26567 server_set_id = $auth1
26568 .endd
26569 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26570 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26571
26572 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26573 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26574 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26575 realm, with:
26576 .code
26577 cyrusless_crammd5:
26578 driver = cram_md5
26579 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26580 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26581 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26582 server_set_id = $auth1
26583 .endd
26584
26585 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26586 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26587 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26588
26589
26590
26591 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26592 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26593 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26594
26595
26596 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26597 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26598 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26599
26600
26601 .vindex "&$host$&"
26602 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26603 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26604 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26605 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26606 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26607 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26608 send the message to the current server.
26609
26610 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26611 strings, is:
26612 .code
26613 fixed_cram:
26614 driver = cram_md5
26615 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26616 client_name = ph10
26617 client_secret = secret
26618 .endd
26619 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26620 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26621
26622
26623
26624 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26625 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26626
26627 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26628 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26629 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26630 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26631 .cindex "Kerberos"
26632 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26633 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26634
26635 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26636 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26637 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26638 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26639 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26640
26641 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26642 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26643 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26644 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26645
26646 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26647 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26648 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26649 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26650 depending on the driver you are using.
26651
26652 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26653 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26654 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26655 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26656 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26657 implementation.
26658
26659 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26660 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26661 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26662 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26663 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26664 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26665 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26666 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26667
26668
26669 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26670 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26671 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26672 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26673 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26674 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26675 things.
26676
26677
26678 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26679 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26680 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26681 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26682
26683
26684 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26685 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26686 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26687 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26688 example:
26689 .code
26690 sasl:
26691 driver = cyrus_sasl
26692 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26693 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26694 server_set_id = $auth1
26695 .endd
26696
26697 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26698 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26699
26700
26701 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26702 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26703
26704
26705 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26706 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26707 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26708 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26709 .code
26710 sasl_cram_md5:
26711 driver = cyrus_sasl
26712 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26713 server_set_id = $auth1
26714
26715 sasl_plain:
26716 driver = cyrus_sasl
26717 public_name = PLAIN
26718 server_set_id = $auth2
26719 .endd
26720 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26721 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26722 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26723 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26724 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26725
26726
26727
26728
26729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26731 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26732 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26733 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26734 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26735 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26736 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26737 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26738 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26739 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26740
26741 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26742
26743 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26744 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26745 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26746 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26747 .code
26748 dovecot_plain:
26749 driver = dovecot
26750 public_name = PLAIN
26751 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26752 server_set_id = $auth1
26753
26754 dovecot_ntlm:
26755 driver = dovecot
26756 public_name = NTLM
26757 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26758 server_set_id = $auth1
26759 .endd
26760 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26761 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26762 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26763 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26764 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26765 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26766 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26767 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26768
26769
26770 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26772 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26773 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26774 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26775 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26776 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26777 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26778 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26779 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26780 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26781 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26782 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26783 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26784 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26785 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26786 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26787 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26788 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26789 without code changes in Exim.
26790
26791
26792 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26793 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26794 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26795 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26796 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26797 context.
26798
26799 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26800 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26801 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26802
26803 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26804 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26805 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26806
26807 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26808 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26809 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26810
26811
26812 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26813 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26814 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26815 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26816
26817
26818 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26819 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26820 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26821 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26822 example:
26823 .code
26824 sasl:
26825 driver = gsasl
26826 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26827 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26828 server_set_id = $auth1
26829 .endd
26830
26831
26832 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26833 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26834 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26835 the password itself.
26836
26837 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26838 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26839 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26840 if available, else the empty string.
26841 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26842 else the empty string.
26843
26844 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26845
26846 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26847 option to be simply "true".
26848
26849
26850 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26851 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26852 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26853
26854
26855 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26856 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26857 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26858 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26859
26860
26861 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26862 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26863 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26864 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26865
26866
26867 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26868 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26869 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26870
26871
26872 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26873 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26874 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26875 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26876
26877 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26878 meanings for these variables:
26879
26880 .ilist
26881 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26882 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26883 .next
26884 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26885 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26886 .next
26887 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26888 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26889 .endlist
26890
26891 On a per-mechanism basis:
26892
26893 .ilist
26894 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26895 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26896 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26897 .next
26898 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26899 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26900 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26901 .next
26902 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26903 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26904 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26905 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26906 .endlist
26907
26908 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26909 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26910 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26911
26912
26913 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26914 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26915 .code
26916 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26917 driver = gsasl
26918 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26919 server_realm = imap.example.org
26920 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26921 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26922 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26923 server_condition = yes
26924 .endd
26925
26926
26927 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26928 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26929
26930 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26931 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26932 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26933 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26934 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26935 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26936 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26937 reliably.
26938
26939 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26940 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26941 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26942 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26943
26944 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26945 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26946 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26947 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26948
26949 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26950 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26951 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26952 from the keytab.
26953
26954
26955 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26956 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26957 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26958 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26959
26960 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26961 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26962 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26963 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26964
26965 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26966 .ilist
26967 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26968 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26969 .next
26970 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26971 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26972 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26973 GSS Display Name.
26974 .endlist
26975
26976
26977 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26978 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26979
26980 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26981 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26982 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26983 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26984 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26985 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26986 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26987 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26988 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26989 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26990 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26991 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26992 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26993 follows:
26994
26995 .ilist
26996 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26997 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26998 .next
26999 The server sends back a challenge.
27000 .next
27001 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27002 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27003 .endlist
27004
27005 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27006
27007
27008
27009 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27010 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27011 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27012
27013 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27014 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27015 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27016 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27017 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27018 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27019 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27020 for other things. For example:
27021 .code
27022 spa:
27023 driver = spa
27024 public_name = NTLM
27025 server_password = \
27026 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27027 .endd
27028 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27029 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27030
27031
27032
27033
27034
27035 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27036 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27037 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27038
27039
27040
27041 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27042 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27043
27044
27045 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27046 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27047
27048
27049 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27050 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27051 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27052 &'msn.com'&:
27053 .code
27054 msn:
27055 driver = spa
27056 public_name = MSN
27057 client_username = msn/msn_username
27058 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27059 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27060 .endd
27061 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27062 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27063
27064
27065
27066
27067
27068 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27069 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27070
27071 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27072 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27073 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27074 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27075 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27076 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27077 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27078 authentication based on client certificates.
27079
27080 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27081 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27082 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27083 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27084 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27085 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27086
27087 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27088 for which it must have been requested via the
27089 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27090 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27091
27092 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27093 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27094 and can authenticate the connection.
27095 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27096
27097 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27098
27099
27100 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27101 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27102
27103 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27104 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27105 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27106 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27107 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27108 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27109
27110 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27111 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27112 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27113
27114 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27115
27116
27117 Example:
27118 .code
27119 tls:
27120 driver = tls
27121 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27122 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27123 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
27124 {!= {0} \
27125 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27126 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27127 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27128 } } } }
27129 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27130 .endd
27131 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27132 of your configured trust-anchors
27133 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27134 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27135 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27136 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27137
27138 . An alternative might use
27139 . .code
27140 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27141 . .endd
27142 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27143 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27144 . This would help for per-device use.
27145 .
27146 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27147 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27148
27149 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27150 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27151
27152
27153 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27154 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27155 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27156
27157
27158
27159 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27160 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27161
27162 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27163 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27164 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27165 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27166 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27167 .cindex "OpenSSL"
27168 .cindex "GnuTLS"
27169 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27170 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27171 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27172 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27173 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27174 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27175 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27176 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27177 certificates are used.
27178
27179 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27180 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27181 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27182 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27183 between them is encrypted.
27184
27185 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27186 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27187 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27188 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27189 encryption state.
27190
27191 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27192 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27193 in order to get TLS to work.
27194
27195
27196
27197 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27198 "SECID284"
27199 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27200 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27201 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27202 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27203 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27204 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27205 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27206 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27207 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27208 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27209 in preference to STARTTLS.
27210
27211 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27212 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27213 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27214
27215 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27216 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27217 reassigned for other use.
27218 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27219 this port.
27220 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only supported submissions, not
27221 submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27222 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27223
27224 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27225 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27226 the most common use is expected to be:
27227 .code
27228 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27229 .endd
27230 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27231 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27232 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27233 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27234 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27235 defined elsewhere.
27236
27237 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27238 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27239
27240
27241
27242
27243
27244
27245 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27246 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27247 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27248 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27249 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27250 .code
27251 USE_GNUTLS=yes
27252 .endd
27253 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27254 .code
27255 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
27256 .endd
27257 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27258 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27259
27260 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27261
27262 .ilist
27263 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27264 cannot be the path of a directory
27265 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27266 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27267 .next
27268 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27269 .next
27270 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27271 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27272 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27273 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27274 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27275 .next
27276 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27277 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27278 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27279 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27280 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27281 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27282 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27283 option).
27284 .next
27285 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27286 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27287 .next
27288 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27289 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27290 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27291 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27292 .next
27293 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27294 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27295 .next
27296 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27297 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27298 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27299 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27300 .endlist
27301
27302
27303 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27304 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27305 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27306 but not the chosen filename.
27307 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27308 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27309
27310 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27311 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27312 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27313 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27314 of bits requested.
27315 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27316 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27317 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27318 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27319 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27320 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27321 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27322
27323 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27324 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27325 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27326 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27327 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27328
27329 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27330 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27331 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27332 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27333 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27334 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27335
27336 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27337 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27338 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27339
27340 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27341 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27342 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27343 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27344 .code
27345 # ls
27346 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27347 # rm -f new-params
27348 # touch new-params
27349 # chown exim:exim new-params
27350 # chmod 0600 new-params
27351 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27352 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27353 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27354 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27355 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27356 # chmod 0400 new-params
27357 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27358 .endd
27359 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27360 stalling is removed.
27361
27362 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27363 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27364 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27365 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27366 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27367 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27368 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27369 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27370 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27371 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27372 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27373
27374 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27375 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27376 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27377 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27378
27379 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27380 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27381 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27382 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27383 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27384
27385
27386 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27387 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27388 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27389 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27390 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27391 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27392 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27393 directly to this function call.
27394 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27395 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27396 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27397 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27398
27399 .ilist
27400 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27401 .next
27402 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27403 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27404 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27405 SSL v3 algorithms.
27406 .next
27407 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27408 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27409 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27410 algorithms.
27411 .endlist
27412
27413 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27414 &`-`& or &`+`&.
27415 .ilist
27416 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27417 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27418 stated.
27419 .next
27420 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27421 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27422 .next
27423 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27424 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27425 .endlist
27426
27427 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27428 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27429 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27430 not be moved to the end of the list.
27431 .endlist
27432
27433 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27434 string:
27435 .code
27436 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27437 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27438 .endd
27439
27440 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27441 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27442 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27443 choice of clients used:
27444 .code
27445 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27446 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27447 {DEFAULT}\
27448 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
27449 .endd
27450
27451 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27452 .code
27453 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
27454 .endd
27455
27456
27457 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27458 "SECTreqciphgnu"
27459 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27460 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27461 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27462 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27463 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27464 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27465 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27466 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27467 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27468 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27469
27470 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27471 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27472
27473 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27474 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27475 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27476 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27477 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27478 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27479
27480 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27481 "Priority strings". This is online as
27482 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27483 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27484 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27485 then the example code
27486 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27487 on that site can be used to test a given string.
27488
27489 For example:
27490 .code
27491 # Disable older versions of protocols
27492 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27493 .endd
27494
27495 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27496 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27497 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27498
27499 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27500 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27501 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27502 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27503 used:
27504 .code
27505 # GnuTLS variant
27506 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27507 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
27508 {SECURE128}}
27509 .endd
27510
27511
27512 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27513 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27514 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27515 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27516 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27517 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27518 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27519
27520 If STARTTLS is to be used you
27521 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27522
27523 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27524 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27525 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27526 with the error
27527 .code
27528 554 Security failure
27529 .endd
27530 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27531 rejected with a 554 error code.
27532
27533 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27534 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27535
27536 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27537 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27538 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27539 from someone able to intercept the communication.
27540
27541 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27542
27543 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
27544 .code
27545 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27546 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27547 .endd
27548 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27549 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27550 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27551 that goes with it. These files need to be
27552 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27553 always be given as full path names.
27554 The key must not be password-protected.
27555 They can be the same file if both the
27556 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27557 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27558 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27559 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27560 the server's certificate.
27561
27562 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
27563 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
27564 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
27565 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
27566 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
27567 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
27568
27569 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27570 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27571 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27572
27573 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27574 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27575 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27576 transport.
27577
27578 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27579 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27580 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27581 .code
27582 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27583 .endd
27584 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27585 with the parameters contained in the file.
27586 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27587 available:
27588 .code
27589 tls_dhparam = none
27590 .endd
27591 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27592 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27593 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27594 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27595
27596 See the command
27597 .code
27598 openssl dhparam
27599 .endd
27600 for a way of generating file data.
27601
27602 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27603 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27604 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27605 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27606 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27607
27608 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27609 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27610 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27611 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27612 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27613 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27614 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27615 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27616 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27617
27618 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27619 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27620 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27621 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27622 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27623 documentation for more details.
27624
27625 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27626 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27627
27628
27629 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27630 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27631 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27632 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27633 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27634 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27635 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27636 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27637 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27638 expected certificates.
27639 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27640 an explicit file or,
27641 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27642 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27643
27644 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27645 directory is used
27646 (OpenSSL only),
27647 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27648 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27649 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27650 .code
27651 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27652 .endd
27653 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27654
27655 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27656 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27657 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27658 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27659 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27660 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27661 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27662 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27663 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27664 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27665
27666 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27667 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27668 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27669 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27670
27671 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27672 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27673 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27674 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27675 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27676 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27677
27678
27679 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27680 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27681 .cindex "revocation list"
27682 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27683 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27684 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27685 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27686 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27687 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27688 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27689 CRL in PEM format.
27690 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27691 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27692
27693 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27694 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27695 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27696 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27697 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27698 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27699
27700 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27701 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27702 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27703 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27704
27705 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27706 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27707 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27708 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27709 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27710 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27711 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27712 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27713
27714 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27715 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27716 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27717
27718 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27719 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27720 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27721 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27722 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27723
27724 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27725 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27726 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27727 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27728 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27729 next connection.
27730
27731 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27732 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27733 ignored.
27734
27735 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27736 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27737 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27738 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27739 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27740 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27741
27742 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27743 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27744
27745 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27746
27747 .code
27748 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27749 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27750 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27751
27752 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27753 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27754 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27755 .endd
27756
27757
27758
27759
27760 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27761 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27762 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27763 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27764 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27765 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27766 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27767 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27768 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27769
27770 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27771 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27772 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27773 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27774 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27775
27776 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27777 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27778 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27779 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27780 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27781 usual way.
27782
27783 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27784 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27785 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27786 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27787 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27788 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27789 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27790 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27791 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27792 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27793 unencrypted.
27794
27795 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27796 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27797 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27798 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27799
27800 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27801 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27802 These may be
27803 the system default set (depending on library version),
27804 a file,
27805 or (depending on library version) a directory.
27806 The client verifies the server's certificate
27807 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27808 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27809 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27810 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27811
27812 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27813 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27814 or need not succeed respectively.
27815
27816 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27817 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27818 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27819 value is empty.
27820 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27821 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27822 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27823 otherwise.
27824
27825 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27826 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27827 for OCSP to be relevant.
27828
27829 If
27830 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27831 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27832 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27833 alternative hosts, if any.
27834
27835 &*Note*&:
27836 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27837 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27838 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27839 client.
27840
27841 .vindex "&$host$&"
27842 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27843 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27844 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27845 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27846 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27847
27848 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27849 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27850 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27851 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27852 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27853 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27854 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27855 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27856 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27857 outgoing connection.
27858
27859
27860
27861 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27862 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27863 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27864 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27865 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27866 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27867 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27868 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27869 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27870 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27871 for this session.
27872
27873 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27874 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27875 address.
27876
27877 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27878 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27879 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27880 be of limited use in that environment.
27881
27882 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27883 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27884 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27885 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27886 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27887
27888 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27889 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27890 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27891 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27892 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27893
27894 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27895 received from a client.
27896 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27897
27898 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27899 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27900 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27901
27902 .ilist
27903 &%tls_certificate%&
27904 .next
27905 &%tls_crl%&
27906 .next
27907 &%tls_privatekey%&
27908 .next
27909 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27910 .next
27911 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27912 .endlist
27913
27914 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27915 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27916 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
27917 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27918 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
27919 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
27920 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
27921
27922 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27923 are re-expanded.
27924
27925 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27926 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27927 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27928 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27929
27930 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27931 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27932 built, then you have SNI support).
27933
27934
27935
27936 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27937 "SECTmulmessam"
27938 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27939 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27940 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27941 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27942 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27943 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27944 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27945 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
27946 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
27947 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
27948
27949 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
27950 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
27951 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
27952 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
27953 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27954 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27955 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27956
27957 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27958 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27959 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27960 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27961 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27962 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27963 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27964 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27965 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27966
27967 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27968 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27969 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27970 information is recorded.
27971
27972 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27973 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27974 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27975
27976
27977
27978
27979 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27980 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27981 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27982 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27983 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27984 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27985 to Apache, currently at
27986 .display
27987 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27988 .endd
27989 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27990 links to further files.
27991 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27992 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27993 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27994 .display
27995 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27996 .endd
27997
27998
27999 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28000 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28001 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28002 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28003 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28004 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28005 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28006 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28007 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28008 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28009 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28010 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28011 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28012
28013 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28014 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28015 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28016 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28017
28018
28019
28020 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28021 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28022 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28023 with OpenSSL, like this:
28024 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28025 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28026 .code
28027 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28028 -days 9999 -nodes
28029 .endd
28030 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28031 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28032 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28033 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28034 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28035 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28036 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28037
28038 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28039 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28040 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28041 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28042 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28043 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28044 . ==== -pdp, 2012
28045 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28046 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28047 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28048 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28049 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28050 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28051 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28052 be a sensible resolution).
28053
28054 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28055 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28056 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28057
28058 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28059 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28060 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28061 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28062 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28063 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28064
28065 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28066 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28067 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28068 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
28069 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28070 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28071
28072
28073
28074 .new
28075 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28076 .cindex DANE
28077 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28078 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28079 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28080 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28081 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28082 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28083
28084 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28085 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28086 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28087
28088 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28089 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28090
28091 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28092 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28093 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28094
28095 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28096 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28097 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28098 DNSSEC.
28099 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28100 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is traceable to the one
28101 defined by (one of?) the TSLA records
28102
28103 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28104 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28105 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28106 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28107
28108 The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3). The latter specifies
28109 the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server (and should be the sole one transmitted
28110 during the TLS handshake); this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28111 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28112 well-known one. A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate which is used to sign
28113 cerver certificates, but running one securely does require careful arrangement. If a private CA is used
28114 then either all clients must be primed with it, or (probably simpler) the server TLS handshake must transmit
28115 the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate. If a public CA is used then all clients must be primed with it
28116 (losing one advantage of DANE) - but the attack surface is reduced from all public CAs to that single CA.
28117 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28118 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28119
28120 The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28121
28122 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28123 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28124
28125 .code
28126 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28127 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28128 | openssl sha512 \
28129 | awk '{print $2}'
28130 .endd
28131
28132 are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28133
28134 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28135
28136 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28137 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28138 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28139
28140 .code
28141 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28142 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28143 {*}{}}
28144 .endd
28145
28146 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28147 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28148 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28149 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28150 control the OCSP request.
28151
28152 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28153 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28154
28155
28156 For client-side DANE there are two new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%& and &%hosts_require_dane%&.
28157 The latter variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28158
28159 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28160
28161 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28162 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28163 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28164 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28165
28166 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28167 .code
28168 hosts_require_tls
28169 tls_verify_hosts
28170 tls_try_verify_hosts
28171 tls_verify_certificates
28172 tls_crl
28173 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28174 .endd
28175
28176 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28177 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28178
28179 Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28180
28181 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28182
28183 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28184 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28185 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28186 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28187
28188 .cindex DANE reporting
28189 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28190 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28191 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28192 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28193 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28194 Section 4.3 of that document.
28195
28196 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28197 .wen
28198
28199
28200
28201 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28202 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28203
28204 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28205 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28206 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
28207 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28208 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28209 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
28210 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28211 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28212 one very small ACL:
28213 .code
28214 begin acl
28215 small_acl:
28216 accept hosts = one.host.only
28217 .endd
28218 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28219 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28220
28221 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28222 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28223 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28224 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28225 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28226 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28227 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28228 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28229
28230
28231 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28232 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28233 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28234
28235
28236 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28237 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28238 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28239 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28240 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28241 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28242 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28243 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28244 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28245 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28246 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28247 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28248 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28249 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28250 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28251 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28252 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28253 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28254 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28255 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28256
28257 .table2 140pt
28258 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28259 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28260 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28261 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28262 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28263 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28264 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28265 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28266 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28267 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28268 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28269 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28270 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28271 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28272 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28273 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28274 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28275 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28276 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28277 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28278 .endtable
28279
28280 For example, if you set
28281 .code
28282 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28283 .endd
28284 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28285 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28286 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28287 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28288 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28289 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28290 testing as possible at RCPT time.
28291
28292
28293 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28294 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28295 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28296 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28297 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28298 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28299 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28300 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28301 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28302 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28303 in any of these ACLs.
28304
28305 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28306 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28307 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28308 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28309 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28310 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28311 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28312 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28313 .code
28314 control = suppress_local_fixups
28315 .endd
28316 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28317 run, it is too late.
28318
28319 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28320 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28321
28322 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28323 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28324 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28325
28326
28327 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28328 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28329 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28330 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28331 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28332 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28333 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28334 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28335 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28336
28337
28338 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28339 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28340 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28341 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28342 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28343 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28344 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28345 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28346 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28347
28348 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28349 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28350 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28351
28352 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28353 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28354 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28355 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28356 an EHLO response.
28357
28358
28359 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28360 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28361 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28362 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28363 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28364 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28365 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28366 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28367 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28368 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28369
28370 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28371 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28372 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28373 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28374 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28375 associated with the DATA command.
28376
28377 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28378 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28379 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28380 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28381 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28382 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28383 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28384 the data specified is received.
28385
28386 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28387 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28388 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28389 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28390 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28391 your resources.
28392
28393 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28394 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28395 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28396 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28397
28398 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28399 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28400 enabled (which is the default).
28401
28402 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28403 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28404 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28405
28406 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28407
28408 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
28409
28410
28411 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28412 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28413 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28414
28415 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28416
28417
28418 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28419 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28420 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28421 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28422 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28423 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28424 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28425 has been accepted.
28426
28427 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28428 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28429 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28430 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28431 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28432 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28433 for some or all recipients.
28434
28435 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28436 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28437 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28438 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28439 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28440 is &"yes"&.
28441 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28442 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28443 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28444
28445 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28446 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28447
28448 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28449 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28450 the feature was not requested by the client.
28451
28452 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28453 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28454 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28455 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28456 does not in fact control any access.
28457 For this reason, it may only accept
28458 or warn as its final result.
28459
28460 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28461 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28462 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28463 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28464
28465 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28466 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28467
28468 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28469 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28470 response to QUIT.
28471
28472 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28473 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28474 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28475 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28476 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28477
28478
28479 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28480 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28481 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28482 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28483 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28484 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28485 situation even worse.
28486
28487 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28488 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28489 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28490 and &%warn%&.
28491
28492 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28493 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28494 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28495 connection. The possible values are:
28496 .table2
28497 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28498 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28499 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28500 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28501 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28502 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28503 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28504 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28505 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28506 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28507 .endtable
28508 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28509 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28510 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28511 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28512 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28513 used.
28514
28515
28516 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28517 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28518 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28519 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28520 .code
28521 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28522 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28523 .endd
28524 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28525 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
28526 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28527 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28528 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28529
28530 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28531 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28532 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28533
28534 .ilist
28535 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28536 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28537 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28538 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28539 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28540 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28541 .code
28542 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28543 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28544 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28545 .endd
28546 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28547 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28548 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28549 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28550 .next
28551 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28552 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28553 matches the string.
28554 .next
28555 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28556 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28557 want to have something like
28558 .code
28559 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28560 .endd
28561 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28562 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28563 .endlist
28564
28565
28566
28567
28568 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28569 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28570 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28571 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28572 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28573 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28574 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28575 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28576 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28577
28578 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28579 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28580 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28581
28582
28583 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28584 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28585 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28586 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28587
28588 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28589 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28590 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28591 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28592 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28593 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28594 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28595
28596 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28597 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28598
28599
28600 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28601 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28602 recipients; it may create new recipients.
28603
28604
28605
28606 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28607 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28608 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28609 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28610 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28611 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28612
28613 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28614 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28615 used to accept or reject anything.
28616
28617 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28618 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28619 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28620 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28621
28622 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28623 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28624 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28625 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28626 configuration file.
28627
28628
28629
28630
28631 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28632 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28633 .vindex &$domain$&
28634 .vindex &$local_part$&
28635 .vindex &$sender_address$&
28636 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28637 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28638 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28639 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28640 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28641 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28642 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28643 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28644
28645 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28646 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28647 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28648 how it is used.
28649
28650 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
28651 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28652 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28653 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28654 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28655 received).
28656
28657 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28658 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28659 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28660 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28661 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28662 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28663 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28664 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28665
28666
28667
28668
28669
28670 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28671 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28672 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28673 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28674 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28675 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28676 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28677 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28678 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28679 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28680 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28681 unencrypted connections.
28682 .code
28683 acl_check_auth:
28684 accept encrypted = *
28685 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28686 {CRAM-MD5}}
28687 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28688 .endd
28689 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28690 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28691 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28692 option to do this.)
28693
28694
28695
28696 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28697 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28698 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28699 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28700 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28701 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28702 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28703
28704 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28705 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28706 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28707 example:
28708 .code
28709 deny dnslists = list1.example
28710 dnslists = list2.example
28711 .endd
28712 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28713 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28714 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28715 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28716 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28717
28718
28719 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28720 The ACL verbs are as follows:
28721
28722 .ilist
28723 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28724 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28725 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28726 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28727 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28728 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28729 check a RCPT command:
28730 .code
28731 accept domains = +local_domains
28732 endpass
28733 verify = recipient
28734 .endd
28735 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28736 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28737 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28738 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28739 &%endpass%&.
28740
28741 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28742 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28743 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28744 configuration.
28745
28746 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28747 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28748 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28749 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28750 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28751 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28752 .display
28753 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28754 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28755 .endd
28756 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28757 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28758 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28759
28760 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28761 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28762 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28763 of &%endpass%&.
28764
28765
28766 .next
28767 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28768 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28769 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28770 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28771 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28772 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28773 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28774
28775
28776 .next
28777 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28778 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28779 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28780 example,
28781 .code
28782 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28783 .endd
28784 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28785
28786
28787 .next
28788 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28789 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28790 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28791 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28792 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28793 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28794 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28795 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28796 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28797
28798 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28799 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28800 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28801
28802
28803 .next
28804 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28805 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28806 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28807 .code
28808 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28809 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28810 .endd
28811 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28812 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28813
28814 .next
28815 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28816 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28817 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28818 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28819 .code
28820 require message = Sender did not verify
28821 verify = sender
28822 .endd
28823 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28824 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28825 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28826 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28827
28828 .next
28829 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28830 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28831 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28832 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28833 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28834 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28835 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28836
28837 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28838 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28839 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28840 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28841 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28842
28843 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28844 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28845 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28846 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28847 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28848 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28849 onwards.
28850
28851
28852 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28853 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28854 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28855 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28856 .code
28857 warn !verify = sender
28858 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28859 .endd
28860 .endlist
28861
28862 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28863
28864 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28865 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28866 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28867 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28868 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28869
28870
28871
28872 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28873 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28874 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28875 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28876 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28877 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28878 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28879 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28880 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28881 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28882 .ilist
28883 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28884 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28885 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28886 on the same SMTP connection.
28887 .next
28888 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28889 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28890 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28891 .endlist
28892
28893 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28894 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28895 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28896 .code
28897 accept hosts = whatever
28898 set acl_m4 = some value
28899 accept authenticated = *
28900 set acl_c_auth = yes
28901 .endd
28902 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28903 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28904 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28905
28906 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28907 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28908 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28909 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28910 error is generated.
28911
28912 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28913 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28914
28915
28916 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28917 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28918 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28919 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28920 .code
28921 deny domains = *.dom.example
28922 !verify = recipient
28923 .endd
28924 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28925 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28926 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28927 two statements are equivalent:
28928 .code
28929 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28930 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28931 .endd
28932 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28933 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28934
28935 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28936 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28937 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28938 .code
28939 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28940 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28941 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28942 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28943 .endd
28944 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28945 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28946 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28947 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28948 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28949 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28950 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28951
28952 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28953 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28954 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28955 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28956 message is handled.
28957
28958 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28959 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28960 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28961 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28962 .code
28963 require message = Can't verify sender
28964 verify = sender
28965 message = Can't verify recipient
28966 verify = recipient
28967 message = This message cannot be used
28968 .endd
28969 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28970 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28971 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28972 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28973 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28974 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28975
28976 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28977 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28978 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28979 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28980 .code
28981 deny hosts = ...
28982 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28983 message = Invalid sender from client host
28984 .endd
28985 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28986 by which time Exim has set up the message.
28987
28988
28989
28990 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28991 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28992 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28993
28994 .vlist
28995 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28996 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28997 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28998 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28999
29000 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29001 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29002 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29003 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29004 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29005 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29006 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29007 write rather ugly lines like this:
29008 .display
29009 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29010 .endd
29011 Instead, all you need is
29012 .display
29013 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29014 .endd
29015
29016 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29017 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29018 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29019 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29020 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29021 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29022 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29023 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29024
29025 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29026 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29027 in several different ways. For example:
29028
29029 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29030 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29031 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29032 . ==== way.
29033
29034 .ilist
29035 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29036 .code
29037 accept ...some conditions
29038 control = queue_only
29039 .endd
29040 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29041 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29042
29043 .next
29044 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29045 .code
29046 accept ...some conditions...
29047 control = queue_only
29048 ...some more conditions...
29049 .endd
29050 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29051 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29052 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29053 to be relevant.
29054
29055 .next
29056 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29057 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29058 example:
29059 .code
29060 warn ...some conditions...
29061 control = freeze
29062 accept ...
29063 .endd
29064 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29065 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29066 log entry.
29067
29068 .next
29069 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29070 &%require%& verb. For example:
29071 .code
29072 require control = no_multiline_responses
29073 .endd
29074 .endlist
29075
29076 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29077 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29078 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
29079 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29080 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29081 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29082 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29083 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29084 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29085
29086 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29087 example:
29088 .code
29089 deny ...some conditions...
29090 delay = 30s
29091 .endd
29092 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29093 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29094 .code
29095 deny delay = 30s
29096 ...some conditions...
29097 .endd
29098 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29099 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29100 .code
29101 warn ...some conditions...
29102 delay = 2m
29103 control = freeze
29104 accept ...
29105 .endd
29106
29107 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29108 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29109 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29110 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29111 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29112 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29113 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29114
29115
29116 .vitem &*endpass*&
29117 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29118 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29119 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29120 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29121 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29122 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29123 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29124
29125
29126 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29127 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29128 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29129 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29130 .code
29131 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29132 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29133 .endd
29134 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29135 example:
29136 .display
29137 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29138 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29139 .endd
29140 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29141 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29142 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29143 message.
29144
29145 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29146 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29147 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29148 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29149 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29150 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29151 ignored.
29152
29153 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29154 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29155 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29156 error message.
29157
29158 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29159 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29160 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29161 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29162 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29163 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29164
29165 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29166 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29167 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29168 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29169 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29170 logging rejections.
29171
29172
29173 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29174 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29175 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29176 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29177 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29178 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29179 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29180 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29181 .display
29182 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29183 &` log_reject_target =`&
29184 .endd
29185 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29186 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29187 current ACL.
29188
29189
29190 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29191 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29192 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29193 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29194 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29195 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29196 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29197 ACLs. For example:
29198 .display
29199 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29200 &` control = freeze`&
29201 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29202 .endd
29203 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29204 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29205 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29206 example:
29207 .code
29208 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29209 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29210 .endd
29211
29212
29213 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29214 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29215 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29216 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29217 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29218 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29219 &%accept%& for details.)
29220
29221 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29222 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29223 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29224 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29225 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29226 .code
29227 require message = Host not recognized
29228 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
29229 .endd
29230 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29231 processed.)
29232
29233 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29234 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29235 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29236 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29237 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29238 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29239 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29240 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29241 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29242 EHLO options.
29243
29244 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29245 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29246 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29247 .code
29248 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29249 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29250 .endd
29251 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29252 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29253 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
29254 2&'xx'&.
29255
29256 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29257 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29258
29259 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29260 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29261 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29262 response.
29263
29264 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29265 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29266 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29267
29268 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29269 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29270 However, the original message is available in the variable
29271 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29272 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29273 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29274 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29275
29276 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29277 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29278 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29279 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29280 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29281 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29282 effect.
29283
29284
29285 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29286 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29287 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29288 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29289 for the message.
29290 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29291 the DATA ACL).
29292 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29293 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29294 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29295 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29296
29297
29298 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29299 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29300 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29301 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29302
29303
29304 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29305 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29306 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29307 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29308
29309
29310 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29311 .cindex "UDP communications"
29312 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29313 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29314 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29315 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29316 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29317 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29318 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29319 when:
29320 .code
29321 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29322 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29323 .endd
29324 .endlist
29325
29326
29327
29328
29329 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29330 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29331 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29332
29333 .vlist
29334 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29335 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29336 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29337 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29338 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29339 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29340 not work without it. For example:
29341 .code
29342 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29343 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29344 .endd
29345 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29346 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29347 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29348 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29349 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29350
29351
29352 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29353 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29354 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29355 .cindex "case of local parts"
29356 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29357 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29358 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29359 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29360 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29361 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29362 is encountered.
29363
29364 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29365 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29366 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29367 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29368 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29369
29370 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29371 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29372 spam score:
29373 .code
29374 warn control = caseful_local_part
29375 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29376 $acl_m4 + \
29377 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29378 }
29379 control = caselower_local_part
29380 .endd
29381 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29382 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29383
29384
29385 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29386 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29387 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29388 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29389
29390 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29391 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29392 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29393 is used for all recipients of the message,
29394 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29395 and data is copied from one to the other.
29396
29397 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29398 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29399 If a recipient-verify callout
29400 (with use_sender)
29401 connection is subsequently
29402 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29403 any subsequent recipients and the data,
29404 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29405
29406 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29407 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29408 Note also that headers cannot be
29409 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29410 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29411 The Received-By: header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29412 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29413 this will affect the timestamp.
29414
29415 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29416 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29417 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29418 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29419 message body.
29420
29421 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29422 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29423 before the entire message has been received from the source.
29424 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29425 or CHUNKING
29426 options in use.
29427
29428 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29429 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29430 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29431 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29432 before the acceptance "<=" line.
29433
29434 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29435 usual fashion.
29436 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29437 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29438 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29439 and does not queue the message.
29440 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29441
29442 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29443 (possibly faked)
29444 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29445
29446
29447 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29448 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29449 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29450 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29451 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29452 by default called &'debuglog'&.
29453 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29454 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29455 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29456 option.
29457 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29458 with the &'kill'& option.
29459 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29460 contexts):
29461 .code
29462 control = debug
29463 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29464 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29465 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29466 control = debug/kill
29467 .endd
29468
29469
29470 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29471 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29472 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29473 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29474 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29475
29476
29477 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29478 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29479 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29480 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29481 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29482 strings or to numeric value.
29483 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29484 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29485 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29486
29487 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29488 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29489 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29490 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29491 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29492
29493
29494 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29495 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29496 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29497 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29498 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29499 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29500 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29501 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29502
29503 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29504 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29505 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29506 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29507 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29508 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29509 work with.
29510
29511
29512 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29513 .cindex "fake defer"
29514 .cindex "defer, fake"
29515 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29516 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29517 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29518 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29519 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29520
29521 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29522 .cindex "fake rejection"
29523 .cindex "rejection, fake"
29524 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29525 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29526 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29527 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29528 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29529 the same SMTP connection.
29530
29531 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29532 message is supplied, the following is used:
29533 .code
29534 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29535 550-kept for evaluation.
29536 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29537 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29538 .endd
29539 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29540
29541 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29542 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29543 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29544 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29545 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29546 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29547 SMTP connection.
29548
29549 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29550 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29551 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29552 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29553
29554 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29555 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29556 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29557 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29558 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29559 disables such output flushing.
29560
29561 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29562 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29563 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29564 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29565 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29566 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29567
29568 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29569 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29570 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29571 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29572 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29573 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29574 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29575 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29576 to be useful in production.
29577
29578 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29579 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29580 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29581 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29582 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29583
29584 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29585 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29586 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29587 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29588 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29589 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29590
29591 .ilist
29592 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29593 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29594 verification failed"&) is sent.
29595 .next
29596 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29597 line is output.
29598 .endlist
29599
29600 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29601 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29602
29603 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29604 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29605 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29606 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29607 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29608 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29609 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29610
29611 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29612 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29613 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29614 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29615 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29616 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29617 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29618 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29619 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29620 same SMTP connection.
29621
29622 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29623 .cindex "message" "submission"
29624 .cindex "submission mode"
29625 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29626 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29627 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29628 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29629 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29630 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29631 late (the message has already been created).
29632
29633 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29634 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29635 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29636 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29637 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29638
29639 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29640 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29641 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29642 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29643 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29644
29645 .ilist
29646 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29647 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29648 .next
29649 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29650 .next
29651 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29652 .endlist ilist
29653
29654 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29655 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29656 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29657 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29658 data is read.
29659
29660 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29661 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29662
29663 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29664 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29665 to a-label form.
29666 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29667 .endlist vlist
29668
29669
29670 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29671 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29672
29673 .ilist
29674 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29675 .next
29676 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29677 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29678 .next
29679 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29680 .next
29681 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29682 .endlist
29683
29684
29685
29686 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29687 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29688 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29689 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29690 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29691 to an incoming message, as in this example:
29692 .code
29693 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29694 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29695 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29696 .endd
29697 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29698 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29699 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29700 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29701 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29702 RCPT ACL).
29703
29704 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29705 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29706
29707 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29708 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29709 contains one or more newlines that
29710 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29711 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29712 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29713
29714 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29715 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29716 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29717 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29718 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29719 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29720 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29721 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29722 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29723 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29724 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29725
29726 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29727 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29728 of message headers
29729 until they are added to the
29730 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29731 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29732 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29733 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29734 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29735 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29736 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29737
29738 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29739
29740 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29741 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29742 .display
29743 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29744 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29745
29746 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29747 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29748 .endd
29749 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29750 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29751 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29752 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29753 honoured.
29754
29755 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29756 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29757 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29758 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29759 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29760 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29761 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29762 specifications.
29763
29764 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29765 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29766 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29767 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29768 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29769
29770 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29771 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29772 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29773 to be a header name first.) For example:
29774 .code
29775 warn add_header = \
29776 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29777 .endd
29778 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29779 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29780 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29781 up in reverse order.
29782
29783 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29784 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29785 system filter or in a router or transport.
29786
29787
29788
29789 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29790 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29791 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29792 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29793 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29794 from an incoming message, as in this example:
29795 .code
29796 warn message = Remove internal headers
29797 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29798 .endd
29799 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29800 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29801 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29802 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29803 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29804 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29805
29806 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
29807 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29808
29809 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29810 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29811 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29812 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29813 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29814 .code
29815 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29816 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29817 warn message = Remove internal headers
29818 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29819 .endd
29820 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29821 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29822 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29823 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29824 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29825 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29826 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29827 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29828 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29829 would have been removed.
29830
29831 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29832 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29833 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29834 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29835 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29836 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29837 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29838 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29839 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29840
29841 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29842 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29843 .display
29844 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29845 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29846
29847 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29848 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29849 .endd
29850 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29851 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29852 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29853 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29854 are honoured.
29855
29856 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29857 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29858 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29859
29860
29861
29862
29863 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29864 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29865 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29866 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29867 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29868 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29869
29870 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29871 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29872 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29873 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29874 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29875 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29876 The conditions are as follows:
29877
29878
29879 .vlist
29880 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29881 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29882 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29883 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29884 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29885 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29886 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29887 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29888 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29889 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29890 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29891 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29892
29893 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29894 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29895 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29896 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29897 The name and values are expanded separately.
29898 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29899 will act as argument separators.
29900
29901 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29902 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29903 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29904 conditions are tested.
29905
29906 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29907 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29908 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29909 for different local users or different local domains.
29910
29911 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29912 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29913 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29914 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29915 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29916 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29917 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29918 .code
29919 authenticated = *
29920 .endd
29921
29922 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29923 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29924 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29925 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29926 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29927 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29928 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29929 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29930 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29931 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29932 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29933 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29934 negative.
29935
29936 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29937 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29938 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29939 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29940 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29941 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29942 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29943 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29944
29945 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29946 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29947 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29948 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29949 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29950 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29951 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29952 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29953 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29954 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29955
29956 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29957 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29958 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29959 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29960 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29961 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29962 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29963 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29964 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29965 &%domains%& test.
29966
29967 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29968 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
29969
29970
29971 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29972 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
29973 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
29974 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
29975 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
29976 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
29977 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
29978 .code
29979 encrypted = *
29980 .endd
29981
29982
29983 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
29984 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
29985 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
29986 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
29987 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
29988 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
29989 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
29990 .code
29991 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29992 .endd
29993 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29994 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
29995 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
29996
29997 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
29998 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
29999 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30000 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30001 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30002 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30003
30004 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30005 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30006 .code
30007 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30008 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30009 .endd
30010 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30011 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30012 statement can then check the IP address.
30013
30014 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30015 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30016 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30017 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30018 .code
30019 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30020 message = $host_data
30021 .endd
30022 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30023
30024 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30025 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30026 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30027 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30028 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30029 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30030 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30031 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30032 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30033 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30034
30035 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30036 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30037 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30038 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30039 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30040 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30041 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30042
30043 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30044 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30045 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30046 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30047 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30048 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30049 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30050 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30051
30052 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30053 .cindex "rate limiting"
30054 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30055 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30056
30057 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30058 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30059 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30060 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30061 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30062 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30063
30064 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30065 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30066 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30067 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30068 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30069 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30070 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30071
30072 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30073 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30074 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30075 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30076 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30077 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30078 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30079 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30080 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30081 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30082 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30083 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30084 influence the sender checking.
30085
30086 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30087 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30088
30089 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30090 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30091 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30092 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30093 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30094 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30095 .code
30096 senders = :
30097 .endd
30098 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30099 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30100
30101 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30102 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30103 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30104 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30105 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30106 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30107
30108 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30109 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30110 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30111 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30112 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30113 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30114 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30115 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30116 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30117 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30118
30119 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30120 .cindex "CSA verification"
30121 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30122 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30123 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30124
30125 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30126 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30127 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30128 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30129 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30130 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30131 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30132 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30133 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30134 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30135
30136 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30137 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30138 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30139
30140 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30141 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30142 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30143 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30144 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30145 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30146 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30147 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30148 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30149 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30150 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30151 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30152 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30153 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30154 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30155
30156 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30157 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30158 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30159 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30160 .code
30161 deny senders = :
30162 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30163 !verify = header_sender
30164 .endd
30165
30166 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30167 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30168 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30169 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30170 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30171 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30172 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30173 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30174 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30175 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30176 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30177 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30178 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30179 appropriate.
30180
30181 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30182 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30183 .code
30184 To: @
30185 .endd
30186 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30187 common as they used to be.
30188
30189 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30190 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30191 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30192 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30193 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30194 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30195 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30196 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30197 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30198 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30199 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30200 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30201 independently of this condition.
30202
30203 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30204 option), this condition is always true.
30205
30206
30207 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
30208 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30209 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30210 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30211 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30212 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30213 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30214 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30215 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30216
30217 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30218 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30219
30220
30221 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30222 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30223 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30224 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30225 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30226 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30227 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30228 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30229 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30230 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30231 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30232 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30233 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30234 value for the child address.
30235
30236 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30237 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30238 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30239 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30240 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30241 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30242 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30243 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30244 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30245 original IP address.
30246
30247 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30248 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30249
30250 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30251 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30252
30253 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30254 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30255 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30256 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
30257 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
30258 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30259 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30260 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30261 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30262
30263 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30264 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30265 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30266 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30267 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30268 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30269 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30270
30271 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30272 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30273 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30274
30275 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30276 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30277 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30278 verified as a sender.
30279
30280 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30281 (eg. is generated from the received message)
30282 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30283 .code
30284 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30285 .endd
30286 .endlist
30287
30288
30289
30290 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30291 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30292 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30293 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30294 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30295 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30296 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30297 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30298 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30299 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30300 .code
30301 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30302 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30303 .endd
30304 the following records are looked up:
30305 .code
30306 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30307 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30308 .endd
30309 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30310 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30311 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30312 use two separate conditions:
30313 .code
30314 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30315 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30316 .endd
30317 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30318 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30319 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30320 processed.
30321
30322 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30323 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30324 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30325 following special items in the list:
30326 .display
30327 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30328 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30329 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30330 .endd
30331 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30332 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30333 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30334 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30335 .code
30336 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30337 .endd
30338 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30339 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30340 .code
30341 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30342 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30343 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30344 .endd
30345 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30346 .cindex DNS TTL
30347 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30348 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30349 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30350 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30351 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30352 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30353
30354
30355
30356 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30357 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30358 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30359 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30360 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30361 .code
30362 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30363 .endd
30364 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30365 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30366 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30367 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30368
30369
30370
30371
30372 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30373 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30374 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30375 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
30376 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
30377 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30378 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30379 .code
30380 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30381 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30382 .endd
30383 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30384 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30385 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30386 up by this example is
30387 .code
30388 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30389 .endd
30390 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30391 addresses. For example:
30392 .code
30393 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30394 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30395 .endd
30396 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30397 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30398
30399
30400
30401
30402 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30403 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30404 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30405 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30406 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30407 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30408 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30409 either to double the separators like this:
30410 .code
30411 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30412 .endd
30413 or to change the separator character, like this:
30414 .code
30415 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30416 .endd
30417 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30418 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30419 occurs. Consider this condition:
30420 .code
30421 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30422 .endd
30423 The DNS lookups that occur are:
30424 .code
30425 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30426 a.domain.black.list.tld
30427 .endd
30428 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30429 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30430 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30431 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30432 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30433 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30434 error for a previous item.
30435
30436 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30437 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30438 .code
30439 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30440 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30441 .endd
30442 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30443 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30444 .code
30445 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30446 $sender_address_domain \
30447 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30448 see $dnslist_text.
30449 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30450 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30451 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30452 .endd
30453 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30454 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30455 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30456 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30457 .code
30458 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30459 .endd
30460 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30461 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30462
30463 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30464 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30465
30466
30467
30468
30469 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30470 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30471 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30472 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30473 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30474 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30475 .display
30476 127.1.0.1 RBL
30477 127.1.0.2 DUL
30478 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30479 127.1.0.4 RSS
30480 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30481 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30482 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30483 .endd
30484 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30485 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30486 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30487
30488
30489 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30490 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30491 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30492 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30493 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30494 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30495 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30496 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30497 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30498 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30499 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30500 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30501 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30502 cases, for example:
30503 .code
30504 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30505 .endd
30506 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30507 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30508 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30509 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30510 .code
30511 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30512 .endd
30513 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30514 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30515
30516 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30517 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30518 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30519 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30520 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30521 information.
30522
30523 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30524 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30525 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30526 .code
30527 deny hosts = !+local_networks
30528 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30529 at $dnslist_domain
30530 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30531 .endd
30532
30533
30534
30535 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30536 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30537 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30538 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30539 For example,
30540 .code
30541 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30542 .endd
30543 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30544 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30545 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30546 describes how multiple records are handled.
30547
30548 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30549 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30550 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30551 .code
30552 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30553 .endd
30554 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30555 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30556 first. For example:
30557 .code
30558 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30559 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30560 .endd
30561
30562 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30563 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30564 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30565 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30566 tested. For example:
30567 .code
30568 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30569 .endd
30570 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30571 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30572 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30573 .code
30574 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30575 .endd
30576 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30577 an odd number.
30578
30579
30580
30581 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30582 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30583 condition. Whereas
30584 .code
30585 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30586 .endd
30587 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30588 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30589 .code
30590 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30591 .endd
30592 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30593 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30594 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30595 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30596
30597 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30598 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30599
30600 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30601 previous example is precisely equivalent to
30602 .code
30603 deny dnslists = a.b.c
30604 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30605 .endd
30606 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30607 Consider this example:
30608 .code
30609 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30610 list.dsbl.org : \
30611 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30612 relays.ordb.org
30613 .endd
30614 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30615 .code
30616 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30617 list.dsbl.org
30618 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30619 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30620 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30621 .endd
30622 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30623
30624
30625
30626
30627 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30628 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30629 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30630 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30631 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30632 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30633 .code
30634 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30635 .endd
30636 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30637 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30638 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30639 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30640 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30641 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30642
30643 .ilist
30644 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30645 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30646 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30647 .next
30648 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30649 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30650 changed to:
30651 .code
30652 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30653 .endd
30654 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30655 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30656 .code
30657 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30658 .endd
30659 for the condition to be true.
30660 .endlist
30661
30662 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30663 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30664 .ilist
30665 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30666 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30667 .code
30668 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30669 .endd
30670 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30671 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30672 .next
30673 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30674 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30675 .code
30676 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30677 .endd
30678 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30679 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30680 .code
30681 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30682 .endd
30683 for the condition to be false.
30684 .endlist
30685 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30686 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30687
30688
30689
30690
30691 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30692 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30693 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30694 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30695 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30696 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30697 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30698 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30699 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30700 lists.
30701
30702 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30703 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30704 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30705 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30706 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30707 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30708 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30709 .code
30710 reject message = \
30711 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30712 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30713 dnslists = \
30714 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30715 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30716 .endd
30717 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30718 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30719 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30720 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30721 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30722 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30723
30724 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30725 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30726 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30727 .code
30728 reject dnslists = \
30729 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30730 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30731 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30732 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30733 .endd
30734 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30735 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30736 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30737
30738
30739
30740 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30741 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30742 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30743 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30744 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
30745 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30746 .code
30747 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30748 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30749 .endd
30750 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30751 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30752 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30753 .code
30754 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30755 .endd
30756 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30757 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30758
30759 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30760 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30761 .code
30762 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30763 dnslists = some.list.example
30764 .endd
30765
30766 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30767 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30768 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30769 .code
30770 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30771 .endd
30772
30773 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30774 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30775 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30776 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30777 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30778 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30779 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30780 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30781 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30782 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30783 .display
30784 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30785 .endd
30786 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30787 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30788
30789 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30790 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30791 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30792 of &'p'&.
30793
30794 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30795 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30796 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30797 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30798 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30799 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30800 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30801 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30802 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30803
30804 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30805 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30806 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30807 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30808
30809 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30810 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30811 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30812 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30813 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30814 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30815 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30816 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30817 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30818 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30819
30820 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30821 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30822 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30823 ACL.
30824
30825 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30826 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30827 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30828 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30829 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30830 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30831
30832 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30833 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30834 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30835 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30836 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30837 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30838 the &%count=%& option.
30839
30840
30841 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30842 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30843 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30844 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30845 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30846
30847 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30848 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30849 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30850 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30851
30852 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30853 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30854 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30855 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30856 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30857 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30858 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30859
30860 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30861 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30862 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30863 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30864 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30865 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30866 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30867
30868 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30869 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30870 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30871 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30872 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
30873
30874 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30875 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30876 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30877 multiple different commands.
30878
30879 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30880 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30881 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30882 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30883 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30884
30885 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30886
30887
30888 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30889 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30890 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30891 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30892 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30893
30894 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30895 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30896
30897 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30898 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30899 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30900 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30901 new rate.
30902 .code
30903 acl_check_connect:
30904 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30905 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30906 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30907 # ...
30908 acl_check_mail:
30909 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30910 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30911 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30912 .endd
30913
30914 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30915 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30916 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30917 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30918 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30919 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30920 checks.
30921
30922 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30923 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30924 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30925 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30926 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30927
30928
30929 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30930 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30931 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30932 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30933 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30934 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30935 rest of the ACL.
30936
30937 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30938 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30939 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30940 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30941 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30942 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30943 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30944 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30945 from getting any email through.
30946
30947 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30948 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30949 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30950 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30951 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30952 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30953 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30954 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30955 .code
30956 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30957 .endd
30958
30959
30960 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30961 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30962 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30963 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30964 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30965 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30966 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30967 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30968 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
30969
30970 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
30971 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
30972 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
30973 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
30974 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
30975 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
30976
30977 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
30978 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
30979 rate.
30980
30981 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
30982 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
30983 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
30984 required increases with larger limits.
30985
30986 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
30987 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
30988 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
30989 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
30990 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
30991 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
30992 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
30993 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
30994 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
30995 as intended.
30996
30997
30998 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
30999 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31000 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31001 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31002 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31003 message. For example:
31004 .code
31005 # Log all senders' rates
31006 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31007 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31008
31009 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31010 # at the decimal point.
31011 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31012 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31013 $sender_rate_limit }s
31014
31015 # Keep authenticated users under control
31016 deny authenticated = *
31017 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31018
31019 # System-wide rate limit
31020 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31021 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31022
31023 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31024 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31025 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31026 messages per $sender_rate_period
31027 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31028 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31029 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31030 .endd
31031 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31032 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31033 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31034 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31035 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31036 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31037 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31038
31039
31040
31041 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31042 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31043 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31044 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31045 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31046 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31047 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31048 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31049 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31050 .code
31051 verify = sender/callout
31052 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31053 .endd
31054 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31055 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31056 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31057 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31058 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31059 The available options are as follows:
31060
31061 .ilist
31062 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31063 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31064 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31065 .next
31066 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31067 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31068 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31069 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31070 .next
31071 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31072 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31073 .next
31074 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31075 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31076 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31077 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31078 .endlist
31079
31080 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31081 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31082 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31083 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31084 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31085 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31086 coding like this:
31087 .code
31088 warn !verify = sender
31089 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31090 .endd
31091 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31092 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31093 verification failure.
31094
31095 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31096 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31097
31098 .ilist
31099 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31100 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31101 .next
31102 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31103 .next
31104 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31105 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31106 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31107 .next
31108 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31109 .next
31110 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31111 .endlist
31112
31113 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31114 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31115
31116
31117
31118
31119 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31120 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31121 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31122 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31123 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31124 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31125 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31126 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31127 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31128 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31129 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31130 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31131 sender's domain.
31132
31133 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31134 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31135 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31136 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31137 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31138 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31139
31140 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31141 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31142 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31143 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31144 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31145
31146 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31147 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31148 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31149 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31150 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31151 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31152 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31153 supplies a host list.
31154 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31155
31156 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31157 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31158 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31159 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31160 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31161 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31162 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31163
31164 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31165 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31166 following SMTP commands are sent:
31167 .display
31168 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31169 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
31170 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31171 &`QUIT`&
31172 .endd
31173 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31174 set to &"lmtp"&.
31175
31176 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31177 settings.
31178
31179 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31180 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31181 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31182 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31183 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31184 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31185
31186 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31187 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31188 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31189 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31190 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31191
31192 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31193 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31194 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31195 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31196 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31197
31198
31199
31200
31201 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31202 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31203 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31204 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31205 .code
31206 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31207 .endd
31208 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31209 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31210 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31211
31212
31213 .vlist
31214 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31215 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31216 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31217 For example:
31218 .code
31219 verify = sender/callout=5s
31220 .endd
31221 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31222 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31223 the &%connect%& parameter.
31224
31225
31226 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31227 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31228 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31229 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31230 .code
31231 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31232 .endd
31233 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31234
31235 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
31236 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31237 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31238 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31239 updated in this circumstance.
31240
31241 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31242 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31243 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31244 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31245 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31246 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31247
31248
31249 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31250 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31251 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31252 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31253 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31254 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31255 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31256 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31257 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31258 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31259 .code
31260 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31261 .endd
31262 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31263
31264
31265 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31266 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31267 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31268 For example:
31269 .code
31270 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31271 .endd
31272 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31273 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31274 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31275 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31276 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
31277
31278
31279 .vitem &*no_cache*&
31280 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31281 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31282 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31283
31284 .vitem &*postmaster*&
31285 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31286 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31287 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31288 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31289 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31290 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31291 made, until the cache record expires.
31292
31293 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31294 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31295 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31296 For example:
31297 .code
31298 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31299 .endd
31300 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31301 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31302 .code
31303 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31304 .endd
31305 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31306 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31307 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31308 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31309
31310
31311 .vitem &*random*&
31312 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31313 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31314 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31315 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31316 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31317 .code
31318 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31319 .endd
31320 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31321 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31322 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31323 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31324 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31325
31326 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31327 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31328 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31329 .code
31330 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31331 .endd
31332 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31333 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31334 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31335 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31336 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31337
31338 .vitem &*use_sender*&
31339 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31340 .code
31341 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31342 .endd
31343 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31344 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31345 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31346 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31347 usefulness of callout caching.
31348
31349 .vitem &*hold*&
31350 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31351 .code
31352 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31353 .endd
31354 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
31355 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31356 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31357 when that is used for the connections.
31358 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31359 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31360 if the use_sender option is used,
31361 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31362 and if no other callouts intervene.
31363 .endlist
31364
31365 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31366 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31367 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31368 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31369 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31370 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31371 these circumstances.
31372
31373 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31374 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31375 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31376 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31377 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31378 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31379 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31380
31381 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31382 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31383 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31384 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31385
31386
31387
31388
31389 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31390 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31391 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31392 .cindex "caching" "callout"
31393 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31394 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31395 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31396 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31397 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31398 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31399
31400 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31401 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31402 is not available.
31403
31404 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31405 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31406 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31407
31408 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31409 commands up to and including
31410 .code
31411 MAIL FROM:<>
31412 .endd
31413 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31414 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31415 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31416 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31417 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31418 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31419 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31420
31421 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31422 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31423 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31424 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31425 will eventually be noticed.
31426
31427 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31428 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31429 behaviour will be the same.
31430
31431
31432
31433 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31434 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31435 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31436 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31437 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31438 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31439 you might see:
31440 .code
31441 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31442 250 OK
31443 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31444 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31445 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31446 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31447 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31448 550 Sender verification failed
31449 .endd
31450 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31451 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31452 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31453 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31454 example:
31455 .code
31456 verify = sender/no_details
31457 .endd
31458
31459 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31460 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31461 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31462 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31463 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31464 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31465 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31466
31467 .ilist
31468 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31469 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31470 verification also fails.
31471 .next
31472 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31473 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31474 .endlist
31475
31476 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31477 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31478 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31479 .code
31480 A.Wol: aw123
31481 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31482 .endd
31483 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31484 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31485 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31486 verification to succeed.
31487
31488 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31489 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31490 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31491 option. For example:
31492 .code
31493 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31494 .endd
31495 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31496 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31497
31498 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31499 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31500 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31501 address and a report is output for each of them.
31502
31503
31504
31505 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31506 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31507 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31508 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31509 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31510 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31511 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31512 .code
31513 verify = csa
31514 .endd
31515 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31516 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31517 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31518 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31519 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31520 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31521
31522 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31523 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31524 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31525 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31526
31527 .ilist
31528 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31529 .next
31530 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31531 .next
31532 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31533 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31534 .next
31535 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31536 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31537 .endlist
31538
31539 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31540 use for the DNS query. The default is:
31541 .code
31542 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31543 .endd
31544 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31545 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31546 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31547 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31548 meaningful to say:
31549 .code
31550 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31551 .endd
31552 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31553 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31554 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31555
31556 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31557 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31558 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31559 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31560 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31561 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31562 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31563 of legitimate HELO domains.
31564
31565 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31566 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31567 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31568 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31569 lookup such as:
31570 .code
31571 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31572 .endd
31573 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31574 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31575 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31576
31577
31578
31579
31580 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31581 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
31582 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31583 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31584 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31585 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31586 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31587 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31588
31589 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31590 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31591 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31592 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31593 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31594 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31595 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31596 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
31597
31598 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31599 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31600 like this:
31601 .code
31602 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31603 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31604 }{$value}}
31605 .endd
31606 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31607 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31608 use this:
31609 .code
31610 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31611 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31612 senders = :
31613 recipients = +batv_senders
31614
31615 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31616 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31617 senders = :
31618 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31619 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31620 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31621 .endd
31622 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31623 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31624 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31625 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31626 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31627
31628 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31629 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31630 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31631 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31632 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31633 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31634 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31635
31636 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31637 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31638 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31639 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31640 .code
31641 batv_redirect:
31642 driver = redirect
31643 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31644 .endd
31645 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31646 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31647 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31648 local addresses.
31649
31650 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31651 can be used:
31652 .code
31653 external_smtp_batv:
31654 driver = smtp
31655 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31656 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31657 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31658 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31659 {$value}fail}}}
31660 .endd
31661 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31662
31663
31664
31665 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31666 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31667 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31668 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31669 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31670 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31671 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31672 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31673 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31674 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31675
31676 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31677 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31678 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31679 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31680 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31681 same host is fulfilling both functions,
31682 . ///
31683 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
31684 . ///
31685 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31686 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31687 system to arbitrary domains.
31688
31689
31690 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31691 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31692 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31693 example, suppose you want to do the following:
31694
31695 .ilist
31696 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31697 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31698 &'my.dom2.example'&.
31699 .next
31700 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31701 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31702 .next
31703 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31704 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31705 .endlist
31706
31707
31708 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31709 .code
31710 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31711 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31712 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31713 .endd
31714 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31715 command:
31716 .code
31717 acl_check_rcpt:
31718 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31719 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31720 .endd
31721 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31722 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31723 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31724 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31725 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31726 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31727 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31728
31729
31730
31731 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31732 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31733 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31734 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31735 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31736 .ecindex IIDacl
31737
31738
31739
31740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31742
31743 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31744 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31745 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31746 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31747 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31748 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31749 specification.
31750
31751 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31752 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31753 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31754 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31755 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31756
31757 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31758 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31759 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31760
31761 .ilist
31762 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31763 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31764 .next
31765 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31766 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31767 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31768 .next
31769 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31770 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31771 .next
31772 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31773 conditions.
31774 .next
31775 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31776 .endlist
31777
31778 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31779 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31780 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31781 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31782 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31783 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31784
31785 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31786 temporarily created in a file called:
31787 .display
31788 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31789 .endd
31790 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31791 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31792 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31793 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31794 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31795 .code
31796 control = no_mbox_unspool
31797 .endd
31798 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31799 same directory by default.
31800
31801
31802
31803 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31804 .cindex "virus scanning"
31805 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31806 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31807 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31808 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31809 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31810 in memory and thus are much faster.
31811
31812 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31813 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31814
31815 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31816 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31817 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31818 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31819 .display
31820 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31821 .endd
31822 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31823 .code
31824 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31825 .endd
31826 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31827 before use.
31828 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31829 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
31830 .new
31831 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
31832 .wen
31833
31834 .vlist
31835 .vitem &%avast%&
31836 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31837 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31838 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
31839 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31840 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31841 This scanner type takes one option,
31842 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31843 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31844 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31845 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31846 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
31847 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31848 For example:
31849 .code
31850 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31851 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31852 .endd
31853 If you omit the argument, the default path
31854 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31855 is used.
31856 If you use a remote host,
31857 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31858 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31859 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31860 .code
31861 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31862 FLAGS
31863 SENSITIVITY
31864 PACK
31865 .endd
31866
31867 Only the first virus detected will be reported.
31868
31869
31870 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31871 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31872 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31873 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31874 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31875 example:
31876 .code
31877 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31878 .endd
31879
31880
31881 .vitem &%clamd%&
31882 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31883 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31884 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31885 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31886 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31887
31888 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31889 a UNIX socket specification,
31890 a TCP socket specification,
31891 or a (global) option.
31892
31893 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31894 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31895 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31896 and the second a port number,
31897 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31898 These per-server options are supported:
31899 .code
31900 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31901 .endd
31902
31903 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31904 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31905
31906 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31907
31908 Examples:
31909 .code
31910 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31911 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31912 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31913 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31914 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31915 .endd
31916 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31917 &`local`&
31918 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31919 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31920 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31921 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31922
31923 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31924 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31925 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31926 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31927 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31928 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31929 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31930 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31931 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31932 .code
31933 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31934 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31935 (Connection refused)
31936 .endd
31937
31938 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31939 contributing the code for this scanner.
31940
31941 .vitem &%cmdline%&
31942 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31943 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31944 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31945 type takes 3 mandatory options:
31946
31947 .olist
31948 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31949 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31950
31951 .next
31952 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31953 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31954 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31955 the &"trigger"& expression.
31956
31957 .next
31958 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
31959 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
31960 &"name"& expression.
31961 .endlist olist
31962
31963 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
31964 .code
31965 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
31966 .endd
31967 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
31968 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
31969 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
31970 configuration setting:
31971 .code
31972 av_scanner = cmdline:\
31973 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
31974 found in file:'(.+)'
31975 .endd
31976 .vitem &%drweb%&
31977 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
31978 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
31979 takes one option,
31980 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31981 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31982 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31983 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31984 For example:
31985 .code
31986 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
31987 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
31988 .endd
31989 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
31990 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
31991
31992 .vitem &%f-protd%&
31993 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
31994 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
31995 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
31996 (or port-range).
31997 For example:
31998 .code
31999 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32000 .endd
32001 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32002
32003 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32004 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32005 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32006 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32007 For example:
32008 .code
32009 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32010 .endd
32011 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32012
32013 .vitem &%fsecure%&
32014 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32015 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
32016 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32017 .code
32018 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32019 .endd
32020 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32021 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32022
32023 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32024 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32025 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32026 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32027 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32028 For example:
32029 .code
32030 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32031 .endd
32032 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32033
32034 .vitem &%mksd%&
32035 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32036 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
32037 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
32038 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
32039 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32040 provided that mksd has
32041 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32042 .code
32043 av_scanner = mksd:2
32044 .endd
32045 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32046
32047 .vitem &%sock%&
32048 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32049 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32050 running on the local machine.
32051 There are four options:
32052 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32053 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32054 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32055 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32056 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32057 For example:
32058 .code
32059 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32060 .endd
32061 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32062 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32063 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32064 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32065 specify an empty element to get this.
32066
32067 .vitem &%sophie%&
32068 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32069 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32070 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
32071 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32072 client communication. For example:
32073 .code
32074 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32075 .endd
32076 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32077 the option.
32078 .endlist
32079
32080 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32081 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32082 ACL.
32083
32084 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32085 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32086 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32087 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32088 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32089 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32090 message.
32091
32092 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32093 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32094 The first element can then be one of
32095
32096 .ilist
32097 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32098 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32099 recommended usage.
32100 .next
32101 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32102 the condition fails immediately.
32103 .next
32104 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32105 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32106 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32107 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32108 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
32109 .endlist
32110
32111 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32112 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32113 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32114
32115 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32116 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32117 For example:
32118 .code
32119 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32120 .endd
32121 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32122
32123 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32124 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32125 is set to record the actual address used.
32126
32127 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32128 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32129 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32130 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32131 logging data.
32132
32133 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32134 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32135
32136 Here is a very simple scanning example:
32137 .code
32138 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32139 malware = *
32140 .endd
32141 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32142 .code
32143 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32144 malware = */defer_ok
32145 .endd
32146 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32147 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32148 .code
32149 av_scanner = $acl_m0
32150 .endd
32151 in the main Exim configuration.
32152 .code
32153 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32154 set acl_m0 = sophie
32155 malware = *
32156
32157 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32158 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32159 malware = *
32160 .endd
32161
32162
32163 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32164 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32165 .cindex "spam scanning"
32166 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
32167 .cindex "Rspamd"
32168 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32169 score and a report for the message.
32170 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32171
32172 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32173 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32174 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
32175
32176 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32177 .code
32178 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32179 .endd
32180 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32181 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32182 nicely, however.
32183
32184 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32185 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32186 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32187 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32188 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32189 configuration as follows (example):
32190 .code
32191 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
32192 .endd
32193 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32194 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32195 iptables firewall, consider setting
32196 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32197 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32198 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32199 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32200 soon.
32201
32202
32203 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32204 on TCP port 11333)
32205 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
32206 .code
32207 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
32208 .endd
32209
32210 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32211 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32212 file name instead of an address/port pair:
32213 .code
32214 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32215 .endd
32216 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32217 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32218 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32219 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
32220 .code
32221 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32222 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32223 192.168.2.12 783
32224 .endd
32225 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32226 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32227 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32228 condition defers.
32229
32230 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32231 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32232 and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
32233
32234 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32235 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32236 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32237 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32238
32239 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32240 are options.
32241 The supported options are:
32242 .code
32243 pri=<priority> Selection priority
32244 weight=<value> Selection bias
32245 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32246 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32247 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32248 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32249 .endd
32250
32251 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32252 higher values being tried first.
32253 The default priority is 1.
32254
32255 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32256 Within a priority set
32257 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32258 The default value for selection bias is 1.
32259
32260 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32261 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32262 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32263 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32264
32265 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32266 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32267
32268 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32269 The default value is two minutes.
32270
32271 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32272 a failed connect is made.
32273 The default is to not retry.
32274
32275 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32276 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32277 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32278 expansion.
32279
32280 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32281 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32282 is set to record the actual address used.
32283
32284 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32285 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32286 .code
32287 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32288 spam = joe
32289 .endd
32290 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32291 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32292 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32293 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32294 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32295 right-hand side.
32296
32297 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32298 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32299 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32300 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32301 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32302 are not set.
32303 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32304 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32305 after the first),
32306 or the use of PRDR,
32307 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32308 are needed to use this feature.
32309
32310 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32311 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32312 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32313
32314
32315 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32316 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32317 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32318 example:
32319 .code
32320 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32321 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32322 spam = nobody
32323 .endd
32324
32325 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32326 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32327 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32328 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32329
32330 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32331 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32332 variables.
32333 Except for &$spam_report$&,
32334 these variables are saved with the received message so are
32335 available for use at delivery time.
32336
32337 .vlist
32338 .vitem &$spam_score$&
32339 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32340 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32341
32342 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32343 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32344 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32345 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32346 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32347
32348 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
32349 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
32350 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
32351 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
32352 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32353 spam bar is 50 characters.
32354
32355 .vitem &$spam_report$&
32356 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32357 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32358 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32359 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32360 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32361 unencoded in headers.
32362
32363 .vitem &$spam_action$&
32364 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32365 spam score versus threshold.
32366 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
32367
32368 .endlist
32369
32370 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32371 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32372 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32373
32374 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32375 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32376 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32377 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32378 spam condition, like this:
32379 .code
32380 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32381 spam = joe/defer_ok
32382 .endd
32383 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32384
32385 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32386 condition:
32387 .code
32388 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32389 warn spam = nobody:true
32390 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32391 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32392
32393 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32394 # is over threshold
32395 warn spam = nobody
32396 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32397
32398 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32399 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32400 spam = nobody:true
32401 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32402 .endd
32403
32404
32405
32406 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32407 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32408 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
32409 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32410 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32411 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32412 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32413 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32414 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32415 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32416 cases.
32417
32418 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32419 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32420 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32421 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32422 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32423 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32424 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32425
32426 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32427 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32428 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32429 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32430 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32431
32432 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32433 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32434 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32435 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32436 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32437 syntax is:
32438 .display
32439 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32440 .endd
32441 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32442 the value can be:
32443
32444 .olist
32445 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32446 .next
32447 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32448 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32449 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32450 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32451 .next
32452 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32453 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32454 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32455 the full path and file name.
32456 .next
32457 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32458 filename, and the default path is then used.
32459 .endlist
32460 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32461 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32462 a file with its original, proposed filename using
32463 .code
32464 decode = $mime_filename
32465 .endd
32466 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32467 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32468 automatically unlinked.
32469
32470 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32471 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32472 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32473 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32474 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32475
32476 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32477 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32478 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32479
32480 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32481 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32482 available in the MIME ACL:
32483
32484 .vlist
32485 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32486 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32487 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32488 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32489 contains the empty string.
32490
32491 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
32492 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32493 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32494 .code
32495 us-ascii
32496 gb2312 (Chinese)
32497 iso-8859-1
32498 .endd
32499 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32500 case-insensitively.
32501
32502 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32503 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32504 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32505 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32506 only used for display purposes.
32507
32508 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32509 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32510 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32511
32512 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32513 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32514 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32515
32516 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32517 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32518 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32519 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32520 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32521
32522 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32523 This variable contains the normalized content of the
32524 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32525 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32526
32527 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32528 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32529 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32530 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32531 .code
32532 text/plain
32533 text/html
32534 application/octet-stream
32535 image/jpeg
32536 audio/midi
32537 .endd
32538 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32539 empty string.
32540
32541 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32542 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32543 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32544 containing the decoded data.
32545 .endlist
32546
32547 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32548 .vlist
32549 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
32550 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32551 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32552 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32553 RFC2047
32554 or RFC2231
32555 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32556 If no filename was
32557 found, this variable contains the empty string.
32558
32559 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32560 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32561 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32562 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32563
32564 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32565 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32566 follows:
32567
32568 .olist
32569 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32570
32571 .next
32572 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32573 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32574
32575 .next
32576 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32577 and the rest are attachments.
32578
32579 .next
32580 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32581 .endlist olist
32582
32583 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32584 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32585 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32586 .code
32587 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32588 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32589 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32590 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32591 .endd
32592 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32593 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32594 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32595 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32596 want to carry out specific actions on them.
32597
32598 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32599 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32600 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32601 decoding is fully recursive.
32602
32603 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32604 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32605 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32606 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32607 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32608 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32609 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32610 .endlist
32611
32612
32613
32614 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32615 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32616 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32617 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32618 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32619
32620 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32621 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32622 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32623 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32624 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32625
32626 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32627 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32628 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32629 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32630 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
32631 32K characters are checked.
32632
32633 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32634 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32635 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32636 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32637 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32638 .code
32639 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32640 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32641 .endd
32642 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32643 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32644 matching regular expression.
32645 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32646 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32647
32648 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32649 CPU-intensive.
32650
32651 .ecindex IIDcosca
32652
32653
32654
32655
32656 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32657 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32658
32659 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32660 "Local scan function"
32661 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32662 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32663 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32664 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32665 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32666
32667 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32668 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32669 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32670 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32671 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32672
32673 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32674 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32675 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32676 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32677
32678 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32679 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32680 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32681 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32682
32683 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32684 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32685 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32686 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32687 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32688 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32689 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32690 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32691 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32692
32693
32694
32695 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32696 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32697 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32698 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32699 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32700 directory, so you might set
32701 .code
32702 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32703 .endd
32704 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32705 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32706 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32707 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32708 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32709 _src/local_scan.c_.
32710
32711 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32712 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32713 .code
32714 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32715 .endd
32716 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32717
32718
32719
32720
32721 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32722 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32723 You must include this line near the start of your code:
32724 .code
32725 #include "local_scan.h"
32726 .endd
32727 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32728 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32729 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32730 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32731 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32732 strings and pointers to character strings:
32733 .code
32734 #define CS (char *)
32735 #define CCS (const char *)
32736 #define CSS (char **)
32737 #define US (unsigned char *)
32738 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32739 #define USS (unsigned char **)
32740 .endd
32741 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32742 .code
32743 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32744 .endd
32745 The arguments are as follows:
32746
32747 .ilist
32748 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32749 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32750 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32751
32752 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32753 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32754 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32755 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32756 case this changes in some future version.
32757 .next
32758 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32759 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32760 .endlist
32761
32762 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32763
32764 .vlist
32765 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32766 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32767 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32768 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32769 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32770 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32771
32772 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32773 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32774 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32775
32776 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32777 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32778 queued without immediate delivery.
32779
32780 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32781 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32782 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32783 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32784 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32785 used.
32786
32787 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32788 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32789 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32790 problem"& is used.
32791
32792 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32793 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32794 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32795 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32796 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32797 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32798 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32799
32800 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32801 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32802 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32803 .endlist
32804
32805 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32806 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32807 &%-oe%& command line options.
32808
32809
32810
32811 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32812 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32813 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32814 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32815 want to do this, you must have the line
32816 .code
32817 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32818 .endd
32819 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32820 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32821 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32822 to define them.
32823
32824 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32825 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32826 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32827 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32828 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32829 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32830 .code
32831 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32832 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32833
32834 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32835 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32836 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32837 };
32838
32839 int local_scan_options_count =
32840 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32841 .endd
32842 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32843 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32844 .code
32845 begin local_scan
32846 my_integer = 99
32847 my_string = some string of text...
32848 .endd
32849 The available types of option data are as follows:
32850
32851 .vlist
32852 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32853 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32854 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32855 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32856 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32857 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32858 values.)
32859
32860 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32861 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32862 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32863 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32864
32865 .vitem &*opt_int*&
32866 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32867 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32868 Exim.
32869
32870 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32871 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32872 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32873 printed with the suffix K or M.
32874
32875 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32876 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32877 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32878 always output in octal.
32879
32880 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32881 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32882 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32883
32884 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32885 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32886 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32887 .endlist
32888
32889 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32890 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32891
32892
32893
32894 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32895 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32896 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32897 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32898 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32899 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32900 C variables are as follows:
32901
32902 .vlist
32903 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32904 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32905 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32906
32907 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32908 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32909 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32910
32911 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32912 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32913 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32914 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32915
32916 .ilist
32917 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32918 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32919 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32920
32921 .next
32922 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32923 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32924 of debugging bits.
32925 .endlist ilist
32926
32927 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32928 selected, you should use code like this:
32929 .code
32930 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32931 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32932 .endd
32933 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32934 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32935 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32936
32937 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32938 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32939 discussed below.
32940
32941 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32942 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32943
32944 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32945 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32946
32947 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32948 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32949 &%-bh%& command line option.
32950
32951 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32952 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32953 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32954
32955 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32956 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32957 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32958 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32959
32960 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32961 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32962 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32963
32964 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32965 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32966
32967 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32968 The number of accepted recipients.
32969
32970 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32971 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32972 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32973 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32974 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32975 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32976 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32977 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32978 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32979 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32980 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32981 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32982
32983 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32984 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32985
32986 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32987 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32988 locally-submitted messages.
32989
32990 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32991 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32992 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32993
32994 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32995 The name of the sending host, if known.
32996
32997 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32998 The port on the sending host.
32999
33000 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33001 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33002
33003 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33004 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33005
33006 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33007 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33008 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33009 .endlist
33010
33011
33012 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33013 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33014 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33015 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33016 their type to *.
33017
33018
33019 .vlist
33020 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33021 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33022
33023 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33024 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33025 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33026 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33027 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33028 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33029 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33030
33031 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33032 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33033 internal newlines.
33034
33035 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33036 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33037 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33038 .endlist
33039
33040
33041
33042 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33043 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33044
33045 .vlist
33046 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33047 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33048
33049 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33050 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33051 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33052 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33053
33054 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33055 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33056 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33057 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33058 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33059 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33060 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33061 is NULL for all recipients.
33062 .endlist
33063
33064
33065
33066 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33067 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33068 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33069 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33070 release:
33071
33072 .vlist
33073 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33074 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33075
33076 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33077 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33078 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33079 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33080
33081 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33082 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33083 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33084 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33085 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33086
33087 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33088
33089 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33090 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33091 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33092 return value is as follows:
33093
33094 .ilist
33095 >= 0
33096
33097 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33098 ending status.
33099
33100 .next
33101 < 0 and > &--256
33102
33103 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33104 signal number.
33105
33106 .next
33107 &--256
33108
33109 The process timed out.
33110 .next
33111 &--257
33112
33113 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33114 .endlist
33115
33116 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33117 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33118 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33119 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33120 forks a subprocess that is running
33121 .code
33122 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33123 .endd
33124 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33125 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33126 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33127 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33128
33129 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33130 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33131 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33132 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33133
33134
33135 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33136 *sender_authentication)*&
33137 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33138 that it runs is:
33139 .display
33140 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33141 .endd
33142 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33143
33144
33145 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33146 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33147 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33148 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33149 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33150 .code
33151 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33152 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33153 .endd
33154
33155 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33156 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33157 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33158 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33159 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33160 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33161 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33162 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33163
33164 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33165 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33166 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33167 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33168 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33169 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33170
33171 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33172 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33173 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33174 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33175
33176 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33177 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33178 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33179 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33180 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33181 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33182 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33183 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33184 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33185 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33186 .code
33187 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33188 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33189 .endd
33190 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33191 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33192
33193
33194 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33195 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33196 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33197 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33198 match the specification, the function does nothing.
33199
33200
33201 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33202 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33203 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33204 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33205 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33206 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33207 .code
33208 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33209 .endd
33210 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33211 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33212 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33213 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33214 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33215 zero-terminated.
33216
33217 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33218 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33219 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33220 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33221 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33222 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33223 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33224 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33225
33226 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33227 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33228 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33229 .display
33230 &`OK `& match succeeded
33231 &`FAIL `& match failed
33232 &`DEFER `& match deferred
33233 .endd
33234 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33235 inability to contact a database.
33236
33237 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33238 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33239 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33240 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33241 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33242
33243 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33244 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33245 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33246 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33247 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33248
33249 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33250 uschar&~*list)*&"
33251 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33252 expected to be
33253 .code
33254 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33255 .endd
33256 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33257 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33258 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33259 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33260 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33261 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33262 failed.
33263
33264 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33265 *format,&~...)*&"
33266 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33267 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33268 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33269 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33270 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33271 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33272
33273
33274 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33275 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33276 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33277 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33278
33279 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33280 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33281 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33282 value afterwards. For example:
33283 .code
33284 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33285 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33286 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33287 .endd
33288
33289 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33290 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33291 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33292 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33293 address.
33294 .endlist
33295
33296
33297 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33298 .vlist
33299 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33300 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33301 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33302 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33303 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33304 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33305 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33306 binary string is returned with an error message.
33307
33308 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33309 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33310 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33311
33312 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33313 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33314 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33315 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33316 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33317
33318 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33319 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33320 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33321
33322 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33323 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33324 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33325 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33326 with translation.
33327
33328
33329 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33330 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33331 below.
33332
33333 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33334 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33335 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33336 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33337 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33338 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33339 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33340 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33341 is involved.
33342
33343 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
33344 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
33345
33346 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
33347 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
33348 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33349 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33350 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33351 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33352 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33353 .code
33354 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33355 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33356 .endd
33357 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33358 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33359 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33360 multiple output lines.
33361
33362 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33363 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33364 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33365 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33366 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33367 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33368 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33369 is an error.
33370
33371 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33372 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33373 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33374 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33375
33376 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33377 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33378 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33379
33380 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33381 See below.
33382
33383 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33384 See below.
33385
33386 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33387 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33388 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33389 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33390 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33391 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33392 more discussion.
33393 .endlist
33394
33395
33396
33397 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33398 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33399 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33400 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33401 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33402 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33403 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33404 terminates.
33405
33406 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33407 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33408 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33409 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33410
33411 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33412 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33413 .code
33414 store_pool = POOL_PERM
33415 .endd
33416 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33417 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33418 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33419 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33420
33421 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33422 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33423 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33424 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33425 &%store_pool%&.
33426 .ecindex IIDlosca
33427
33428
33429
33430
33431 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33432 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33433
33434 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33435 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33436 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33437 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33438 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33439 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33440 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33441 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33442
33443 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33444 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33445 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33446 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33447 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33448
33449 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33450 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33451 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33452 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33453 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33454 prevent it happening on retries.
33455
33456 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33457 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33458 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33459 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33460 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33461 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33462 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33463 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33464
33465
33466 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33467 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33468 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33469 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33470 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33471 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33472 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33473 .code
33474 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33475 system_filter_user = exim
33476 .endd
33477 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33478 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33479 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33480 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33481 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33482 by the &%reply%& command.
33483
33484
33485 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33486 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33487 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33488 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33489
33490 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33491 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33492
33493
33494
33495 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33496 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33497 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33498 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33499 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33500 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33501 they cause errors.
33502
33503 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33504 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33505 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33506 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33507 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33508 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33509 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33510
33511 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33512 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33513 succeed, it will not be tried again.
33514 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33515 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33516
33517 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33518 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33519 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33520 to which users' filter files can refer.
33521
33522
33523
33524 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33525 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
33526 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33527 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33528 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33529
33530
33531
33532 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33533 .cindex "freezing messages"
33534 .cindex "message" "freezing"
33535 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
33536 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33537 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33538 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33539 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33540 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33541 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33542 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33543 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33544 .code
33545 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33546 .endd
33547 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33548
33549 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33550 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33551 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33552 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33553 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33554 run.
33555
33556 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33557 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33558 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33559 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33560
33561 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33562 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33563 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33564 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33565 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33566 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33567 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33568 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33569 message. For example:
33570 .code
33571 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33572 because it contains attachments that we are \
33573 not prepared to receive."
33574 .endd
33575
33576 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33577 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33578 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33579 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33580 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33581 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33582 use, for example
33583 .code
33584 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33585 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33586 .endd
33587 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33588 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33589 generated by the filter.
33590
33591 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33592 &%defer%&,
33593 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33594 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33595 as
33596 .code
33597 mail ...
33598 freeze
33599 .endd
33600 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33601 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33602 take place.
33603
33604
33605
33606 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33607 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33608 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33609 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33610 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33611 .code
33612 headers add <string>
33613 headers remove <string>
33614 .endd
33615 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33616 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33617 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33618 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33619 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33620
33621 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33622 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33623 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33624 example:
33625 .code
33626 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33627 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33628 X-header-2: ...."
33629 .endd
33630 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33631 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33632 space after input continuations is ignored.
33633
33634 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33635 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33636 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33637 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33638 header with the same name, they are all removed.
33639
33640 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33641 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33642 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33643 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33644 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33645 used for all recipients of the message.
33646
33647 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33648 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33649 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33650 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33651 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33652 until the message is actually being written (see section
33653 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33654
33655 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33656 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33657 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33658 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33659 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33660 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33661 modified more than once.
33662
33663 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33664 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33665 For example:
33666 .code
33667 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33668 headers remove "Subject"
33669 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33670 headers remove "Old-Subject"
33671 .endd
33672
33673
33674
33675 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33676 .cindex "envelope sender"
33677 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33678 .code
33679 errors_to <some address>
33680 .endd
33681 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33682 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33683 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33684 might use
33685 .code
33686 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33687 .endd
33688 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33689 address if its delivery failed.
33690
33691
33692
33693 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33694 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33695 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33696 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33697 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33698 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33699 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33700 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33701 which implements such a filter:
33702 .code
33703 central_filter:
33704 check_local_user
33705 driver = redirect
33706 domains = +local_domains
33707 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33708 no_verify
33709 allow_filter
33710 allow_freeze
33711 .endd
33712 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33713 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33714 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33715 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33716
33717 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33718 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33719 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33720 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33721 normal way.
33722 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
33723 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
33724 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
33725
33726
33727
33728
33729
33730
33731 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33733
33734 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33735 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33736 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33737 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33738 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33739 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33740 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33741 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33742
33743 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33744 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33745 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33746 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33747 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33748
33749 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33750 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33751 loopback interface specially in any way.
33752
33753 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33754 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33755
33756
33757
33758
33759 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33760 .cindex "message" "submission"
33761 .cindex "submission mode"
33762 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33763 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33764 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33765 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33766 .code
33767 control = submission
33768 .endd
33769 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33770 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33771 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33772 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33773 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33774 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33775 .code
33776 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33777 control = submission
33778 .endd
33779 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33780 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33781 is used to separate options. For example:
33782 .code
33783 control = submission/sender_retain
33784 .endd
33785 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33786 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33787 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33788 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33789 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33790 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33791 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33792
33793 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33794 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33795 example:
33796 .code
33797 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33798 .endd
33799 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33800 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33801 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33802 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33803 .code
33804 accept authenticated = *
33805 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33806 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33807 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33808 .endd
33809 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33810 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33811 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33812 .code
33813 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33814 .endd
33815 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33816 line would be:
33817 .code
33818 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33819 .endd
33820 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33821 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33822 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33823 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33824
33825 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33826 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33827 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33828 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33829 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33830 spoof another's address.
33831
33832 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33833 .cindex "line endings"
33834 .cindex "carriage return"
33835 .cindex "linefeed"
33836 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33837 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33838 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33839 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33840 use CRLF or just CR.
33841
33842 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33843 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33844 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33845 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33846 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33847 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33848 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33849 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33850 follows:
33851
33852 .ilist
33853 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33854 .next
33855 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33856 is ignored.
33857 .next
33858 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33859 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33860 terminator.
33861 .next
33862 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33863 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33864 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33865 people trying to play silly games.
33866 .next
33867 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33868 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33869 line.
33870 .endlist
33871
33872
33873
33874
33875
33876 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33877 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33878 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33879 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33880 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33881 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33882 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33883 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33884
33885 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33886 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33887 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33888 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33889 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33890
33891 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33892 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33893 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33894 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33895 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33896 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33897 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33898 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33899
33900
33901
33902
33903 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33904 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33905 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33906 .cindex "sender" "address"
33907 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33908 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33909 .cindex "envelope sender"
33910 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33911 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33912 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33913 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33914 .code
33915 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33916 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33917 .endd
33918 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33919 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33920 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33921 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33922 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33923 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33924 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33925 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33926 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33927
33928 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33929 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33930 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33931 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33932 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33933 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33934 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33935
33936 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33937 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33938 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33939
33940 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33941 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33942 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33943 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33944
33945
33946
33947 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33948 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33949 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
33950 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33951 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33952 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33953 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33954 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33955
33956 .blockquote
33957 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33958 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33959 .endblockquote
33960
33961 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33962 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33963 follows:
33964
33965 .ilist
33966 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33967 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33968 .next
33969 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33970 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33971 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33972 .next
33973 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33974 also removed.
33975 .next
33976 For a locally-submitted message,
33977 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33978 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33979 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33980 included in log lines in this case.
33981 .next
33982 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33983 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33984 .endlist
33985
33986
33987
33988
33989 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33990 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33991 includes the header line:
33992 .code
33993 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33994 .endd
33995
33996 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33997 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33998 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33999 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34000 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34001 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34002
34003
34004 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34005 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34006 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34007 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34008 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34009 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34010
34011 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34012 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34013 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34014 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34015 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34016 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34017 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34018 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34019 messages.
34020
34021
34022 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34023 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34024 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34025 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34026 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34027 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34028 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34029 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34030 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34031 messages.
34032
34033
34034 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34035 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34036 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34037 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34038 .cindex "message" "submission"
34039 .cindex "submission mode"
34040 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34041 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34042
34043 .ilist
34044 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34045 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34046 .next
34047 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34048 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34049 .olist
34050 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34051 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34052 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34053 .next
34054 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34055 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34056 .next
34057 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34058 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34059 .endlist
34060 .endlist
34061
34062 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34063
34064 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34065 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34066 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34067 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34068 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34069 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34070 &%qualify_domain%&.
34071
34072 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34073 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34074 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34075 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34076
34077
34078 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34079 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34080 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34081 .cindex "message" "submission"
34082 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34083 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34084 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34085 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34086 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34087 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34088 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34089 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34090 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34091 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34092
34093
34094 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34095 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34096 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34097 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34098 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34099 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34100
34101 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34102 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34103 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34104 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34105
34106 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34107 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34108 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34109
34110
34111 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34112 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34113 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34114 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34115 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34116 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34117 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34118 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34119 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34120 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34121 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
34122 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34123
34124
34125
34126 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34127 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34128 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34129 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34130 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34131 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34132 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34133 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34134 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34135
34136
34137
34138 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34139 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34140 .cindex "message" "submission"
34141 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34142 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34143 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34144 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34145 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34146 control setting.
34147
34148 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34149 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34150 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34151 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34152 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34153 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34154 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34155 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34156 line is added to the message.
34157
34158 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34159 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34160 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34161 options true at the same time.
34162
34163 .cindex "submission mode"
34164 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34165 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34166 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34167 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34168
34169 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34170 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34171 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34172 created as follows:
34173
34174 .ilist
34175 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34176 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34177 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34178 .next
34179 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34180 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34181 .next
34182 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34183 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34184 .endlist
34185
34186 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34187 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34188 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34189 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34190
34191 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34192 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34193 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34194 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34195
34196
34197
34198 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34199 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34200 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34201 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34202 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34203 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34204 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34205 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34206 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34207
34208 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34209 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34210 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34211 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34212 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34213 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34214
34215 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34216 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34217 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34218
34219 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34220 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34221 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34222 .code
34223 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34224 X-added-second: another added header line
34225 .endd
34226 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34227
34228 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34229 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34230 Each header-line is separately expanded.
34231
34232 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34233 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34234 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34235 not part of the names. For example:
34236 .code
34237 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34238 .endd
34239
34240 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34241 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34242 Each item is separately expanded.
34243 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34244 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34245 will act as list separators.
34246
34247 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34248 items are expanded at routing time,
34249 and then associated with all addresses that are
34250 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34251 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34252 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34253
34254 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
34255 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34256 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34257 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34258
34259 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34260 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34261 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34262 requirements.
34263
34264 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34265 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34266 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34267 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34268 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34269 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34270 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34271
34272 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34273 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34274 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34275 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34276
34277 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34278 the following consequences:
34279
34280 .ilist
34281 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34282 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34283 to it, at all times.
34284 .next
34285 Header lines that are added by a router's
34286 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34287 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34288 .next
34289 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34290 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34291 .next
34292 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34293 a later router or by a transport.
34294 .next
34295 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34296 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34297 .code
34298 headers_remove = subject
34299 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34300 .endd
34301 .endlist
34302
34303 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34304 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34305
34306
34307
34308
34309
34310 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34311 .cindex "address" "constructed"
34312 .cindex "constructed address"
34313 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34314 the form
34315 .display
34316 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34317 .endd
34318 For example:
34319 .code
34320 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34321 .endd
34322 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34323 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34324 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34325 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34326 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34327 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34328 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34329 there is no password file entry.
34330
34331 .cindex "RFC 2047"
34332 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34333 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34334 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34335 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34336 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34337 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34338 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34339 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34340
34341
34342
34343 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
34344 .cindex "case of local parts"
34345 .cindex "local part" "case of"
34346 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
34347 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
34348 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34349 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34350 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34351 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34352 router option.
34353
34354 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
34355 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34356 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34357 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34358 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34359 .code
34360 correct_case:
34361 driver = redirect
34362 domains = +local_domains
34363 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34364 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34365 @$domain
34366 .endd
34367 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34368 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34369 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34370 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34371 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34372
34373
34374
34375 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34376 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
34377 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
34378 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34379 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34380 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34381 empty components for compatibility.
34382
34383
34384
34385 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34386 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34387 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34388 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34389 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34390 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34391
34392 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34393 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34394 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34395 example, a header such as
34396 .code
34397 To: hare@teaparty
34398 .endd
34399 might get rewritten as
34400 .code
34401 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34402 .endd
34403 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34404 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34405 been routed.
34406
34407 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34408 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34409 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34410 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34411 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34412 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34413 .ecindex IIDmesproc
34414
34415
34416
34417 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34419
34420 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34421 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34422 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34423 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34424 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34425 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34426 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34427
34428 .ilist
34429 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34430 .next
34431 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34432 .next
34433 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34434 .endlist
34435
34436 For mail delivery, the following are available:
34437
34438 .ilist
34439 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34440 .next
34441 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34442 &"lmtp"&);
34443 .next
34444 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34445 transport);
34446 .next
34447 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34448 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34449 .endlist
34450
34451 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34452 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34453 used to contain the envelope information.
34454
34455
34456
34457 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34458 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34459 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34460 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34461 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34462 .cindex "EHLO"
34463 .cindex "HELO"
34464 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34465 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34466 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34467 processing is the same in both cases.
34468
34469 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34470 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34471 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34472 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34473 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34474 .cindex "transport" "filter"
34475 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34476 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34477 suppressed.
34478
34479 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34480 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34481 required for the transaction.
34482
34483 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34484 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34485 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34486 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34487 is called for verification.
34488
34489 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34490 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34491 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34492
34493 .cindex "carriage return"
34494 .cindex "linefeed"
34495 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34496 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34497 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34498 line terminator.
34499
34500 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34501 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34502 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34503 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34504 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34505 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34506 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34507 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34508 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34509
34510 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34511 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34512 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34513 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34514
34515 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34516 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34517 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34518 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34519
34520 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34521 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34522 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34523 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34524 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34525 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34526 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34527 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34528 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34529 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34530
34531 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34532 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34533
34534 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34535 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34536 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34537 square bracket of the IP address.
34538
34539
34540
34541
34542 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34543 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34544 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34545 .cindex "host" "error"
34546 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34547 message errors, and recipient errors.
34548
34549 .vlist
34550 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34551 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34552 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34553
34554 .ilist
34555 Connection refused or timed out,
34556 .next
34557 Any error response code on connection,
34558 .next
34559 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34560 .next
34561 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34562 .next
34563 I/O errors at any time,
34564 .next
34565 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34566 the &"."& at the end of the data.
34567 .endlist ilist
34568
34569 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34570 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34571 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34572 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34573 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34574 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34575 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34576 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34577
34578 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34579 .cindex "message" "error"
34580 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34581 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34582 message errors are:
34583
34584 .ilist
34585 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34586 the data,
34587 .next
34588 Timeout after MAIL,
34589 .next
34590 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34591 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34592 connection at any other time.
34593 .endlist ilist
34594
34595 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34596 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34597 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34598 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34599 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34600 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34601 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34602 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34603 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34604 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34605
34606 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34607 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34608 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34609 response to MAIL.
34610
34611 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34612 .cindex "recipient" "error"
34613 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34614 recipient errors are:
34615
34616 .ilist
34617 Any error response to RCPT,
34618 .next
34619 Timeout after RCPT.
34620 .endlist
34621
34622 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34623 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34624 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34625 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34626 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34627 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34628 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34629 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34630 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34631 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34632 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34633 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34634 the retry clock is reset.
34635
34636 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34637 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34638 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34639 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34640 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34641 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34642 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34643 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34644 recipient's retry time.
34645 .endlist
34646
34647 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34648 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34649 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34650 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34651 until the next delivery attempt.
34652
34653 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34654 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34655 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34656 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34657 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34658 is created.
34659
34660 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34661 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34662 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34663 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34664 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34665 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34666 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34667
34668 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34669 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34670 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34671 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34672 then to be treated as a host error.
34673
34674 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34675 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34676 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34677 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34678 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34679
34680
34681
34682
34683 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34684 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34685 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34686 .cindex "inetd"
34687 .cindex "daemon"
34688 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34689 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34690 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34691 .code
34692 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34693 .endd
34694 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34695 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34696 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34697 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34698 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34699 stream and exits with an error code.
34700
34701 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34702 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34703 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34704 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34705
34706 .cindex "carriage return"
34707 .cindex "linefeed"
34708 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34709 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34710 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34711 line terminator.
34712 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34713 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34714 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34715
34716 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34717 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34718 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34719 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34720 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34721 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34722 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34723 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34724
34725 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34726 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34727 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34728 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34729 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34730 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34731 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34732 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34733 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34734
34735 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34736 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34737 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34738
34739 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34740 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34741 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34742 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34743 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34744
34745 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34746 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34747 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34748 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34749 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34750 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34751 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34752
34753 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34754 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34755 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34756 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34757 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34758
34759 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34760 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34761 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34762 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34763 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34764 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34765 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34766 a delivery process.
34767
34768 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34769 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34770 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34771 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34772 however, available with &'inetd'&.
34773
34774 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34775 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34776 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34777 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34778
34779 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34780 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34781 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34782
34783
34784
34785 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34786 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34787 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34788 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34789 the error response to the last command. The default value for
34790 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34791 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34792 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34793
34794
34795 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34796 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34797 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34798 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34799 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34800 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34801 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34802 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34803 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34804 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34805 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34806
34807
34808
34809 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34810 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34811 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34812 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34813 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34814 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34815 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34816 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34817
34818 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34819 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34820 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34821 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34822 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34823 counted.
34824
34825 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34826 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34827 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34828
34829 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34830 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34831 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34832 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34833 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34834
34835
34836
34837
34838 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34839 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34840 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34841 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34842
34843 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34844 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34845 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34846 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
34847 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34848 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34849 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34850 SMTP response codes.
34851
34852 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34853 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34854 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34855 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34856 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34857 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34858 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34859 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34860 RCPT failures.
34861
34862
34863
34864 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34865 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34866 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34867 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34868 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34869 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34870 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34871
34872 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34873 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34874 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34875 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34876 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34877 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34878 argument. For example,
34879 .code
34880 ETRN #brigadoon
34881 .endd
34882 runs the command
34883 .code
34884 exim -R brigadoon
34885 .endd
34886 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34887 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34888 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34889 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34890 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34891
34892 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34893 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34894 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34895 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34896 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34897 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34898 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34899 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34900
34901 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34902 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34903 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34904 whatever the form of its argument. For
34905 example:
34906 .code
34907 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34908 $sender_host_address
34909 .endd
34910 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34911 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34912 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34913 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34914 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34915 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34916 for it to change them before running the command.
34917
34918
34919
34920 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34921 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34922 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34923 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34924 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34925 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34926 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34927 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34928 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34929 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34930 runs for RCPT commands:
34931 .code
34932 accept hosts = :
34933 .endd
34934 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34935
34936
34937
34938 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34939 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34940 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
34941 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34942 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34943 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34944 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34945 envelope along with the message.
34946
34947 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34948 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34949 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34950 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34951 can be used to specify it.
34952
34953 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34954 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34955 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34956 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34957 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34958
34959 .vindex "&$host$&"
34960 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34961 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34962 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34963 router:
34964 .code
34965 begin routers
34966 route_append:
34967 driver = manualroute
34968 transport = smtp_appendfile
34969 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34970
34971 begin transports
34972 smtp_appendfile:
34973 driver = appendfile
34974 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34975 batch_max = 1000
34976 use_bsmtp
34977 user = exim
34978 .endd
34979 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34980 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34981 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34982
34983
34984
34985 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34986 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34987 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34988 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34989 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34990 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34991 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34992 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34993 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34994 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34995
34996 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34997 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34998
34999 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35000 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35001 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35002 make some use of automatically, for example:
35003 .code
35004 554 Unexpected end of file
35005 Transaction started in line 10
35006 Error detected in line 14
35007 .endd
35008 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35009 file, for example:
35010 .code
35011 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35012 The error message was:
35013
35014 501 '>' missing at end of address
35015
35016 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35017 The error was detected in line 12.
35018 The SMTP command at fault was:
35019
35020 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35021
35022 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35023 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35024 .endd
35025 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35026 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35027 accepted.
35028 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35029 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35030
35031
35032
35033 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35034 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35035
35036 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35037 "Customizing messages"
35038 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
35039 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35040 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35041 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35042 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35043
35044 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35045 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35046 option. Exim also adds the line
35047 .code
35048 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35049 .endd
35050 to all warning and bounce messages,
35051
35052
35053 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35054 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35055 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35056 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35057 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35058 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35059 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35060
35061 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35062 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35063 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35064 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35065 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35066 item.
35067
35068 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35069 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35070 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35071 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35072 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35073 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35074 option, rounded to a whole number.
35075
35076 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35077
35078 .ilist
35079 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35080 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35081 .next
35082 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35083 failing addresses with their error messages.
35084 .next
35085 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35086 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35087 .next
35088 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35089 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35090 .endlist
35091
35092 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35093 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35094 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35095 .code
35096 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35097 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35098 {: returning message to sender}}
35099 ****
35100 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35101
35102 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35103 {that you sent }{sent by
35104
35105 <$sender_address>
35106
35107 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35108 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35109 ****
35110 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35111 ****
35112 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35113 ------
35114 ****
35115 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35116 only the first
35117 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35118 ****
35119 .endd
35120 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35121 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35122 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35123 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35124 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35125 text sections:
35126
35127 .ilist
35128 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35129 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35130 .next
35131 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35132 the delayed addresses.
35133 .next
35134 The third item then ends the message.
35135 .endlist
35136
35137 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35138 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35139 .code
35140 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35141 $warn_message_delay
35142 ****
35143 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35144
35145 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35146 {that you sent }{sent by
35147
35148 <$sender_address>
35149
35150 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35151 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
35152
35153 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35154 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35155 The date of the message is: $h_date
35156
35157 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35158 ****
35159 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35160 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35161 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35162 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35163 the message will be returned to you.
35164 .endd
35165 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35166 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35167 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35168 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35169 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35170 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35171 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35172 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35173 handled them.
35174
35175
35176
35177
35178 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35180
35181 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35182 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35183 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35184
35185
35186
35187 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35188 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
35189 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35190 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35191 routing explicitly:
35192 .code
35193 send_to_smart_host:
35194 driver = manualroute
35195 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35196 transport = remote_smtp
35197 .endd
35198 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35199 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35200 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35201 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35202 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35203
35204
35205
35206
35207 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35208 .cindex "mailing lists"
35209 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35210 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35211 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35212
35213 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35214 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35215 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35216 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35217 .code
35218 lists:
35219 driver = redirect
35220 domains = lists.example
35221 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35222 forbid_pipe
35223 forbid_file
35224 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35225 no_more
35226 .endd
35227 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35228 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35229 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35230 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35231
35232 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35233 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35234 a mailing list.
35235
35236 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35237 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35238 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35239 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35240 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35241
35242 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35243 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35244 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35245 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35246 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35247 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35248 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35249 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35250 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35251
35252
35253
35254 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35255 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35256 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35257 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35258 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35259 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35260 addresses are not rigorously checked.
35261
35262 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35263 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35264 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35265 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35266 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35267
35268
35269
35270 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35271 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35272 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35273 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35274 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35275 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35276 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35277 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35278 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35279 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35280
35281 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35282 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35283 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35284 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35285 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35286 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35287 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35288 pre-existing messages.
35289
35290 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35291 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35292 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35293 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35294 one level of expansion anyway.
35295
35296
35297
35298 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35299 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35300 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35301 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35302 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35303 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35304
35305 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35306 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35307 .code
35308 lists_request:
35309 driver = redirect
35310 domains = lists.example
35311 local_part_suffix = -request
35312 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35313 no_more
35314
35315 lists_post:
35316 driver = redirect
35317 domains = lists.example
35318 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35319 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35320 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35321 forbid_pipe
35322 forbid_file
35323 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35324 no_more
35325
35326 lists_closed:
35327 driver = redirect
35328 domains = lists.example
35329 allow_fail
35330 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35331 .endd
35332 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35333 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35334 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35335 mailing list.
35336
35337 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35338 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35339 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35340 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35341 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35342 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35343 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
35344 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
35345 &"unrouteable address"& error.
35346
35347 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
35348 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35349 the address, giving a suitable error message.
35350
35351
35352
35353
35354 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35355 .cindex "VERP"
35356 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35357 .cindex "envelope sender"
35358 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35359 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35360 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35361 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35362 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35363 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35364
35365 .oindex &%errors_to%&
35366 .oindex &%return_path%&
35367 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35368 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35369 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35370 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35371 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35372 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35373 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35374 .code
35375 verp_smtp:
35376 driver = smtp
35377 max_rcpt = 1
35378 return_path = \
35379 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35380 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35381 .endd
35382 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35383 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35384 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35385 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35386 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35387 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35388 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35389 rewritten as
35390 .code
35391 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35392 .endd
35393 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35394 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35395 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35396 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35397 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35398 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35399
35400 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35401 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35402 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35403 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35404 .code
35405 dnslookup:
35406 driver = dnslookup
35407 domains = ! +local_domains
35408 transport = \
35409 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35410 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35411 no_more
35412 .endd
35413 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35414 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35415 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35416 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35417 address.
35418
35419 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35420 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35421 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35422 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35423 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35424 .code
35425 verp_dnslookup:
35426 driver = dnslookup
35427 domains = ! +local_domains
35428 transport = remote_smtp
35429 errors_to = \
35430 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35431 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35432 no_more
35433 .endd
35434 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35435 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35436 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35437 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35438 them.
35439
35440 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35441 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35442 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35443 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35444 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35445 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35446 used).
35447
35448
35449
35450
35451
35452
35453 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35454 .cindex "virtual domains"
35455 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
35456 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35457 meanings:
35458
35459 .ilist
35460 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35461 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35462 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35463 .next
35464 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35465 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35466 have login accounts on that host.
35467 .endlist
35468
35469 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35470 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35471 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35472 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35473 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35474 to a router of this form:
35475 .code
35476 virtual:
35477 driver = redirect
35478 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35479 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35480 no_more
35481 .endd
35482 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35483 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35484 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35485 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35486 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35487 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35488
35489 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35490 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35491 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35492 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35493
35494 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35495 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35496 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35497 .code
35498 my_domains:
35499 driver = accept
35500 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35501 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35502 transport = my_mailboxes
35503 .endd
35504 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35505 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35506 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35507 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35508 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35509 follows:
35510 .code
35511 my_mailboxes:
35512 driver = appendfile
35513 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35514 user = mail
35515 .endd
35516 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35517 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35518
35519 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35520 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35521 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35522 information about the domains.
35523
35524
35525
35526 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35527 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35528 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35529 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
35530 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
35531 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35532 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35533 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35534 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35535 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35536 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35537 example, consider this router:
35538 .code
35539 userforward:
35540 driver = redirect
35541 check_local_user
35542 file = $home/.forward
35543 local_part_suffix = -*
35544 local_part_suffix_optional
35545 allow_filter
35546 .endd
35547 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35548 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35549 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35550 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35551 .code
35552 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35553 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35554 endif
35555 .endd
35556 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35557 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35558 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35559 control over which suffixes are valid.
35560
35561 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35562 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35563 another MTA:
35564 .code
35565 userforward:
35566 driver = redirect
35567 check_local_user
35568 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35569 local_part_suffix = -*
35570 local_part_suffix_optional
35571 allow_filter
35572 .endd
35573 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35574 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35575 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35576 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35577 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35578
35579
35580
35581 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35582 .cindex "vacation processing"
35583 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35584 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35585 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35586 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35587 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35588
35589 .ilist
35590 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35591 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35592 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35593 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35594 .code
35595 spqr, vacation-spqr
35596 .endd
35597 .next
35598 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35599 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35600 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35601 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35602 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35603 message.
35604 .endlist
35605
35606 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35607 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35608
35609
35610
35611 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35612 .cindex "message" "copying every"
35613 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35614 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35615 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35616 each day's messages.
35617
35618 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35619 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35620 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35621 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35622
35623
35624
35625 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35626 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35627 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35628 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35629 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35630 permanently connected.
35631
35632 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35633 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35634 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35635
35636
35637 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35638 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35639 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35640 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35641 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35642 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35643 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35644 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35645
35646 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35647 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35648 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35649 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35650 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35651 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35652 if required.
35653
35654 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35655 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35656 intermittent host. For example:
35657 .code
35658 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35659 .endd
35660 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35661 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35662 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35663 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35664 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35665 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35666 immediately.
35667
35668 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35669 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35670 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35671 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35672 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35673 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35674 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35675
35676
35677
35678 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35679 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35680 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35681 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35682 delivered immediately.
35683
35684 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35685 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35686 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35687 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35688 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35689 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35690 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35691 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35692 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35693 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35694 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35695 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35696 single SMTP connection.
35697
35698
35699
35700 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35701 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35702
35703 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35704 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35705 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
35706 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35707 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35708 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35709 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35710 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35711 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35712 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35713 messages this way.
35714
35715 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35716 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35717 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35718 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35719 email is not desirable.
35720
35721 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35722 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35723 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35724 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35725 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35726 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35727 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35728
35729 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35730 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35731 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35732 before sending a message to the smart host.
35733
35734 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35735 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35736 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35737
35738 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35739 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35740 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35741 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35742 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35743 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35744 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35745
35746 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35747 following ways:
35748
35749 .ilist
35750 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35751 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35752 .next
35753 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35754 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35755 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35756 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35757 successful, a zero return code is given.
35758 .next
35759 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35760 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35761 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35762 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35763 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35764 are.
35765 .next
35766 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35767 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35768 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35769 .next
35770 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35771 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35772 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35773 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35774 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35775 .next
35776 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35777 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35778 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35779 .next
35780 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35781 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35782 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35783 are ever generated.
35784 .next
35785 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35786 .next
35787 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35788 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35789 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35790 .endlist
35791
35792 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35793 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35794 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35795 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35796 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35797 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35798
35799
35800
35801
35802 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35803 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35804
35805 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35806 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35807 .cindex "log" "types of"
35808 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35809 and the panic log:
35810
35811 .ilist
35812 .cindex "main log"
35813 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35814 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35815 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35816 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35817 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35818 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35819 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35820 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35821 .next
35822 .cindex "reject log"
35823 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35824 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35825 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35826 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35827 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35828 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35829 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35830 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35831 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35832 false.
35833 .next
35834 .cindex "panic log"
35835 .cindex "system log"
35836 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35837 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35838 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35839 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35840 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35841 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35842 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35843 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35844 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35845 .endlist
35846
35847 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35848 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35849 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35850 .code
35851 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35852 by QUIT
35853 .endd
35854 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35855 ways of changing this:
35856
35857 .ilist
35858 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35859 you set
35860 .code
35861 timezone = UTC
35862 .endd
35863 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35864 .next
35865 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35866 example:
35867 .code
35868 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35869 .endd
35870 .endlist
35871
35872 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35873 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35874 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35875 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35876 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35877 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35878
35879
35880
35881
35882 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35883 .cindex "log" "destination"
35884 .cindex "log" "to file"
35885 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35886 .cindex "syslog"
35887 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35888 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35889 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35890 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35891 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35892 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35893 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35894
35895 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35896 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35897 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35898 references to the host name:
35899 .code
35900 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35901 .endd
35902 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35903 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35904 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35905 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35906 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35907 log at all.
35908
35909 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35910 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35911 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35912 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35913 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35914 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35915 implying the use of a default path.
35916
35917 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35918 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35919 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35920 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35921 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35922 equivalent to the setting:
35923 .code
35924 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35925 .endd
35926 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35927 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35928 that is where the logs are written.
35929
35930 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35931 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35932
35933 Here are some examples of possible settings:
35934 .display
35935 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35936 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35937 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35938 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35939 .endd
35940 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35941 error is logged.
35942
35943
35944
35945 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35946 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35947 .cindex "cycling logs"
35948 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35949 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35950 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35951 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35952 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35953 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35954 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35955
35956 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35957 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35958 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35959 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35960 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35961 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35962 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35963 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35964 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35965 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35966 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35967 renamed.
35968
35969
35970
35971 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35972 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35973 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35974 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35975 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35976 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35977 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35978 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35979 .code
35980 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35981 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35982 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35983 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35984 .endd
35985 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35986 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35987 .code
35988 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35989 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35990 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35991 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35992 .endd
35993 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35994 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35995 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35996 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35997
35998 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35999 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36000 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36001 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36002 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36003 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36004 log names:
36005 .code
36006 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36007 /var/log/exim-panic.log
36008 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36009 /var/log/exim/panic
36010 .endd
36011
36012
36013 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36014 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36015 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36016 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36017 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36018 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36019 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36020 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36021 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36022 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36023 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36024 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36025 the time and host name to each line.
36026 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36027
36028 .ilist
36029 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36030 .next
36031 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36032 .next
36033 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36034 .endlist
36035
36036 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36037 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36038 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36039 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36040
36041 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36042 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36043 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36044 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36045 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36046 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36047 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36048 RFC 3164, you should set
36049 .code
36050 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36051 .endd
36052 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36053 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36054
36055 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36056 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36057 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36058 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36059 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36060 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36061 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36062 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36063 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36064 .code
36065 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36066 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36067 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36068 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36069 [5/5] mple>)
36070 .endd
36071 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36072 (LOG_NOTICE):
36073 .code
36074 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36075 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36076 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36077 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36078 [5\18] .example>)
36079 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36080 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36081 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36082 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36083 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36084 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36085 [12\18] F From: <>
36086 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36087 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36088 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36089 [16\18] le>
36090 [17\18] B Bcc:
36091 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36092 .endd
36093 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36094 without modification.
36095
36096 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36097 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36098 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36099 where it is.
36100
36101
36102
36103 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36104 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36105 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36106 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36107 timestamp. The flags are:
36108 .display
36109 &`<=`& message arrival
36110 &`(=`& message fakereject
36111 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36112 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36113 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36114 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36115 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36116 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36117 .endd
36118
36119
36120 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36121 .cindex "log" "reception line"
36122 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36123 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36124 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36125 .code
36126 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36127 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36128 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36129 .endd
36130 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36131 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36132 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36133 .code
36134 R=<message id>
36135 .endd
36136 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36137
36138 .cindex "HELO"
36139 .cindex "EHLO"
36140 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36141 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36142 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36143 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36144 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36145 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36146 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36147 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36148 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36149 name in parentheses.
36150
36151 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36152 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36153 the log containing text like these examples:
36154 .code
36155 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36156 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36157 .endd
36158 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36159 on.
36160
36161 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36162 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36163 of Exim.
36164
36165 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
36166 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36167 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36168 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36169 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36170 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36171 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36172 suite that was used.
36173
36174 .cindex log protocol
36175 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36176 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36177 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36178 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36179 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36180 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36181 authenticator name.
36182
36183 .cindex "size" "of message"
36184 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36185 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36186 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36187 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36188 other).
36189
36190 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36191 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36192
36193
36194
36195 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36196 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
36197 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36198 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36199 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36200 to fit it on the page:
36201 .code
36202 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36203 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
36204 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36205 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36206 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36207 .endd
36208 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36209 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36210 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36211 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36212 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36213
36214 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36215 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36216 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36217 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36218
36219 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36220 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36221 .display
36222 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36223 .endd
36224 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36225 parentheses afterwards.
36226
36227 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36228 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36229 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36230 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36231 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36232 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36233 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36234 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36235 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36236 TLS cipher information is still available.
36237
36238 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36239 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36240 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36241 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36242 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36243
36244 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36245 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36246
36247 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36248 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36249
36250
36251 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36252 .cindex "discarded messages"
36253 .cindex "message" "discarded"
36254 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36255 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36256 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36257 .code
36258 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36259 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36260 .endd
36261 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36262 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36263 .code
36264 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36265 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36266 .endd
36267
36268
36269 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36270 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36271 .code
36272 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36273 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36274 .endd
36275 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36276 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36277 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36278 .code
36279 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36280 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36281 .endd
36282 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36283 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36284 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36285
36286
36287
36288 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36289 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36290 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36291 following form is logged:
36292 .code
36293 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36294 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36295 .endd
36296 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36297 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36298 .code
36299 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36300 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36301 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36302 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36303 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36304 .endd
36305 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36306 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36307 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36308 flagged with &`**`&.
36309
36310
36311
36312 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36313 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36314 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36315 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36316 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36317
36318
36319
36320 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
36321 A line of the form
36322 .code
36323 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36324 .endd
36325 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36326 at the end of its processing.
36327
36328
36329
36330
36331 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36332 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36333 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36334 the following table:
36335 .display
36336 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36337 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36338 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36339 &`CV `& certificate verification status
36340 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36341 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
36342 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36343 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36344 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
36345 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
36346 &`H `& host name and IP address
36347 &`I `& local interface used
36348 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36349 &`id `& message id for incoming message
36350 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36351 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36352 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36353 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36354 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36355 &`Q `& alternate queue name
36356 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36357 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36358 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36359 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36360 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
36361 &`S `& size of message in bytes
36362 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36363 &`ST `& shadow transport name
36364 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36365 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
36366 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36367 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36368 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
36369 .endd
36370
36371
36372 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36373 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36374 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36375
36376 .ilist
36377 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36378 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36379 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36380 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36381 during the first delivery attempt.
36382 .next
36383 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36384 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36385 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36386 .next
36387 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36388 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36389 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36390 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36391 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36392 doing.
36393 .next
36394 .cindex "error" "ignored"
36395 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36396 message:
36397 .olist
36398 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36399 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36400 .next
36401 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36402 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36403 .next
36404 A delivery set up by a router configured with
36405 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36406 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36407 .code
36408 errors_to = <>
36409 .endd
36410 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36411 .endlist olist
36412 .next
36413 .new
36414 .cindex DKIM "log line"
36415 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
36416 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
36417 .wen
36418 .endlist ilist
36419
36420
36421
36422
36423
36424 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36425 .cindex "log" "selectors"
36426 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36427 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36428 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36429 example:
36430 .code
36431 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36432 .endd
36433 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36434 selection marked by asterisks:
36435 .display
36436 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36437 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36438 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36439 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36440 &` arguments `& command line arguments
36441 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36442 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36443 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36444 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36445 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
36446 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
36447 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36448 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36449 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36450 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36451 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36452 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36453 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36454 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36455 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
36456 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36457 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36458 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36459 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36460 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36461 &` pid `& Exim process id
36462 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36463 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36464 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36465 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36466 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36467 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36468 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36469 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36470 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36471 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36472 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36473 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36474 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36475 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36476 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36477 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36478 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36479 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36480 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36481 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36482 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36483 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36484 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36485
36486 &` all `& all of the above
36487 .endd
36488 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36489 section &<<SECID99>>&
36490
36491 More details on each of these items follows:
36492
36493 .ilist
36494 .cindex "8BITMIME"
36495 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36496 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36497 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36498 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36499 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36500 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36501 .next
36502 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36503 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36504 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36505 this log selector is set.
36506 .next
36507 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
36508 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36509 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36510 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36511 such users cannot access the log).
36512 .next
36513 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
36514 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36515 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36516 parentheses between them.
36517 .next
36518 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36519 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36520 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36521 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36522 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36523 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36524 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36525 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36526 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36527 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36528 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36529 between the caller and Exim.
36530 .next
36531 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36532 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36533 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36534 .next
36535 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36536 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36537 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36538 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36539 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36540 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36541 .next
36542 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36543 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36544 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36545 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36546 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
36547 .next
36548 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36549 .cindex "size" "of message"
36550 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36551 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36552 .next
36553 .new
36554 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36555 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36556 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
36557 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
36558 .next
36559 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36560 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36561 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
36562 .wen
36563 .next
36564 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36565 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36566 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
36567 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36568 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36569 .next
36570 .cindex log dnssec
36571 .cindex dnssec logging
36572 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36573 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36574 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36575 It does not cover helo-name verification.
36576 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36577 .next
36578 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36579 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36580 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36581 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36582 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36583 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36584 .next
36585 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36586 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36587 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36588 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36589 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36590 .next
36591 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36592 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36593 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36594 client's ident port times out.
36595 .next
36596 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36597 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36598 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36599 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36600 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36601 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36602 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36603 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36604 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36605 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36606 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36607 .next
36608 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36609 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36610 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36611 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36612 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36613 on a proxied connection
36614 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36615 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36616 .next
36617 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36618 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
36619 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36620 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36621 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36622 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36623 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36624 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36625 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36626 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36627 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36628 .next
36629 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36630 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36631 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36632 .next
36633 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
36634 .cindex millisecond logging
36635 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
36636 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
36637 appended to the seconds value.
36638 .next
36639 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36640 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36641 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36642 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36643 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36644 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36645 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36646 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36647 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36648 .next
36649 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36650 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
36651 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36652 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36653 containing => tags) following the IP address.
36654 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36655 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36656 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36657 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36658 local port is a random ephemeral port.
36659 .next
36660 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36661 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36662 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36663 immediately after the time and date.
36664 .next
36665 .cindex "log" "queue run"
36666 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36667 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36668 .next
36669 .cindex "log" "queue time"
36670 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36671 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36672 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36673 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36674 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36675 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36676 message has been successfully received.
36677 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36678 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
36679 .next
36680 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36681 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36682 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36683 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36684 .new
36685 .next
36686 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
36687 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
36688 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
36689 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36690 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
36691 .wen
36692 .next
36693 .cindex "log" "recipients"
36694 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36695 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36696 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36697 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36698 has taken place.
36699 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36700 in the list.
36701 .next
36702 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
36703 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36704 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36705 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36706 .next
36707 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36708 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36709 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36710 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36711 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36712 .next
36713 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
36714 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36715 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36716 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36717 attempt.
36718 .next
36719 .cindex "log" "return path"
36720 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36721 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36722 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36723 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36724 .next
36725 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36726 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36727 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36728 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36729 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36730 .next
36731 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36732 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36733 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36734 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36735 detail is lost.
36736 .next
36737 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
36738 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36739 it is too big.
36740 .next
36741 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36742 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36743 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36744 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36745 it.
36746 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36747 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36748 .next
36749 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36750 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36751 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36752 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36753 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36754 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36755 response.
36756 .next
36757 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36758 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36759 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36760 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36761 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36762 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36763 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36764 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36765 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36766 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36767
36768 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36769 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36770 reset if the daemon is restarted.
36771 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36772 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36773 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36774 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36775 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36776 .next
36777 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36778 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36779 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36780 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36781 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36782 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36783 .next
36784 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36785 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36786 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36787 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36788 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36789 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36790 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36791 already have their own log lines.
36792
36793 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36794 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36795 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36796 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36797 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36798 the same logging options.
36799
36800 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36801 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36802 .code
36803 C=EHLO,QUIT
36804 .endd
36805 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36806 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36807 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36808 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36809 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36810 .next
36811 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36812 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36813 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36814 was accepted or used.
36815 .next
36816 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36817 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36818 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36819 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36820 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36821 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36822 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36823 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36824 .next
36825 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36826 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36827 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36828 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36829 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36830 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36831 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36832 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36833 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36834 .next
36835 .cindex "log" "subject"
36836 .cindex "subject, logging"
36837 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36838 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36839 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36840 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36841 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36842 .next
36843 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36844 .cindex log DANE
36845 .cindex DANE logging
36846 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36847 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36848 verified
36849 .new
36850 using a CA trust anchor,
36851 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
36852 .wen
36853 and &`CV=no`& if not.
36854 .next
36855 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36856 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36857 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36858 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36859 .next
36860 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36861 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36862 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36863 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36864 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36865 .next
36866 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36867 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36868 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36869 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36870 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36871 .next
36872 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36873 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36874 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36875 .endlist
36876
36877
36878 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36879 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36880 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36881 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36882 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36883 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36884 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36885 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36886 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36887 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36888 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36889 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36890 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36891
36892 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36893 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36894 &%message_logs%& option false.
36895 .ecindex IIDloggen
36896
36897
36898
36899
36900 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36901 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36902
36903 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36904 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36905 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36906 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36907 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36908
36909 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36910 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36911 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36912 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36913 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36914 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36915 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36916 various criteria"
36917 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36918 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36919 "extract statistics from the log"
36920 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36921 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36922 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36923 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36924 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36925 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36926 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36927 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36928 .endtable
36929
36930 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36931 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36932 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36933
36934
36935
36936
36937 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36938 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36939 .cindex "process, querying"
36940 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
36941 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36942 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36943 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36944 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36945 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36946 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36947 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36948 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36949
36950 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36951 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36952 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36953
36954
36955 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36956 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36957 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36958 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
36959 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
36960 options:
36961 .display
36962 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
36963 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
36964 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
36965 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
36966 .endd
36967 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
36968 .code
36969 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
36970 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
36971 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
36972 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
36973 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
36974 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
36975 .endd
36976 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
36977 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
36978
36979
36980
36981 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
36982 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
36983 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
36984 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
36985 .code
36986 exim -bpu
36987 .endd
36988 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
36989 .code
36990 exim -bp
36991 .endd
36992 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
36993 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
36994
36995 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
36996 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
36997
36998 .vlist
36999 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37000 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37001 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37002 .code
37003 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
37004 .endd
37005 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37006 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37007 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37008
37009 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37010 Match against the size field.
37011
37012 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37013 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37014
37015 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37016 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37017
37018 .vitem &*-z*&
37019 Match only frozen messages.
37020
37021 .vitem &*-x*&
37022 Match only non-frozen messages.
37023 .endlist
37024
37025 The following options control the format of the output:
37026
37027 .vlist
37028 .vitem &*-c*&
37029 Display only the count of matching messages.
37030
37031 .vitem &*-l*&
37032 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37033 the default.
37034
37035 .vitem &*-i*&
37036 Display message ids only.
37037
37038 .vitem &*-b*&
37039 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37040
37041 .vitem &*-R*&
37042 Display messages in reverse order.
37043
37044 .vitem &*-a*&
37045 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37046 .endlist
37047
37048 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37049
37050
37051
37052 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37053 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37054 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37055 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37056 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
37057 running a command such as
37058 .code
37059 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37060 .endd
37061 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37062 it, as in the following example:
37063 .code
37064 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37065 .endd
37066 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37067 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37068 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37069 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37070
37071 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37072 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37073 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37074 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37075 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37076 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37077 sender.
37078
37079 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37080 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37081 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37082 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37083 level"& addresses).
37084
37085
37086
37087
37088 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37089 "SECTextspeinf"
37090 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37091 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37092 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37093 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37094 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37095 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37096 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37097 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37098 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37099 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37100 .display
37101 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37102 .endd
37103 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37104
37105 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37106 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37107 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
37108
37109 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37110 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37111 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37112 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37113 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37114
37115 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37116 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37117 regular expression.
37118
37119 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37120 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37121
37122 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37123 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37124 normally.
37125
37126 Example of &%-M%&:
37127 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37128 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37129 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37130 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37131 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37132 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37133 search term.
37134
37135 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37136 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37137 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37138 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37139 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37140
37141
37142 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37143 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
37144 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37145 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37146 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37147 the &%--help%& option.
37148
37149
37150 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37151 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37152 .cindex "cycling logs"
37153 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37154 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37155 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37156 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37157 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37158 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37159 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37160 .ilist
37161 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37162 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37163 .next
37164 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37165 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37166 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37167 configuration.
37168 .endlist
37169
37170 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37171 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37172 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37173 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37174 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37175 logs are handled similarly.
37176
37177 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37178 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37179 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37180 any existing log files.
37181
37182 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37183 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37184 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37185 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37186 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37187 .code
37188 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37189 .endd
37190 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37191 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37192
37193
37194
37195 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37196 .cindex "statistics"
37197 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37198 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37199 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37200 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
37201 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
37202
37203 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37204 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37205 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37206 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37207 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37208 .code
37209 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37210 .endd
37211 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37212 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37213 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37214 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37215 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37216 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37217 also produced per user.
37218
37219 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37220 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37221 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37222 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37223 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37224
37225 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37226 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37227 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37228 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37229 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37230 an entirely separate message.
37231
37232 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37233 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37234 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37235 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37236 least one address that failed.
37237
37238 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37239 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37240 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37241 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
37242 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37243 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37244 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37245
37246 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37247 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37248 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37249
37250 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37251 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37252 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37253 .code
37254 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37255 .endd
37256
37257 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37258 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37259 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37260 .cindex "checking access"
37261 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37262 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37263 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37264 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37265 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37266 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37267
37268 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37269 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37270 .code
37271 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37272 .endd
37273 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37274 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37275 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37276 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37277 .code
37278 Rejected:
37279 550 Relay not permitted
37280 .endd
37281 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37282 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37283 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37284 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37285 you can use:
37286 .code
37287 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37288 -f himself@there.example
37289 .endd
37290 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37291 mandatory arguments.
37292
37293 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37294 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37295 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37296
37297
37298
37299 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37300 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37301 .cindex "building DBM files"
37302 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37303 .cindex "lower casing"
37304 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37305 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37306 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37307 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37308 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37309 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37310
37311 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37312 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37313 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37314 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37315 files.
37316
37317 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
37318 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
37319 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
37320 well.
37321
37322 .cindex "USE_DB"
37323 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
37324 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
37325 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
37326 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
37327 .code
37328 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
37329 .endd
37330 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
37331 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
37332
37333 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
37334 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
37335 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
37336 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
37337 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
37338 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
37339
37340 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
37341 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
37342 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
37343 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
37344 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
37345 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
37346 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
37347 return code is 2.
37348
37349
37350
37351
37352 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
37353 .cindex "retry" "times"
37354 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
37355 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
37356 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
37357 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
37358 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
37359 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
37360 output. For example:
37361 .code
37362 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
37363 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
37364 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37365 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37366 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
37367 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
37368 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
37369 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
37370 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
37371 past final cutoff time
37372 .endd
37373 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
37374 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
37375 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
37376 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
37377 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
37378 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
37379 run very often.
37380
37381 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
37382 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
37383 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
37384 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
37385 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
37386 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
37387
37388
37389
37390 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
37391 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
37392 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
37393 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
37394 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37395 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37396 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37397
37398 .ilist
37399 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
37400 .next
37401 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37402 for remote hosts
37403 .next
37404 &'callout'&: the callout cache
37405 .next
37406 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37407 .next
37408 &'misc'&: other hints data
37409 .endlist
37410
37411 The &'misc'& database is used for
37412
37413 .ilist
37414 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37415 .next
37416 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37417 &(smtp)& transport)
37418 .next
37419 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37420 in a transport)
37421 .endlist
37422
37423
37424
37425 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37426 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37427 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37428 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37429 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37430 .code
37431 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37432 .endd
37433 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37434 .code
37435 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
37436 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37437 .endd
37438 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37439 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37440 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37441 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37442 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37443 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37444 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37445 and a textual description of the error.
37446
37447 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37448 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37449 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37450 exceeded.
37451
37452 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37453 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37454 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37455 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37456 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37457 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37458 cross-references.
37459
37460
37461
37462 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37463 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37464 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37465 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37466 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37467 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37468 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37469 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37470 updated sufficiently often.
37471
37472 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37473 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37474 the retry database:
37475 .code
37476 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37477 .endd
37478 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37479 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37480 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37481 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37482 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37483 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37484 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37485 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37486 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37487 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37488 whenever it removes information from the database.
37489
37490 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37491 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37492 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37493 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37494 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37495
37496 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37497 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37498 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37499 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37500 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37501 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37502 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37503 tidied.
37504
37505 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37506 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37507
37508
37509
37510
37511 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37512 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37513 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37514 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37515 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37516 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37517 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37518 displayed.
37519
37520 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37521 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37522 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37523 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37524 by new data, for example:
37525 .code
37526 > 4 951102:1000
37527 .endd
37528 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37529 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37530 used as optional separators.
37531
37532
37533
37534
37535 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37536 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37537 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37538 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
37539 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37540 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37541 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37542 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37543 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37544 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37545 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37546 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37547 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37548
37549 .vlist
37550 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
37551 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37552
37553 .vitem &%-flock%&
37554 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37555 supports it.
37556
37557 .vitem &%-interval%&
37558 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37559 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37560
37561 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
37562 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37563
37564 .vitem &%-mbx%&
37565 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37566
37567 .vitem &%-q%&
37568 Suppress verification output.
37569
37570 .vitem &%-retries%&
37571 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37572 the lock (default 10).
37573
37574 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
37575 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37576 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37577 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37578 subsequently sees.
37579
37580 .vitem &%-timeout%&
37581 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37582 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37583 default), a non-blocking call is used.
37584
37585 .vitem &%-v%&
37586 Generate verbose output.
37587 .endlist
37588
37589 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37590 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37591 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37592 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37593 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37594 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37595 more than 30 minutes old.
37596
37597 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37598 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37599 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37600 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37601 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37602 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37603
37604 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37605 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37606 suppresses all output except error messages.
37607
37608 A command such as
37609 .code
37610 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37611 .endd
37612 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37613 .display
37614 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37615 <&'some commands'&>
37616 &`End`&
37617 .endd
37618 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37619 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37620 such as
37621 .code
37622 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37623 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37624 .endd
37625 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37626 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37627 .ecindex IIDutils
37628
37629
37630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37631 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37632
37633 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37634 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37635 .cindex "X-windows"
37636 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
37637 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37638 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37639 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37640 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37641 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37642 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37643 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37644
37645
37646
37647 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37648 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37649 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37650 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37651 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37652 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37653 parameters are for.
37654
37655 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37656 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37657 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37658 .code
37659 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37660 .endd
37661 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37662 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37663 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37664 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37665 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37666
37667 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37668 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37669 .code
37670 Eximon*background: gray94
37671 .endd
37672 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37673 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37674 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37675 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37676 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37677 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37678 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37679 .code
37680 xrdb -merge <<End
37681 Eximon*highlight: gray
37682 End
37683 .endd
37684 .cindex "admin user"
37685 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37686 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37687
37688 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37689 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37690 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37691 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37692 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37693
37694 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37695 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37696 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37697 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37698 different parts of the display.
37699
37700
37701
37702
37703 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37704 .cindex "stripchart"
37705 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37706 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37707 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37708 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37709 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37710 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37711 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37712 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37713 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37714
37715 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37716 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37717 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37718 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37719
37720 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37721 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37722 to a single partition.
37723
37724 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37725 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37726 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37727 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37728 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37729 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37730 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37731
37732
37733
37734
37735 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37736 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37737 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37738 .cindex "window size"
37739 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37740 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37741 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37742 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37743 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37744 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37745
37746 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37747 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37748 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37749 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37750
37751 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37752 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37753 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37754 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37755 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37756 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37757
37758 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37759 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37760 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37761
37762
37763
37764 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
37765 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37766 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37767 the main log is maintained.
37768 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37769 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37770 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37771 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37772 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37773
37774 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37775 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37776 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37777 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37778 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37779 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37780 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37781 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37782 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37783 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37784 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37785
37786 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37787 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37788 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37789 It cannot go further back up the log.
37790
37791 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37792 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37793 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37794 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37795 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37796 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37797
37798 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37799 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37800 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37801 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37802 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37803 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37804
37805 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37806 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37807 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37808 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37809 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37810 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37811 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37812 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37813 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37814 window.
37815
37816
37817
37818 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37819 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37820 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37821 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37822 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37823 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37824 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37825 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37826 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37827 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37828
37829 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37830 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37831 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37832 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37833 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37834 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37835 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37836
37837 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37838 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37839 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37840 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37841 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37842 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37843 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37844
37845 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37846 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37847 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37848 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37849
37850 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37851 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37852 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37853 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37854 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37855 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37856 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37857 not shown.
37858
37859 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37860 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37861
37862 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37863 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37864 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37865 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37866 display is updated.
37867
37868
37869
37870 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37871 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37872 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37873 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37874 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37875 any selected text.
37876
37877 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37878 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37879 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37880 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37881 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37882 .code
37883 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37884 .endd
37885 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37886 follows:
37887
37888 .ilist
37889 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37890 in a new text window.
37891 .next
37892 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37893 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37894 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37895 .next
37896 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37897 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37898 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37899 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37900 .next
37901 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37902 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37903 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37904 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37905 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37906 .next
37907 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37908 that the message be frozen.
37909 .next
37910 .cindex "thawing messages"
37911 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37912 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37913 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37914 that the message be thawed.
37915 .next
37916 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37917 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37918 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37919 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37920 .next
37921 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37922 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37923 message.
37924 .next
37925 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37926 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37927 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37928 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37929 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37930 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37931 which case no action is taken.
37932 .next
37933 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37934 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37935 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37936 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37937 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37938 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37939 case no action is taken.
37940 .next
37941 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37942 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37943 .next
37944 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37945 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37946 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37947 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37948 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37949 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37950 the address is qualified with that domain.
37951 .endlist
37952
37953 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37954 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37955 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37956 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37957 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37958 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
37959 if no output is generated.
37960
37961 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
37962 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
37963 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
37964 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
37965
37966 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
37967 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
37968 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
37969 .ecindex IIDeximon
37970
37971
37972
37973
37974
37975 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37976 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37977
37978 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
37979 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
37980 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
37981 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
37982
37983 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
37984 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
37985 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
37986 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
37987 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
37988 its security as compared with other MTAs.
37989
37990 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
37991 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
37992 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
37993 as soon as possible.
37994
37995
37996 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
37997 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
37998 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
37999 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38000 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38001 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38002
38003 .ilist
38004 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38005 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
38006 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
38007 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38008 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38009 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38010
38011 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38012 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38013 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38014 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38015 .next
38016
38017 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38018 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38019 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38020 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38021 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38022 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38023 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38024 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38025 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38026 separate commands.
38027
38028 .next
38029 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38030 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38031 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38032 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38033 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38034 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38035 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38036 .next
38037 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38038 is disabled.
38039 .next
38040 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38041 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38042 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38043 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38044 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38045 .endlist
38046
38047
38048
38049 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38050 .cindex "setuid"
38051 .cindex "root privilege"
38052 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38053 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38054 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38055 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38056 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38057 is required for two things:
38058
38059 .ilist
38060 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38061 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38062 not required.
38063 .next
38064 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38065 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38066 configuration.
38067 .endlist
38068
38069 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38070 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38071 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38072 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38073 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38074 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
38075 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38076 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38077
38078 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38079 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38080 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38081
38082 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38083 uid and gid in the following cases:
38084
38085 .ilist
38086 .oindex "&%-C%&"
38087 .oindex "&%-D%&"
38088 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38089 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38090 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38091 the calling process.
38092 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38093 option may not be used at all.
38094 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38095 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38096 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38097 .next
38098 .oindex "&%-be%&"
38099 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
38100 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
38101 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38102 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38103 calling process.
38104 .next
38105 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38106 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38107 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38108 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38109 testing address verification
38110 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
38111 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
38112 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38113 option).
38114 .next
38115 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38116 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38117 .endlist
38118
38119 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38120
38121 .ilist
38122 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38123 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38124 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38125 will be used during message reception.
38126 .next
38127 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38128 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38129 .next
38130 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38131 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38132 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38133 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38134 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38135 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38136 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38137 generating bounce and warning messages.
38138
38139 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38140 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38141 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38142 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38143 .next
38144 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38145 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38146 .endlist
38147
38148
38149
38150
38151 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38152 .cindex "privilege, running without"
38153 .cindex "unprivileged running"
38154 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38155 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38156 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38157 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38158 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38159 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38160 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38161 to any other uid.
38162
38163 .cindex SIGHUP
38164 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38165 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38166 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38167 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38168
38169 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38170 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38171 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38172 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38173 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38174
38175 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38176 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38177 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38178 effect.
38179
38180 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38181 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38182 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38183
38184 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38185 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38186 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38187 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38188 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38189 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38190 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38191 address this problem at this time.
38192
38193 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38194 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38195 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38196 be used in the most straightforward way.
38197
38198 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38199 number of restrictions on what you can do:
38200
38201 .ilist
38202 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38203 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38204 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38205 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38206 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38207 .next
38208 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38209 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38210 .next
38211 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38212 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38213 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38214 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38215 .next
38216 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38217 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38218
38219 .olist
38220 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38221 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38222 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38223 .next
38224 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38225 owned by the Exim user.
38226 .next
38227 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38228 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38229 mailboxes need to be created manually.
38230 .endlist olist
38231 .endlist ilist
38232
38233
38234 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38235 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38236 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38237 gives more security at essentially no cost.
38238
38239 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38240 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38241
38242
38243
38244
38245 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38246 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38247 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38248
38249
38250
38251 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38252 .cindex "security" "local commands"
38253 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38254 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38255 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38256 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38257 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38258
38259 .ilist
38260 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38261 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38262 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38263 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38264 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38265 .next
38266 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38267 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38268 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38269 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38270 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38271 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38272 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38273 .next
38274 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38275 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38276 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38277 .next
38278 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38279 taint checking might apply to their usage.
38280 .next
38281 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38282 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38283 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38284 .next
38285 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38286 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38287 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38288 of opaque strings.
38289 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38290 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38291 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38292 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38293 .endlist
38294
38295
38296
38297
38298 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38299 .cindex "security" "data sources"
38300 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38301 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38302 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
38303 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38304 are some issues to be aware of:
38305
38306 .ilist
38307 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38308 .next
38309 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38310 .next
38311 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38312 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38313 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38314 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38315 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38316 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
38317 data.
38318 .next
38319 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
38320 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
38321 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
38322 .next
38323 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
38324 expected to yield one result.
38325 .endlist
38326
38327
38328
38329
38330 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
38331 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
38332 .cindex "IP source routing"
38333 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
38334 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
38335 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
38336 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
38337
38338
38339
38340 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
38341 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
38342 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
38343
38344
38345
38346
38347 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
38348 .cindex "trusted users"
38349 .cindex "admin user"
38350 .cindex "privileged user"
38351 .cindex "user" "trusted"
38352 .cindex "user" "admin"
38353 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
38354 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
38355 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
38356 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
38357 permit a remote host to be specified.
38358
38359 .oindex "&%-f%&"
38360 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
38361 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
38362 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
38363 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
38364 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
38365 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
38366
38367 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
38368 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
38369 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
38370 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
38371 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
38372
38373 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
38374 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
38375 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
38376 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
38377 includes the contents of files on the spool.
38378
38379 .oindex "&%-M%&"
38380 .oindex "&%-q%&"
38381 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
38382 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
38383 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
38384 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
38385 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
38386 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
38387
38388 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
38389 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
38390 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
38391 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
38392 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
38393 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
38394 files.
38395
38396 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38397 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38398 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38399 This affects most of the checking options,
38400 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38401
38402
38403 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38404 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
38405 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38406 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38407 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38408 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38409
38410
38411
38412 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38413 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38414 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38415 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38416 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38417 this.
38418
38419
38420
38421 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38422 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38423 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38424 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38425 converted output.
38426
38427
38428
38429 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38430 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38431 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38432 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38433 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38434
38435
38436
38437 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38438 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38439 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38440 loading it.
38441
38442
38443 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38444 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38445 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38446 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38447 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38448 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38449 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38450
38451 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38452 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38453 string.
38454
38455
38456
38457 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38458 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38459 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38460 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38461
38462
38463
38464 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38465 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38466 enough to hold the result.
38467 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
38468
38469
38470
38471
38472 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38473 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38474
38475 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38476 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38477 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38478 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38479 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
38480 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38481 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38482 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38483 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38484 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38485 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38486 themselves are recoverable.
38487
38488 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38489 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38490 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38491
38492 .ilist
38493 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38494 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38495 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38496 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38497 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38498 .next
38499 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38500 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38501 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38502 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38503 .next
38504 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38505 .next
38506 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38507 signature.
38508 .endlist
38509 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38510
38511 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38512 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38513 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38514 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38515 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38516 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38517 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38518 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38519 attempt.
38520
38521 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38522 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38523 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38524 relics of crashes and can be removed.
38525
38526 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38527 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38528 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38529 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38530 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38531 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38532 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38533 normally the Exim user.
38534
38535 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38536 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38537 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38538 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38539 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38540 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38541 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38542 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38543
38544 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38545 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38546 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38547 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38548
38549 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38550 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38551
38552 .vlist
38553 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38554 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38555 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38556 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38557 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38558 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38559 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38560 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38561 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38562 newlines.
38563
38564 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38565 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38566 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38567 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38568 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38569 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38570
38571 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38572 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38573 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38574 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38575 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38576 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38577
38578 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38579 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38580 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38581
38582 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38583 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38584 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38585 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38586 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38587
38588 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38589 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38590 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38591 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38592 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38593
38594 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38595 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38596 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38597
38598 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38599 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38600 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38601
38602 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38603 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38604 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38605
38606 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38607 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38608 present if the number is greater than zero.
38609
38610 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38611 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38612 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38613
38614 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38615 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38616 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38617
38618 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38619 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38620 command.
38621
38622 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38623 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38624 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38625 messages.
38626
38627 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38628 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38629 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38630 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38631
38632 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38633 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38634 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38635
38636 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38637 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38638 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38639 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38640 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38641 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38642
38643 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38644 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38645 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38646 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38647 supplied by the remote host, if any.
38648
38649 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38650 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38651 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38652 generated messages.
38653
38654 .vitem &%-local%&
38655 The message is from a local sender.
38656
38657 .vitem &%-localerror%&
38658 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38659
38660 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38661 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38662 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38663 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38664
38665 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38666 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38667 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38668
38669 .vitem &%-N%&
38670 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38671 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38672 &%-N%& is assumed.
38673
38674 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38675 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38676 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38677
38678 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38679 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38680 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38681
38682 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38683 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38684 of &$spam_score_int$&.
38685
38686 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38687 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38688 rather than Unix-format.
38689 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38690 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38691
38692 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38693 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38694 certificate was verified by the server.
38695
38696 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38697 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38698 name of the cipher suite that was used.
38699
38700 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38701 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38702 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38703 certificate.
38704 .endlist
38705
38706 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38707 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38708 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38709 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38710 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38711 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38712 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38713 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38714 addresses are complete.
38715
38716 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38717 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38718 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38719 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38720 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38721 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38722 .code
38723 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38724 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38725 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38726 .endd
38727 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38728 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38729 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38730 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38731 example:
38732 .code
38733 4
38734 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38735 darcy@austen.fict.example
38736 rdo@foundation
38737 alice@wonderland.fict.example
38738 .endd
38739 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38740 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38741 line is of the following form:
38742 .display
38743 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38744 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38745 .endd
38746 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38747 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38748 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38749 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38750 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38751 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38752 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38753 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38754
38755
38756 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38757 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38758 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38759 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38760 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38761 following:
38762
38763 .table2 50pt
38764 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38765 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38766 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38767 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38768 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38769 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38770 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38771 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38772 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38773 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38774 .endtable
38775
38776 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38777 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38778 typical set of headers:
38779 .code
38780 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38781 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38782 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38783 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38784 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38785 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38786 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38787 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38788 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38789 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38790 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38791 .endd
38792 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38793 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38794 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38795 .ecindex IIDforspo1
38796 .ecindex IIDforspo2
38797 .ecindex IIDforspo3
38798
38799 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
38800 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
38801 an ASCII newline character.
38802 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
38803 can have an alternate format.
38804 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
38805 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
38806 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
38807 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
38808 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
38809 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
38810
38811 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38812 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38813
38814 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38815 "DKIM and SPF Support"
38816 .cindex "DKIM"
38817
38818 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
38819
38820 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38821 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38822 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38823 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
38824
38825 .new
38826 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
38827 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
38828 any original DKIM signature.
38829 .wen
38830
38831 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38832 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38833
38834 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
38835 .olist
38836 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38837 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38838 (including transport filters)
38839 except cutthrough delivery.
38840 .next
38841 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38842 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38843 different signature contexts.
38844 .endlist
38845
38846 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38847 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38848 Exim's standard controls.
38849
38850 .new
38851 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38852 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
38853
38854 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
38855 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
38856 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38857 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38858 .code
38859 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38860 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38861 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38862 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38863 .endd
38864 .wen
38865
38866 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38867 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38868 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38869 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38870 senders).
38871
38872
38873 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38874 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38875
38876 .new
38877 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
38878 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38879 .code
38880 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38881
38882 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38883 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38884 .endd
38885
38886 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
38887 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
38888 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
38889 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
38890 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
38891 .wen
38892
38893 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38894 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38895
38896 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
38897 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
38898 After expansion, this can be a list.
38899 Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
38900 while expanding the remaining signing options.
38901 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
38902 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38903
38904 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
38905 This sets the key selector string.
38906 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
38907 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
38908 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38909 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38910 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
38911 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38912
38913 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38914 This sets the private key to use.
38915 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38916 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38917 The result can either
38918 .ilist
38919 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
38920 .new
38921 .next
38922 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
38923 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
38924 .wen
38925 .next
38926 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38927 the private key
38928 .next
38929 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38930 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38931 is set.
38932 .endlist
38933
38934 .new
38935 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38936 .code
38937 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38938 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38939 .endd
38940
38941 Support for EC keys is being developed under
38942 &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-dcrup-dkim-crypto/).
38943 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
38944 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
38945 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
38946 for some transition period.
38947 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
38948 for EC keys.
38949 .wen
38950
38951 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
38952 Can be set alternatively to &"sha1"& to use an alternate hash
38953 method.
38954
38955 .new
38956 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38957 .code
38958 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38959 .endd
38960 .wen
38961
38962 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
38963 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
38964 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
38965 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
38966 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
38967 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
38968
38969 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
38970 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
38971 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
38972 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
38973 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
38974
38975 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
38976 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
38977 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
38978 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
38979 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
38980 variables here.
38981
38982 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
38983 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
38984 list of header names.
38985 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
38986 in the message signature.
38987 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
38988 whether or not each header is present in the message.
38989 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
38990 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
38991
38992 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
38993 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
38994 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
38995
38996 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
38997 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
38998 will be signed.
38999 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39000 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39001 name will be appended.
39002
39003
39004 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39005 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39006
39007 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is implemented via the
39008 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
39009 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39010 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39011 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39012 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39013 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39014
39015 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
39016 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39017 runtime of the ACL.
39018
39019 .new
39020 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39021 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39022 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39023 .wen
39024
39025 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39026 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39027 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39028 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39029
39030 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39031 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39032 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39033 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39034 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39035 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39036 it defaults as:
39037 .code
39038 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39039 .endd
39040 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39041 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39042 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39043 .code
39044 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39045 .endd
39046 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39047 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39048 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39049 .code
39050 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39051 .endd
39052
39053 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39054 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39055
39056 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39057 for each matching signature.
39058
39059
39060 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39061 available (from most to least important):
39062
39063
39064 .vlist
39065 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39066 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39067 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39068 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39069
39070 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39071 Within the DKIM ACL,
39072 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39073 .ilist
39074 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39075 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39076 .next
39077 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39078 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39079 .next
39080 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39081 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39082 .next
39083 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39084 .endlist
39085
39086 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39087 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39088 hash-method or key-size:
39089 .code
39090 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39091 condition = ${if eq {$len_3:$dkim_algo}{rsa}}
39092 condition = ${if or {eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39093 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}} }
39094 logwrite = NOTE: forcing dkim verify fail (was pass)
39095 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39096 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39097 .endd
39098
39099 After all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39100 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39101
39102 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39103 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39104 "fail" or "invalid". One of
39105 .ilist
39106 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39107 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39108 .next
39109 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39110 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39111 .next
39112 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39113 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39114 means that the message body was modified in transit.
39115 .next
39116 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39117 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39118 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39119 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39120 .endlist
39121
39122 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39123
39124 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39125 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39126 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39127 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39128
39129 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39130 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39131 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39132 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39133
39134 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39135 The key record selector string.
39136
39137 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39138 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39139 .new
39140 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39141 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39142 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39143 for EC keys.
39144 .wen
39145
39146 .new
39147 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39148 .code
39149 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39150
39151 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39152 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39153 .endd
39154
39155 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39156 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39157 .wen
39158
39159 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39160 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39161
39162 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39163 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39164
39165 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39166 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39167 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39168 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39169 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39170 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39171
39172 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39173 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39174 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39175 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39176
39177 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39178 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39179 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39180
39181 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39182 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39183 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39184 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39185 integer size comparisons against this value.
39186 .new
39187 Note that Exim does not check this value.
39188 .wen
39189
39190 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39191 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39192
39193 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39194 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39195
39196 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39197 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39198
39199 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39200 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39201 in the key record.
39202
39203 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39204 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39205 in the key record.
39206
39207 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39208 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39209
39210 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39211 Number of bits in the key.
39212
39213 .new
39214 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39215 .code
39216 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39217 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39218 .endd
39219
39220 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39221 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39222 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39223 .wen
39224
39225 .endlist
39226
39227 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39228
39229 .vlist
39230 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39231 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39232 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39233 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39234 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39235
39236 .code
39237 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39238 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39239 sender_domains = gmail.com
39240 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39241 dkim_status = none
39242 .endd
39243
39244 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
39245 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
39246
39247 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
39248 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
39249 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
39250 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
39251
39252 .code
39253 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
39254 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
39255 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
39256 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
39257 .endd
39258
39259 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
39260 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
39261 for more information of what they mean.
39262 .endlist
39263
39264
39265
39266
39267 .new
39268 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
39269 .cindex SPF verification
39270
39271 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
39272 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
39273 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
39274
39275 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
39276 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
39277
39278 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
39279 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
39280 &url(http://www.libspf2.org/).
39281 There is no Exim involvement on the trasmission of messages; publishing certain
39282 DNS records is all that is required.
39283
39284 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
39285 .new
39286 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39287 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39288 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39289 .wen
39290
39291
39292 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39293 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
39294 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
39295 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
39296 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
39297 Valid strings are:
39298 .vlist
39299 .vitem &%pass%&
39300 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
39301
39302 .vitem &%fail%&
39303 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
39304 domain in the envelope-from address.
39305
39306 .vitem &%softfail%&
39307 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
39308 is a forgery.
39309
39310 .vitem &%none%&
39311 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
39312
39313 .vitem &%neutral%&
39314 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
39315 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
39316 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
39317
39318 .vitem &%permerror%&
39319 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
39320 You may deny messages when this occurs. (Changed in 4.83)
39321
39322 .vitem &%temperror%&
39323 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
39324 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
39325 (Changed in 4.83)
39326
39327 .vitem &%err_temp%&
39328 Same as permerror, deprecated in 4.83, will be removed in a future release.
39329
39330 .vitem &%err_perm%&
39331 Same as temperror, deprecated in 4.83, will be removed in a future release.
39332 .endlist
39333
39334 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
39335 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
39336 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
39337 short-circuit fashion.
39338
39339 Example:
39340 .code
39341 deny spf = fail
39342 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
39343 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
39344 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
39345 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
39346 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
39347 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
39348 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
39349 ip=$sender_host_address
39350 .endd
39351
39352 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
39353 variables:
39354
39355 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
39356 .vlist
39357 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
39358 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
39359 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
39360 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
39361 it for logging purposes.
39362
39363 .vitem &$spf_received$&
39364 .vindex &$spf_received$&
39365 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
39366 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
39367 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
39368 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
39369
39370 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
39371 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
39372
39373 .vitem &$spf_result$&
39374 .vindex &$spf_result$&
39375 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
39376 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
39377 temperror.
39378
39379 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
39380 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
39381 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
39382 and required in order to obtain a result.
39383
39384 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39385 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39386 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
39387 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
39388 .endlist
39389
39390
39391 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39392 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
39393 .cindex SPF "best guess"
39394 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
39395 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
39396 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
39397 capability.
39398 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
39399 for a description of what it means.
39400
39401 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
39402 of the spf one. For example:
39403
39404 .code
39405 deny spf_guess = fail
39406 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
39407 .endd
39408
39409 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
39410 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
39411 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
39412 reject message.
39413
39414 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
39415 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
39416
39417 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
39418 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
39419 &%spf_guess%& option.
39420 For example, the following:
39421
39422 .code
39423 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
39424 .endd
39425
39426 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
39427
39428
39429 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
39430 .cindex lookup spf
39431 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
39432 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
39433
39434 .code
39435 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
39436 .endd
39437
39438 The lookup will return the same result strings as they can appear in
39439 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
39440 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
39441
39442
39443 . wen-for SPF section
39444 .wen
39445
39446
39447 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39448 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39449
39450 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
39451 "Proxy support"
39452 .cindex "proxy support"
39453 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
39454
39455 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
39456 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
39457
39458
39459 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
39460 .cindex proxy inbound
39461 .cindex proxy "server side"
39462 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
39463 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
39464
39465 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
39466 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
39467 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
39468 in Local/Makefile.
39469
39470 It was built on specifications from:
39471 (&url(http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt)).
39472 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
39473 (&url(http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e)).
39474
39475 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
39476 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
39477 to distribute load.
39478 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
39479 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
39480 There is no logging if a host passes or
39481 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
39482 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
39483
39484 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
39485 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
39486 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
39487 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
39488 automatically determines which version is in use.
39489
39490 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
39491 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
39492 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
39493 Exim and the proxy server.
39494
39495 The following expansion variables are usable
39496 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
39497 of the proxy):
39498 .display
39499 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
39500 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
39501 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
39502 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
39503 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
39504 .endd
39505 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
39506 there was a protocol error.
39507
39508 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
39509 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
39510 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
39511 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
39512 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
39513 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
39514 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
39515 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
39516 A possible solution is:
39517 .display
39518 # Set max number of connections per host
39519 LIMIT = 5
39520 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
39521 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
39522
39523 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
39524 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
39525 .endd
39526
39527
39528
39529 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
39530 .cindex proxy outbound
39531 .cindex proxy "client side"
39532 .cindex proxy SOCKS
39533 .cindex SOCKS proxy
39534 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
39535 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
39536 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
39537 Local/Makefile.
39538
39539 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
39540 on an smtp transport.
39541 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
39542 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
39543 Each proxy specifier is a list
39544 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
39545 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
39546
39547 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
39548 The list of options is in the following table:
39549 .display
39550 &'auth '& authentication method
39551 &'name '& authentication username
39552 &'pass '& authentication password
39553 &'port '& tcp port
39554 &'tmo '& connection timeout
39555 &'pri '& priority
39556 &'weight '& selection bias
39557 .endd
39558
39559 More details on each of these options follows:
39560
39561 .ilist
39562 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
39563 .cindex proxy authentication
39564 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
39565 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
39566 for access to the proxy.
39567 Default is &"none"&.
39568 .next
39569 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
39570 Default is empty.
39571 .next
39572 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
39573 Default is empty.
39574 .next
39575 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
39576 Default is 1080.
39577 .next
39578 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
39579 Default is 5.
39580 .next
39581 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
39582 higher values being tried first.
39583 The default priority is 1.
39584 .next
39585 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
39586 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
39587 weighted by this value.
39588 The default value for selection bias is 1.
39589 .endlist
39590
39591 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
39592 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
39593 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
39594
39595 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
39596 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
39597 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
39598 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
39599
39600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39602
39603 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
39604 "Internationalisation""
39605 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
39606 .cindex EAI
39607 .cindex i18n
39608 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
39609
39610 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
39611 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
39612 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
39613
39614 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
39615 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
39616 requirement, upon libidn2.
39617
39618 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
39619 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
39620 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
39621 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
39622 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
39623 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
39624
39625 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
39626 international handling for the message is enabled and
39627 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
39628
39629 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
39630 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
39631 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
39632 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
39633
39634 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
39635 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
39636 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
39637 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
39638
39639 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
39640 components expanded to a-label form,
39641 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
39642 form of the name.
39643
39644 .cindex log protocol
39645 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
39646 .cindex i18n logging
39647 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
39648 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
39649
39650 The following expansion operators can be used:
39651 .code
39652 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
39653 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
39654 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
39655 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
39656 .endd
39657
39658 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
39659 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
39660 .new
39661 The RCPT ACL
39662 .wen
39663 may use the following modifier:
39664 .display
39665 control = utf8_downconvert
39666 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
39667 .endd
39668 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
39669 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
39670 Message Submission Agent context.
39671 If a value is appended it may be:
39672 .display
39673 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
39674 &`0 `& no downconversion
39675 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
39676 .endd
39677
39678 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
39679 is initially set to -1.
39680
39681
39682 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
39683 Configurations supporting these should inspect
39684 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
39685
39686 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
39687 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
39688 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
39689
39690 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
39691 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
39692
39693
39694
39695 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
39696 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
39697 the following expansion operator can be used:
39698 .code
39699 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
39700 .endd
39701
39702 The string is converted from the charset specified by
39703 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
39704 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
39705 to the
39706 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
39707 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
39708 (which has to be a single character)
39709 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
39710 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
39711
39712 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
39713 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
39714
39715 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
39716 by many other IMAP servers.
39717
39718 Examples:
39719 .display
39720 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
39721 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
39722 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
39723 .endd
39724
39725 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
39726 must be representable in UTF-16.
39727
39728
39729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39731
39732 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
39733 "Events"
39734 .cindex events
39735
39736 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
39737 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
39738 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
39739 processing actions.
39740
39741 Most installations will never need to use Events.
39742 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
39743 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39744
39745 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
39746 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
39747 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
39748
39749 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
39750 An example might look like:
39751 .cindex logging custom
39752 .code
39753 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
39754 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
39755 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
39756 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
39757 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
39758 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
39759 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
39760 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
39761 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
39762 } {}}
39763 .endd
39764
39765 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
39766 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
39767 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
39768
39769 The current list of events is:
39770 .display
39771 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
39772 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
39773 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39774 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
39775 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
39776 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
39777 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39778 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
39779 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
39780 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
39781 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
39782 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
39783 .endd
39784 New event types may be added in future.
39785
39786 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
39787 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
39788 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
39789
39790 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
39791 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
39792 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
39793
39794 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
39795 should define the event action.
39796
39797 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
39798 with the event type:
39799 .display
39800 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
39801 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
39802 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
39803 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
39804 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
39805 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
39806 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
39807 .endd
39808
39809 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
39810
39811 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
39812 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
39813 the course of its processing:
39814 .ilist
39815 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
39816 transport call
39817 .next
39818 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
39819 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
39820 .endlist
39821 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
39822 a useful way of writing to the main log.
39823
39824 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
39825 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
39826 following will be forced:
39827 .display
39828 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
39829 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
39830 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
39831 .endd
39832 All other message types ignore the result string, and
39833 no other use is made of it.
39834
39835 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
39836 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
39837 the target system.
39838
39839 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
39840 chain element received on the connection.
39841 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
39842 loaded locally.
39843
39844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39845 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39846
39847 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
39848 "Adding drivers or lookups"
39849 .cindex "adding drivers"
39850 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
39851 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
39852 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
39853 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
39854
39855 .olist
39856 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
39857 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
39858 .next
39859 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
39860 .display
39861 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
39862 .endd
39863 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
39864 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
39865 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
39866 .next
39867 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
39868 .code
39869 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
39870 .endd
39871 .next
39872 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
39873 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
39874 .next
39875 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
39876 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
39877 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
39878 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
39879 simple form that most lookups have.
39880 .next
39881 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
39882 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
39883 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
39884 .next
39885 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
39886 &_src_&.
39887 .next
39888 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
39889 as for other drivers and lookups.
39890 .endlist
39891
39892 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
39893 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
39894 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
39895 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
39896 searched using a binary chop procedure.
39897
39898 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
39899 the interface that is expected.
39900
39901
39902
39903
39904 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39905 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39906
39907 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39908 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
39909 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
39910 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
39911 . processors.
39912 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39913
39914 .literal xml
39915 <?sdop
39916 format="newpage"
39917 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
39918 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
39919 ?>
39920 .literal off
39921
39922 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
39923 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
39924 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
39925
39926
39927 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39928 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////